MCP19111-E/MJ [MICROCHIP]
Digitally-Enhanced Power Analog Controller;型号: | MCP19111-E/MJ |
厂家: | MICROCHIP |
描述: | Digitally-Enhanced Power Analog Controller |
文件: | 总226页 (文件大小:3155K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
MCP19110/11
Digitally-Enhanced Power Analog Controller
with Integrated Synchronous Driver
Synchronous Buck Features
Microcontroller Features
• Precision 8 MHz Internal Oscillator Block:
- Factory Calibrated
• Input Voltage: 4.5V to 32V
• Output Voltage: 0.5V to 3.6V
- Greater than 3.6V requires external divider
• Switching Frequency: 100 kHz to 1.6 MHz
• Quiescent Current: 5 mA Typical
• High-Drive:
• Interrupt Capable
- Firmware
- Interrupt-on-Change Pins
• Only 35 Instructions to Learn
• 4096 Words On-Chip Program Memory
• High Endurance Flash:
- +5V Gate Drive
- 1A/2A Source Current
- 1A/2A Sink Current
- 100,000 write Flash Endurance
- Flash Retention: >40 years
• Low-Drive:
• Watchdog Timer (WDT) with Independent
Oscillator for Reliable Operation
• Programmable Code Protection
- +5V Gate Drive
- 2A Source Current
- 4A Sink Current
• In-Circuit Debug (ICD) via Two Pins (MCP19111)
• Peak Current Mode Control
• Differential Remote Output Sense
• Multi-Phase Systems:
- Master or Slave
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) via Two
Pins
• 11 I/O Pins and One Input-Only Pin (MCP19110)
- Three Open-Drain Pins
- Frequency Synchronized
- Common Error Signal
• Multiple Output Systems:
- Master or Slave
• 14 I/O Pins and One Input-Only Pin (MCP19111)
- Three Open-Drain Pins
• Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC):
- 10-bit Resolution
- Frequency Synchronized
- AEC-Q100 Qualified
- 12 Internal Channels
- Eight External Channels
• Configurable Parameters:
- Overcurrent Limit
• Timer0: 8-bit Timer/Counter with 8-Bit Prescaler
• Enhanced Timer1:
- Input Undervoltage Lockout
- Output Overvoltage
- 16-bit Timer/Counter with Prescaler
- Two Selectable Clock Sources
• Timer2: 8-Bit Timer/Counter with Prescaler
- 8-bit Period Register
- Output Undervoltage
- Internal Analog Compensation
- Soft Start Profile
•
I2C Communication:
- Synchronous Driver Dead Time
- Switching Frequency
• Thermal Shutdown
- 7-bit Address Masking
- Two Dedicated Address Registers
- SMBus/PMBusTM Compatibility
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 1
MCP19110/11
Pin Diagram – 24-Pin QFN (MCP19110)
1
VDD
GPA0
18
17
16
15
14
13
2
BOOT
GPA1
3
4
5
6
GPA2
GPA3
HDRV
PHASE
VDR
MCP19110
GPA7
GPA6
EXP-25
LDRV
DS20002331D-page 2
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 1:
I/O
24-PIN SUMMARY
Basic
Additional
GPA0
GPA1
GPA2
1
2
3
Y
Y
Y
AN0
AN1
AN2
—
—
—
—
—
IOC
IOC
Y
Y
Y
—
—
—
Analog Debug Output (1)
Sync. Signal In/Out (2, 3)
—
T0CKI
IOC
INT
GPA3
GPA4
5
8
Y
N
AN3
—
—
—
IOC
IOC
Y
N
—
—
—
—
—
GPA5
GPA6
GPA7
GPB0
GPB1
GPB2
VIN
7
6
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
IOC(4)
IOC
IOC
IOC
IOC
IOC
—
Y(5)
N
MCLR
ICSPDAT
ICSPCLK
—
—
—
5
—
SCL
SDA
—
N
—
9
—
N
—
23
24
11
14
AN4
AN5
—
Y
—
Error Signal In/Out (3)
—
Y
—
—
—
—
—
VIN
Device Input Voltage
VDR
—
—
—
VDR
Gate Drive Supply Input
Voltage
VDD
GND
PGND
LDRV
18
10
12
13
N
N
N
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
GND
—
Internal Regulator Output
Small Signal Ground
Large Signal Ground
—
Low-Side MOSFET
Connection
HDRV
16
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
High-Side MOSFET
Connection
PHASE
BOOT
+VSEN
15
17
21
N
N
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Switch Node
Floating Bootstrap Supply
Output Voltage
Differential Sense
-VSEN
22
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
Output Voltage
Differential Sense
+ISEN
-ISEN
20
19
N
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Current Sense Input
Current Sense Input
Note 1: The Analog Debug Output is selected when the ATSTCON<BNCHEN> bit is set.
2: Selected when device is functioning as multiple output master or slave by proper configuration of the MLTPH<2:0> bits
in the BUFFCON register.
3: Selected when device is functioning as multi-phase master or slave by proper configuration of the MLTPH<2:0> bits in
the BUFFCON register.
4: The IOC is disabled when MCLR is enabled.
5: Weak pull-up always enabled when MCLR is enabled, otherwise the pull-up is under user control.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 3
MCP19110/11
Pin Diagram – 28-Pin QFN (MCP19111)
1
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
GPB6
VDD
GPA0
2
GPA1
3
BOOT
GPA2
4
GPB4
HDRV
PHASE
VDR
MCP19111
5
6
7
GPA3
GPA7
GPA6
EXP-29
LDRV
DS20002331D-page 4
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 2:
I/O
28-PIN SUMMARY
Basic
Additional
GPA0
GPA1
GPA2
1
2
3
Y
Y
Y
AN0
AN1
AN2
—
—
—
—
—
IOC
IOC
Y
Y
Y
—
—
—
Analog Debug Output (1)
Sync. Signal In/Out (2, 3)
—
T0CKI
IOC
INT
GPA3
GPA4
5
9
Y
N
AN3
—
—
—
IOC
IOC
Y
N
—
—
—
—
—
GPA5
GPA6
GPA7
GPB0
GPB1
GPB2
GPB4
8
7
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
IOC(4)
IOC
IOC
IOC
IOC
IOC
IOC
Y(5)
N
MCLR
—
—
—
6
—
SCL
SDA
—
N
—
—
10
26
28
4
—
N
—
—
AN4
AN5
AN6
Y
—
Error Signal In/Out (3)
—
Y
—
—
—
—
Y
ICSPDAT
ICDDAT
GPB5
27
Y
AN7
—
—
IOC
Y
ICSPCLK
ICDCLK
Alternate Sync
Signal In/Out (2, 3)
GPB6
GPB7
VIN
21
11
13
16
N
N
N
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
IOC
IOC
—
Y
Y
—
—
—
—
—
—
VIN
VDR
Device Input Voltage
VDR
—
Gate Drive Supply Input
Voltage
VDD
GND
PGND
LDRV
20
12
14
15
N
N
N
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
GND
—
Internal Regulator Output
Small Signal Ground
Large Signal Ground
—
Low-Side MOSFET
Connection
HDRV
18
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
High-Side MOSFET
Connection
PHASE
BOOT
+VSEN
17
19
24
N
N
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Switch Node
Floating Bootstrap Supply
Output Voltage
Differential Sense
-VSEN
25
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
Output Voltage
Differential Sense
+ISEN
-ISEN
23
22
N
N
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Current Sense Input
Current Sense Input
Note 1: The Analog Debug Output is selected when the ATSTCON<BNCHEN> bit is set.
2: Selected when device is functioning as multiple output master or slave by proper configuration of the MLTPH<2:0> bits
in the BUFFCON register.
3: Selected when device is functioning as multi-phase master or slave by proper configuration of the MLTPH<2:0> bits in
the BUFFCON register.
4: The IOC is disabled when MCLR is enabled.
5: Weak pull-up always enabled when MCLR is enabled, otherwise the pull-up is under user control.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 5
MCP19110/11
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 9
2.0 Pin Description ........................................................................................................................................................................... 12
3.0 Functional Description................................................................................................................................................................ 17
4.0 Electrical Characteristics............................................................................................................................................................ 23
5.0 Digital Electrical Characteristics ................................................................................................................................................. 29
6.0 Configuring the MCP19110/11.................................................................................................................................................... 37
7.0 Typical Performance Curves ...................................................................................................................................................... 53
8.0 System Bench Testing................................................................................................................................................................ 57
9.0 Device Calibration ...................................................................................................................................................................... 59
10.0 Relative Efficiency Measurement ............................................................................................................................................... 67
11.0 Memory Organization................................................................................................................................................................. 69
12.0 Device Configuration.................................................................................................................................................................. 81
13.0 Oscillator Modes......................................................................................................................................................................... 83
14.0 Resets ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 85
15.0 Interrupts .................................................................................................................................................................................... 93
16.0 Power-Down Mode (Sleep) ...................................................................................................................................................... 101
17.0 Watchdog Timer (WDT)............................................................................................................................................................ 103
18.0 Flash Program Memory Control ............................................................................................................................................... 105
19.0 I/O Ports ....................................................................................................................................................................................111
20.0 Interrupt-On-Change ................................................................................................................................................................ 121
21.0 Internal Temperature Indicator Module..................................................................................................................................... 123
22.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module .............................................................................................................................. 125
23.0 Timer0 Module.......................................................................................................................................................................... 135
24.0 Timer1 Module with Gate Control............................................................................................................................................. 137
25.0 Timer2 Module.......................................................................................................................................................................... 140
26.0 PWM Module............................................................................................................................................................................ 143
27.0 Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) Module .................................................................................................................... 147
28.0 In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) ............................................................................................................................... 191
29.0 Instruction Set Summary.......................................................................................................................................................... 193
30.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 203
31.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 207
Appendix A: Revision History............................................................................................................................................................. 213
Index .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 215
The Microchip Web Site..................................................................................................................................................................... 221
Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 221
Customer Support.............................................................................................................................................................................. 221
Product Identification System............................................................................................................................................................. 223
DS20002331D-page 6
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS
It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip
products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and
enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced.
If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via
E-mail at docerrors@microchip.com. We welcome your feedback.
Most Current Data Sheet
To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at:
http://www.microchip.com
You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page.
The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000000A is version A of document DS30000000).
Errata
An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current
devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision
of silicon and revision of document to which it applies.
To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following:
•
•
Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com
Your local Microchip sales office (see last page)
When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are
using.
Customer Notification System
Register on our web site at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 7
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 8
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
After initial device configuration using Microchip’s
MPLAB® X Integrated Development Environment (IDE)
software, the PMBus or I2C can be used by a host to
communicate with, or modify, the operation of the
MCP19110/11.
1.0
DEVICE OVERVIEW
The MCP19110/11 is a highly integrated, mixed signal,
analog pulse-width modulation (PWM) current mode
controller with an integrated microcontroller core for
synchronous DC/DC step-down applications. Since the
MCP19110/11 uses traditional analog control circuitry
to regulate the output of the DC/DC converter, the
integration of the PIC® microcontroller mid-range core
is used to provide complete customization of device
operating parameters, start-up and shut down profiles,
protection levels and fault handling procedures.
Two internal linear regulators generate two 5V rails.
One 5V rail is used to provide power for the internal
analog circuitry and is contained on-chip. The second
5V rail provides power to the PIC device and is present
on the VDD pin. It is recommended that a 1 µF capacitor
be placed between VDD and PGND. The VDD pin may
also be directly connected to the VDR pin, or connected
through a low-pass RC filter. The VDR pin provides
power to the internal synchronous driver.
The MCP19110/11 is designed to efficiently operate
from a single 4.5V to 32V supply. It features integrated
synchronous drivers, bootstrap device, internal linear
regulator and 4 kW nonvolatile memory all in a
space-saving 24-pin 4 mm x 4mm QFN package
(MCP19110) or 28-pin 5 mm x 5 mm QFN package
(MCP19111).
FIGURE 1-1:
TYPICAL APPLICATION CIRCUIT
VIN
GPA6
GPB1
VIN
GPA0
GPA2
GPB2
GPA3
GPB7
GPB6
GPA1
GPA4
GPA7
GPB0
HDRV
BOOT
PHASE
LDRV
VDD
TRACK
PGOOD
CNTL
+VOUT
-VOUT
ADDR1
ADDR0
SYNC
VDR
MCP19111
+ISEN
SMBus Alert
SCL
-ISEN
+VSEN
-VSEN
SDA
ICDDAT
GPB4
PGND
GND
®
MPLAB X ICD
ICDCLK
MCLR
GPB5
GPA5
Programmer
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 9
FIGURE 1-2:
MCP19110/11 SYNCHRONOUS BUCK BLOCK DIAGRAM
VIN
VIN
Bias Gen
VDD
dc current sense gain
VDD
VDR
LDO1
To ADC
LDO2
AVDD
3
+ISEN
BGAP
CSDGEN
bit
12R
R
+ISEN
UVLO
4
VDAC
-ISEN
ac current sense gain
6
BOOT
8
8
VOUT
OV
UV
OV REF
5
VIN
VOUT
UV REF
OC
Comp
8+5
HDRV
VREGREF
BGAP
PHASE
VOUT
AVDD
LVL_SFT
Lo_on
4
-ISEN
DLY
4
Slave
Mode
VOUT
LDRV
+VSEN
-VSEN
VDR
DLY
4
+VSEN
4
4
Lo_on
VIN_OK
-VSEN
5
I/O(Digital Signals)
VZC
OCFLAG
OV
UV
Master
Mode
A/D Mux
11 (15)
Debug
MUX
PGND
GND
Buck
PIC CORE
I/O
I/O
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 1-3:
MICROCONTROLLER CORE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Configuration
13
8
PORTA
Data Bus
Program Counter
GPA0
GPA1
GPA2
GPA3
GPA4
GPA5
Flash
4K x 14
Program
Memory
RAM
256
bytes
8 Level Stack
(13-bit)
File
Registers
Program
Bus
14
GPA6
GPA7
RAM Addr
9
Addr MUX
Instruction reg
Indirect
Addr
7
Direct Addr
8
PORTB
GPB0
GPB1
GPB2
FSR reg
STATUS reg
8
GPB4 (MCP19111
)
3
MUX
GPB5 (MCP19111
)
Power-up
Timer
GPB6 (MCP19111
)
)
Instruction
Decode &
Control
GPB7 (MCP19111
ALU
Power-on
Reset
8
Timing
Generation
TESTCLKIN
SDA
SCL
W reg
Watchdog
Timer
MSSP
8 MHz Internal
Oscillator
VIN
VSS
MCLR
PMDATL
Self read/
write flash
memory
Timer2
Timer0
Timer1
EEADDR
T0CKI
Analog Interface
Registers
PWM
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 11
MCP19110/11
2.0
PIN DESCRIPTION
The MCP19110/11 family of devices feature pins that
have multiple functions associated with each pin.
Table 2-1 provides a description of the different func-
tions. See Section 2.1 “Detailed Pin Functional
Description” for more detailed information.
TABLE 2-1:
MCP19110/11 PINOUT DESCRIPTION
Input Output
Name
Function
Description
Type
Type
GPA0/AN0/ANALOG_TEST
GPA1/AN1/CLKPIN
GPA0
AN0
TTL
AN
—
CMOS General purpose I/O
—
—
A/D Channel 0 input.
Internal analog signal multiplexer output (1)
ANALOG_TEST
GPA1
TTL
AN
—
CMOS General purpose I/O
AN1
—
—
A/D Channel 1 input.
Switching frequency clock input or output (2 ,3)
CLKPIN
GPA2
GPA2/AN2/T0CKI/INT
TTL
AN
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O
AN2
—
—
—
A/D Channel 2 input
Timer0 clock input
External interrupt
T0CKI
INT
ST
GPA3/AN3
GPA3
TTL
AN
TTL
CMOS General purpose I/O
AN3
—
A/D Channel 3 input
General purpose I/O
GPA4
GPA4
OD
GPA5/MCLR
GPA5
TTL
—
—
General purpose input only
MCLR
GPA6
ICSPDAT
GPA7
SCL
ST
ST
Master Clear with internal pull-up
GPA6/ICSPDAT
CMOS General purpose I/O
CMOS Serial Programming Data I/O (MCP19110 Only)
GPA7/SCL/ICSPCLK
ST
I2C
ST
OD
OD
—
General purpose open-drain I/O
I2C clock
ICSPCLK
GPB0
SDA
Serial Programming Clock (MCP19110 Only)
General purpose I/O
I2C data input/output
GPB0/SDA
TTL
I2C
TTL
AN
—
OD
OD
GPB1/AN4/EAPIN
GPB1
AN4
CMOS General purpose I/O
—
—
A/D Channel 4 input
Error amplifier signal input/output (3)
EAPIN
GPB2
AN5
GPB2/AN5
TTL
AN
TTL
AN
ST
CMOS General purpose I/O
A/D Channel 5 input
CMOS General purpose I/O
A/D Channel 6 input
CMOS Serial Programming Data I/O
—
GPB4/AN6/ICSPDAT
(MCP19111 Only)
GPB4
AN6
—
ICSPDAT
Legend:
AN = Analog input or output CMOS =CMOS compatible input or output
TTL = TTL compatible input ST
OD = Open Drain
=Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels I2C = Schmitt Trigger input with I2C
Note 1: Analog Test is selected when the ATSTCON<BNCHEN> bit is set.
2: Selected when device is functioning as multiple output master or slave by proper configuration of the MLTPH<2:0> bits
in the BUFFCON register.
3: Selected when device is functioning as multi-phase master or slave by proper configuration of the MLTPH<2:0> bits in
the BUFFCON register.
DS20002331D-page 12
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 2-1:
MCP19110/11 PINOUT DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED)
Input Output
Name
Function
Description
Type
Type
GPB5/AN7/ICSPCLK/
ALT_CLKPIN
(MCP19111 Only)
GPB5
AN7
TTL
AN
ST
—
CMOS General purpose I/O
—
—
—
A/D Channel 7 input
ISCPCLK
ALT_CLKPIN
Serial Programming Clock
Alternate switching frequency clock input
or output (2,3)
GPB6 (MCP19111 Only)
GPB6
GPB7
VIN
TTL
TTL
—
CMOS General purpose I/O
CMOS General purpose I/O
GPB7 (MCP19111 Only)
VIN
—
—
—
—
—
—
Device input supply voltage
VDD
VDD
—
Internal +5V LDO output pin
Gate drive supply input voltage pin
Small signal quiet ground
VDR
VDR
—
GND
PGND
LDRV
GND
PGND
LDRV
—
—
Large signal power ground
—
High-current drive signal connected to the gate
of the low-side MOSFET
HDRV
HDRV
—
—
Floating high-current drive signal connected to
the gate of the high-side MOSFET
PHASE
BOOT
+VSEN
PHASE
BOOT
+VSEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
Synchronous buck switch node connection
Floating bootstrap supply
Positive input of the output voltage sense
differential amplifier
-VSEN
-VSEN
—
—
Negative input of the output voltage sense
differential amplifier
+ISEN
-ISEN
EP
+ISEN
-ISEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Current sense input
Current sense input
Exposed Thermal Pad
Legend:
AN = Analog input or output CMOS =CMOS compatible input or output
TTL = TTL compatible input ST
OD = Open Drain
=Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels I2C = Schmitt Trigger input with I2C
Note 1: Analog Test is selected when the ATSTCON<BNCHEN> bit is set.
2: Selected when device is functioning as multiple output master or slave by proper configuration of the MLTPH<2:0> bits
in the BUFFCON register.
3: Selected when device is functioning as multi-phase master or slave by proper configuration of the MLTPH<2:0> bits in
the BUFFCON register.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 13
MCP19110/11
AN3 is an input to the A/D. To configure this pin to be
read by the A/D on channel 3, bits TRISA3 and ANSA3
must be set.
2.1
Detailed Pin Functional
Description
2.1.1
GPA0 PIN
2.1.5
GPA4 PIN
GPA0 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPA. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
GPA4 is a true open-drain general purpose pin whose
data direction is controlled in TRISGPA. There is no
internal connection between this pin and device VDD
making this pin ideal to be used as an SMBus Alert pin.
This pin does not have a weak pull-up, but interrupt-on-
change is available.
,
AN0 is an input to the A/D. To configure this pin to be
read by the A/D on channel 0, bits TRISA0 and ANSA0
must be set.
2.1.6
GPA5 PIN
When the ATSTCON<BNCHEN> bit is set, this pin is
configured as the ANALOG_TEST function. It is a
buffered output of the internal analog signal
multiplexer. Signals present on this pin are controlled
by the BUFFCON register, see Register 8-2.
GPA5 is a general purpose TTL input-only pin. An inter-
nal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
For programming purposes, this pin is to be connected
to the MCLR pin of the serial programmer. See
Section 28.0 “In-Circuit Serial Programming™
(ICSP™)” for more information.
2.1.2
GPA1 PIN
GPA1 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPA. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
2.1.7
GPA6 PIN
GPA6 is a general purpose CMOS input/output pin
whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPA. An
interrupt-on-change is also available.
AN1 is an input to the A/D. To configure this pin to be
read by the A/D on channel 1, bits TRISA1 and ANSA1
must be set.
On the MCP19110, the ISCPDAT is the serial program-
ming data input function. This is used in conjunction
with ICSPCLK to serial program the device. This pin
function is only implemented on the MCP19110.
When the MCP19110/11 is configured as a multiple
output or multi-phase MASTER or SLAVE, this pin is
configured
synchronization input or output, CLKPIN. See
Section 3.10.6 “Multi-Phase System” and
to
be
the
switching
frequency
2.1.8
GPA7 PIN
Section 3.10.7 “Multiple Output System” for more
information.
GPA7 is a true open-drain general purpose pin whose
data direction is controlled in TRISGPA. There is no
internal connection between this pin and device VDD
This pin does not have a weak pull-up, but interrupt-on-
change is available.
When the MCP19110/11 is configured for I2C
communication (see Section 27.2 “I2C Mode
Overview”), GPA7 functions as the I2C clock, SCL.
.
2.1.3
GPA2 PIN
GPA2 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPA. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
AN2 is an input to the A/D. To configure this pin to be
read by the A/D on channel 2, bits TRISA2 and ANSA2
must be set.
On the MCP19110, the ISCPCLK is the serial
programming clock function. This is used in conjunction
with ICSPDAT to serial program the device. This pin
function is only implemented on the MCP19110.
When bit T0CS is set, the T0CKI function is enabled.
See Section 23.0 “Timer0 Module” for more
information.
2.1.9
GPB0 PIN
GPA2 can also be configured as an external interrupt
by setting of the INTE bit. See Section 15.2
“GPA2/INT Interrupt” for more information.
GPB0 is a true open-drain general purpose pin whose
data direction is controlled in TRISGPB. There is no
internal connection between this pin and device VDD
This pin does not have weak pull-up, but
interrupt-on-change is available.
.
a
2.1.4
GPA3 PIN
When the MCP19110/11 is configured for I2C
communication (see Section 27.2 “I2C Mode
Overview”), GPB0 functions as the I2C clock, SDA.
GPA3 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPA. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
DS20002331D-page 14
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
This pin can also be configured as an alternate switch-
ing frequency synchronization input or output, ALT_-
CLKPIN, for use in multiple output or multi-phase
systems. See Section 19.1 “Alternate Pin Function”
for more information.
2.1.10
GPB1 PIN
GPB1 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPB. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
AN4 is an input to the A/D. To configure this pin to be
read by the A/D on channel 4, bits TRISB1 and ANSB1
must be set.
2.1.14
GPB6 PIN
This pin and associated functions is only available on
the MCP19111 device.
When the MCP19110/11 is configured as a multiple
output or multi-phase MASTER or SLAVE, this pin is
configured to be the error amplifier signal input or out-
put. See Section 3.10.6 “Multi-Phase System” and
Section 3.10.7 “Multiple Output System”, for more
information.
GPB6 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPB. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
2.1.15
GPB7 PIN
This pin and associated functions is only available on
the MCP19111 device.
2.1.11
GPB2 PIN
GPB2 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPB. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
GPB7 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPB. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
AN5 is an input to the A/D. To configure this pin to be
read by the A/D on channel 5, bits TRISB2 and ANSB2
must be set.
2.1.16
V
PIN
IN
Device input power connection pin. It is recommended
that capacitance be placed between this pin and the
GND pin of the device.
2.1.12
GPB4 PIN
This pin and its associated functions are only available
on the MCP19111 device.
2.1.17
V
PIN
DD
GPB4 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPB. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
The output of the internal +5.0V regulator is connected
to this pin. It is recommended that a 1.0 µF bypass
capacitor be connected between this pin and the GND
pin of the device. The bypass capacitor should be
placed physically close to the device.
AN6 is an input to the A/D. To configure this pin to be
read by the A/D on channel 6, bits TRISB4 and ANSB4
must be set.
2.1.18
V
PIN
DR
The 5V supply for the low-side driver is connected to
this pin. The pin can be connected by an RC filter to the
VDD pin.
On the MCP19111, the ISCPDAT is the serial program-
ming data input function. This is used in conjunction
with ICSPCLK to serial program the device. This pin
function is only implemented on the MCP19111.
2.1.19
GND PIN
2.1.13
GBP5 PIN
GND is the small signal ground connection pin. This pin
should be connected to the exposed pad, on the
bottom of the package.
This pin and its associated functions are only available
on the MCP19111 device.
GPB5 is a general purpose TTL input or CMOS output
pin whose data direction is controlled in TRISGPB. An
internal weak pull-up and interrupt-on-change are also
available.
2.1.20
P
PIN
GND
Connect all large signal level ground returns to PGND
.
These large-signal level ground traces should have a
small loop area and minimal length to prevent coupling
of switching noise to sensitive traces.
AN7 is an input to the A/D. To configure this pin to be
read by the A/D on channel 7, bits TRISB5 and ANSB5
must be set.
2.1.21
LDRV PIN
On the MCP19111, the ISCPCLK is the serial
programming clock function. This is used in conjunction
with ICSPDAT to serial program the device. This pin
function is only implemented on the MCP19111.
The gate of the low-side or rectifying MOSFET is
connected to LDRV. The PCB tracing connecting LDRV
to the gate must be of minimal length and appropriate
width to handle the high peak drive currents and fast
voltage transitions.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 15
MCP19110/11
2.1.22
HDRV PIN
The gate of the high-side MOSFET is connected to
HDRV. This is a floating driver referenced to PHASE.
The PCB trace connecting HDRV to the gate must be
of minimal length and appropriate width to handle the
high-peak drive current and fast voltage transitions.
2.1.23
PHASE PIN
The PHASE pin provides the return path for the high-
side gate driver. The source of the high-side MOSFET,
drain of the low-side MOSFET and the inductor are
connected to this pin.
2.1.24
BOOT PIN
The BOOT pin is the floating bootstrap supply pin for
the high-side gate driver. A capacitor is connected
between this pin and the PHASE pin to provide the
necessary charge to turn on the high-side MOSFET.
2.1.25
+V
PIN
SEN
The non-inverting input of the unity gain amplifier used
for output voltage remote sensing is connected to the
+VSEN pin. This pin can be internally pulled-up to VDD
by setting PE1<PUEN> bit.
2.1.26
-V
PIN
SEN
The inverting input of the unity gain amplifier used for
output voltage remote sensing is connected to the
-VSEN pin. This pin can be internally pull-down to GND
by setting PE1<PDEN> bit.
2.1.27
+I
PIN
SEN
The non-inverting input of the current sense amplifier is
connected to the +ISEN pin.
2.1.28
-I
PIN
SEN
The inverting input of the current sense amplifier is
connected to the -ISEN pin.
2.1.29
EXPOSED PAD (EP)
There is no internal connection to the Exposed Thermal
Pad. The EP should be connected to the GND pin and
to the GND PCB plane to aid in the removal of the heat.
DS20002331D-page 16
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
3.2
Internal Synchronous Driver
3.0
3.1
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
Linear Regulators
The internal synchronous driver is capable of driving
two N-Channel MOSFETs in a synchronous rectified
buck converter topology. The gate of the floating
MOSFET is connected to the HDRV pin. The source of
this MOSFET is connected to the PHASE pin. The
HDRV pin source and sink current is configurable. By
setting the DRVSTR bit in the PE1 register, the high-
side is capable of sourcing and sinking a peak current
of 1A. By clearing this bit, the source and sink peak
current is 2A.
Two internal linear regulators generate two 5V rails.
One 5V rail is used to provide power for the internal
analog circuitry and is contained on-chip. The second
5V rail provides power to the internal PIC core and it is
present on the VDD pin. It is recommended that a 1 µF
capacitor be placed between VDD and PGND
.
The VDR pin provides power to the internal
synchronous MOSFET driver. VDD can be directly
connected to VDR or connected through a low-pass RC
filter to provide noise filtering. A 1 µF ceramic bypass
Note 1: The PE1<DRVSTR> bit configures the
peak source/sink current of the HDRV
pin.
capacitor should be placed between VDR and PGND
.
When connecting VDD to VDR, the gate drive current
required to drive the external MOSFETs must be added
to the MCP19110/11 quiescent current, IQ(max). This
total current must be less than the maximum current,
IDD-OUT, available from VDD that is specified in
Section 4.2 “Electrical Characteristics”.
The MOSFET connected to the LDRV pin is not
floating. The low-side MOSFET gate is connected to
the LDRV pin and the source of this MOSFET is
connected to PGND. The drive strength of the LDRV pin
is not configurable. This pin is capable of sourcing a
peak current of 2A. The peak sink current is 4A. This
helps keep the low-side MOSFET off when the
high-side MOSFET is turning on.
EQUATION 3-1:
TOTAL REGULATOR
CURRENT
IDD – OUT > IQ + IDRIVE + IEXT
Note 1: Refer to Figure 1-1 for a graphical
representation
connections.
of
the
MOSFET
Where:
- I
is the total current available from V
DD-OUT
DD
3.2.1
MOSFET DRIVER DEAD TIME
- I is the device quiescent current
Q
The MOSFET driver dead time is defined as the time
between one drive signal going low and the
complimentary drive signal going high. Refer to
Figure 6-2. The MCP19110/11 has the capability to
adjust both the high-side and low-side driver dead time
independently. The adjustment of the driver dead time
is controlled by the DEADCON register and is
adjustable in 4 ns increments.
- I
is the current required to drive the
DRIVE
external MOSFETs
- I is the amount of current used to power
additional external circuitry.
EXT
EQUATION 3-2:
GATE DRIVE CURRENT
IDRIVE = QgHIGH + QgLOW FSW
Note 1: The DEADCON register controls the
amount of dead time added to the HDRV
or LDRV signal. The dead time circuitry is
enabled by the LDLYBY and HDLYBY
bits in the PE1 register.
Where:
- IDRIVE is the current required to drive the
external MOSFETs
- QgHIGH is the total gate charge of the
high-side MOSFET
3.2.2
MOSFET DRIVER CONTROL
- QgLOW is the total gate charge of the
low-side MOSFET
The MCP19110/11 has the ability to disable the entire
synchronous driver or just one side of the synchronous
drive signal. The bits that control the MOSFET driver
can be found in the Register 8-1.
- FSW is the switching frequency
Alternatively, an external regulator can be used to
power the synchronous driver. An external 5V source
can be connected to VDR. The amount of current
required from this external source can be found in
Equation 3-2. Care must be taken that the voltage
applied to VDR does not exceed the maximum ratings
By
setting
ATSTCON<DRVDIS>,
the
entire
synchronous driver is disabled. The HDRV and LDRV
signals are set low and the PHASE pin is floating.
Clearing this bit allows normal operation.
Individual control of the HDRV or LDRV signal is
accomplished by setting or clearing the HIDIS or
LODIS bits in the ATSTCON register. When either
driver is disabled, the output signal is set low.
found
in
Section 4.1
“Absolute
Maximum
Ratings (†)”.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 17
MCP19110/11
3.3
Output Voltage
3.6
Slope Compensation
The output voltage is configured by the settings
contained in the OVCCON and OVFCON registers. No
external resistor divider is needed to set the output
voltage. Refer to Section 6.10 “Output Voltage
Configuration”.
In current mode control systems, slope compensation
needs to be added to the control path to help prevent
subharmonic oscillation when operating with greater
than 50% duty cycle. In the MCP19110/11, a negative
slope is added to the error amplifier output signal
before it is compared to the current sense signal. The
amount of slope added is controlled by the
SLPCRCON register, Register 6-7.
The MCP19110/11 contains a unity gain differential
amplifier used for remote sensing of the output voltage.
Connect the +VSEN and -VSEN pins directly at the load
for better load regulation. The +VSEN and -VSEN are the
positive and negative inputs, respectively, of the
differential amplifier.
Note 1: To enable the slope compensation
circuitry, the ABECON<SLCPBY> bit
must be cleared.
3.4
Switching Frequency
The amount of slope compensation added should be
equal to the inductor current down slope during the
high-side off time.
The switching frequency is configurable over the range
of 100 kHz to 1.6 MHz. The Timer2 module is used to
generate the HDRV/LDRV switching frequency. Refer
to Section 26.0 “PWM Module” for more information.
Example 3-1 shows how to configure the
MCP19110/11 for a switching frequency of 300 kHz.
3.7
Current Sense
The output current is differentially sensed by the
MCP19110/11. The sense element can be either a
resistor placed in series with the output, or the series
resistance of the inductor. If the inductor series resis-
tance is used, a filter is needed to remove the large AC
component of the voltage that appears across the
inductor and leave only the small AC voltage that
appears across the inductor resistance, as shown in
Figure 3-2. This small AC voltage is representative of
the output current.
EXAMPLE 3-1:
CONFIGURING F
SW
BANKSEL
CLRF
CLRF
T2CON
T2CON
TMR2
0x19
PR2
0x0A
PWMRL
0x00
PWMPHL
0x04
T2CON
;Turn off Timer2
;Initialize module
;Fsw=300 kHz
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
;Max duty cycle=40%
;No phase shift
;Turn on Timer2
FIGURE 3-2:
INDUCTOR CURRENT
SENSE FILTER
VIN
3.5
Compensation
-ISEN
+ISEN
The MCP19110/11 is an analog peak current mode
controller with integrated adjustable compensation.
The CMPZCON register is used to adjust the
compensation zero frequency and gain. Figure 3-1
shows the internal compensation network with the
output differential amplifier.
CS
RL
RS
HDRV
To Load
PHASE
LDRV
L
FIGURE 3-1:
SIMPLIFIED INTERNAL
COMPENSATION
The value of RS and CS can be found by using
Equation 3-3. When the current sense filter time
constant is set equal to the inductor time constant, the
voltage appearing across CS approximates the current
flowing in the inductor, multiplied by the inductor
resistance.
+VSEN
-VSEN
VREF
DS20002331D-page 18
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
EQUATION 3-3:
CALCULATING FILTER
VALUES
3.7.1
PLACEMENT OF THE CURRENT
SENSE FILTER COMPONENTS
The amplitude of the current sense signal is typically
less than 100 mV peak-to-peak. Therefore, the small
signal current sense traces are very susceptible to
circuit noise. When designing the printed circuit board,
placement of RS and CS is very important. The +ISEN
and -ISEN traces should be routed parallel to each other
with minimum spacing. This Kelvin sense routing
technique helps minimize noise sensitivity. The filter
capacitor (CS), should be placed as close to the
MCP19110/11 as possible. This will help filter any noise
that is injected onto the current sense lines. The trace
connecting CS to the inductor should occur directly at
the inductor and not at any other +VSEN trace. The filter
resistor (RS), should be placed close to the inductor.
See Figure 3-3 for component placement. Care should
also be taken to avoid routing the +ISEN and -ISEN
traces near the high current switching nodes of the
HDRV, LDRV, PHASE, or BOOST traces. It is
recommended that a ground layer be placed between
these high current traces and the small signal current
sense traces.
L
----- = RS CS
RL
Where:
- L is the inductance value of the output
inductor
- RL is the series resistance of the output
inductor
- RS is the current sense filter resistor
- CS is the current sense filter capacitor
Both AC gain and DC gain can be added to the current
sense signal. Refer to Section 6.3 “Current Sense
AC Gain” and Section 6.4 “Current Sense DC Gain”
for more information.
FIGURE 3-3:
CURRENT SENSE FILTER COMPONENT PLACEMENT
-ISEN
+ISEN
CS
RS
To
PHASE
To
Load
INDUCTOR
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 19
MCP19110/11
3.8.3
OUTPUT UNDERVOLTAGE
3.8
Protection Features
When the output undervoltage DAC is enabled by
setting the ABECON<UVDCEN> bit, the voltage
measured between the +VSEN and -VSEN pins is
monitored and compared to the UV threshold
controlled by the OUVCON register (Register 6-12).
When the output voltage is below the threshold, the
PIR2<UVIF> flag will be set. Once set, firmware can
determine how the MCP19110/11 responds to the fault
condition and it must clear the UVIF flag.
3.8.1
INPUT UNDERVOLTAGE LOCKOUT
The input Undervoltage Lockout (UVLO) threshold is
configurable by the VINLVL register, Register 6-1.
When the voltage at the VIN pin of the MCP19110/11 is
below the configurable threshold, the PIR2<VINIF>
flag will be set. This flag is cleared by hardware once
the VIN voltage is greater than the configurable
threshold. By enabling the global interrupts or polling
the VINIF bit, the MCP19110/11 can be disabled when
the VIN voltage is below the threshold.
By setting the PE1<UVTEE> bit, the HDRV and LDRV
signals will be asserted low when the UVIF flag is set.
The signals will remain low until the flag is cleared.
Note 1: The UVLO DAC must be enabled by
setting the VINLVL<UVLOEN> bit.
Note 1: The UV DAC must be enabled by setting
2: Interrupt flag bits are set when an
interrupt condition occurs, regardless of
the state of its corresponding enable bit
or the Global Enable bit (GIE) of the
INTCON register.
the ABECON<UVDCEN> bit.
2: Interrupt flag bits are set when an
interrupt condition occurs, regardless of
the state of its corresponding enable bit
or the Global Enable bit (GIE) of the
INTCON register.
Some techniques that can be used to disable the
switching of the MCP19110/11 while the VINIF flag is
set include setting the ATSTCON<DVRDIS> bit, setting
the reference voltage to 0V, setting the PE1<PUEN>
bit, or setting the ATSTCON<HIDIS> and
ATSTCON<LODIS> bits.
3: The output of the remote sense
comparator is compared to the UV
threshold. Therefore, the offset in this
comparator should be considered when
calculating the UV threshold.
3.8.4
OUTPUT OVERVOLTAGE
3.8.2
OUTPUT OVERCURRENT
When the output overvoltage DAC is enabled by setting
the ABECON<OVDCEN> bit, the voltage measured
between the +VSEN and -VSEN pins is monitored and
compared to the OV threshold controlled by the
OOVCON register (Register 6-13). When the output
voltage is above the threshold, the PIR2<OVIF> flag
will be set. Once set, firmware can determine how the
MCP19110/11 responds to the fault condition and it
must clear the OVIF flag.
The MCP19110/11 senses the voltage drop across the
high-side MOSFET to determine when an output
overcurrent (OC) exists. This voltage drop is
configurable by the OCCON register (Register 6-2),
and is measured when the high-side MOSFET is
conducting. To avoid false OC events, leading edge
blanking is applied to the measurements. The amount
of blanking is controlled by the OCLEB<1:0> bits in the
OCCON register. See Section 6.2 “Output
Overcurrent” for more information.
By setting the PE1<OVTEE> bit, the HDRV and LDRV
signals will be asserted low when the OVIF flag is set.
The signals will remain low until the flag is cleared.
When the input voltage is greater than 20V, or if the
RDSON of the high-side MOSFET is such that the
programmed overcurrent threshold does not produce
acceptable peak overcurrent protection, an alternative
method must be used to determine an overcurrent
situation. An alternative technique can use the
configurable output undervoltage protection, and the
PE1<UVTEE> bit, to quickly terminate switching when
the output voltage drops because of an overcurrent
event.
Note 1: The OV DAC must be enabled by setting
the ABECON<UVDCEN> bit.
2: Interrupt flag bits are set when an
interrupt condition occurs, regardless of
the state of its corresponding enable bit
or the Global Enable bit (GIE) of the
INTCON register.
3: The output of the remote sense
comparator is compared to the OV
threshold. Therefore, the offset in this
comparator should be considered when
calculating the OV threshold.
Note 1: The OC DAC must be enabled by setting
the OCCON<OCEN> bit.
DS20002331D-page 20
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
3.8.5
The
OVERTEMPERATURE
MCP19110/11 features
Note 1: The GUI can be found on the
a
hardware
MCP19110/11
product
page
on
overtemperature shutdown protection typically set at
+160°C. No firmware fault-handling procedure is
required to shutdown the MCP19110/11 for an
overtemperature condition. The ABECON<TMPSEN>
bit must be set to enable the over temperature circuitry.
www.microchip.com.
2: Microchip's MPLAB
X Integrated
Development Environment Software is
required to use the GUI.
The MCP19110/11 device features firmware debug
support. See Section 30.0 “Development Support”
for more information.
3.9
PIC Microcontroller Core
Integrated into the MCP19110/11 is the PIC
microcontroller mid-range core. This is a fully functional
microcontroller, allowing proprietary features to be
implemented. Setting the CONFIG<CP> bit enables
the code protection. The firmware is then protected
from external reads or writes. Various status and fault
bits are available to customize the fault handling
response.
3.10 Miscellaneous Features
3.10.1
DEVICE ADDRESSING
The communication address of the MCP19110/11 is
stored in the SSPADD register. This value can be
loaded when the device firmware is programmed or
configured by external components. By reading a volt-
age on a GPIO with the ADC, a device specific address
can be stored into the SSPADD register.
A minimal amount of firmware is required to properly
configure
the
MCP19110/11.
Section 6.0
“Configuring the MCP19110/11” contains detailed
information about each register that needs to be set for
the MCP19110/11 device to operate. To aid in the
development of the required firmware, a Graphical
User Interface (GUI) has been developed. This GUI
can be used to quickly configure the MCP19110/11 for
basic operation. Customized or proprietary features
can then be added to the GUI generated firmware.
The MCP19110/11 contains a second address register,
SSPADD2. This is a 7-bit address that can be used as
the SMBus alert address when PMBus communication
is used. See Section 27.0 “Master Synchronous
Serial Port (MSSP) Module” for more information.
3.10.2
DEVICE ENABLE
A GPIO pin can be configured to be a device enable
pin. By configuring the pin as an input, the PORT
register or the interrupt on change (IOC) can be used
to enable the device. Example 3-2 shows how to
configure a GPIO as an enable pin by testing the PORT
register.
EXAMPLE 3-2:
CONFIGURING GPA3 AS DEVICE ENABLE
BANKSEL
TRISGPA
BSF
BANKSEL
TRISGPA, 3
ANSELA
;Set GPA3 as input
BCF
ANSELA, 3
;Set GPA3 as digital input
:
:
;Insert additional user code here
:
WAIT_ENABLE:
BANKSEL
BTFSS
PORTGPA
PORTGPA, 3
;Test GPA3 to see if pulled high
;A high on GPA3 indicated device to be enabled
;Stay in loop waiting for device enable
GOTO
BANKSEL
WAIT_ENABLE
ATSTCON
BSF
:
:
ATSTCON, 0
;Enable the device by enabling drivers
;Insert additional code here
:
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 21
MCP19110/11
3.10.3
OUTPUT POWER GOOD
Note 1: The ALT_CLKPIN can also be used by
setting the APFCON<CLKSEL> bit. This
function is only available in the
MCP19111.
The output voltage measured between the +VSEN and
-VSEN pins can be monitored by the internal ADC. In
firmware, when this ADC reading matches a user-
defined power good value, a GPIO can be toggled to
indicate the system output voltage is within a specified
range. Delays, hysteresis and time-out values can all
be configured in firmware.
3.10.7
MULTIPLE OUTPUT SYSTEM
In a multiple output system, the switching frequency of
each converter should be synchronized to a master
clock to prevent beat frequencies from developing.
Phase shift is often added to the master clock to help
smooth the system input current. The MCP19110/11
has the ability to function as a multiple output master or
slave by setting the appropriate MLTPH<2:0> bits in
the BUFFCON register (Register 8-2).
3.10.4
OUTPUT VOLTAGE SOFT-START
During start-up, soft start of the output voltage is
accomplished in firmware. By using one of the internal
timers and incrementing the OVCCON or OVFCON
register on a timer overflow, very long soft start times
can be achieved.
When configured as a multiple output master, the
GPA1 pin is set as the CLKPIN output function. The
internal switching frequency clock is applied to this pin
and is to be connected to the GPA1 pin of the slave
units.
3.10.5
OUTPUT VOLTAGE TRACKING
The MCP19110/11 can be configured to track another
voltage signal at start-up or shutdown. The ADC is
configured to read a GPIO that has the desired tracking
voltage applied to it. The firmware then handles the
tracking of the internal output voltage reference to this
ADC reading.
When configured as a multiple output slave, the GPA1
pin is set as the CLKPIN input function. The switching
frequency clock of the master device is connected to
this pin. Phase shift can be applied by appropriately
setting the PWMPHL register of the slave device. Refer
to Section 26.1 “Standard Pulse-Width Modulation
(PWM) Mode”.
3.10.6
MULTI-PHASE SYSTEM
In a multi-phase system, the output of each converter
is connected together. There is one master device that
sets the system switching frequency and provides each
slave device with an error signal, in order to regulate
the output to the same value.
Note 1: The ALT_CLKPIN can also be used by
setting the APFCON<CLKSEL> bit. This
function is only available in the
MCP19111.
The MCP19110/11 can be configured as a multi-phase
master or slave by the setting of the MLTPH<2:0> bits
in the BUFFCON register (Register 8-2). When set as
a multi-phase master device, the internal switching fre-
quency clock is connected to GPA1 and the output of
the error amplifier is connected to GPB1. The GPIOs
need to be configured as outputs.
3.10.8
SYSTEM BENCH TESTING
The MCP19110/11 is a highly integrated controller. To
facilitate system prototyping, various internal signals
can be measured by configuring the MCP19110/11 in
bench test mode. To accomplish this, the
ATSTCON<BNCHEN> bit is set. This configures GPA0
as the ANALOG_TEST feature. The signals measured
on GPA0 are controlled by the ASEL<4:0> bits of the
BUFFCON register. See Section 8.0 “System Bench
Testing” for more information.
When set as a multi-phase slave device, the GPA1 pin
is configured as the CLKPIN function. The switching
frequency clock from the master device must be
connected to GPA1. The slave device will synchronize
its internal switching frequency clock to the master
clock. Phase shift can be applied by setting the
PWMPHL register of the slave device. The slave GPB1
pin is configured as the error signal input pin (EAPIN).
The master error amplifier output must be connected to
GPB1. Gain can be added to the master error amplifier
output signal by the SLVGNCON register setting
(Register 6-8). The slave device will use this master
error signal to regulate the output voltage. When set as
a slave device, GPA1 and GPB1 need to be configured
as inputs. Refer to Section 26.1 “Standard Pulse-
Width Modulation (PWM) Mode” for additional
information.
Note 1: The factory-set calibration words are
write-protected
even
when
the
MCP19110/11 is placed in a Bench Test
mode.
DS20002331D-page 22
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
4.0
4.1
ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS (†)
VIN – VGND .................................................................................................................................................. -0.3V to +32V
VBOOT - VPHASE.......................................................................................................................................... -0.3V to +6.5V
VPHASE (continuous) ........................................................................................................................ GND – 0.3V to +38V
VPHASE (transient < 100 ns)............................................................................................................. GND – 5.0V to +38V
VDD internally generated...................................................................................................................................+5V ±20%
VHDRV, HDRV Pin..........................................................................................................+VPHASE – 0.3V to VBOOT + 0.3V
VLDRV, LDRV Pin............................................................................................................. +(VGND – 0.3V) to (VDD + 0.3V)
Voltage on MCLR with respect to GND.................................................................................................... -0.3V to +13.5V
Maximum Voltage: any other pin..................................................................................... +(VGND – 0.3V) to (VDD + 0.3V)
Maximum output current sunk by any single I/O pin ...............................................................................................25 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any single I/O pin..........................................................................................25 mA
Maximum current sunk by all GPIO ........................................................................................................................65 mA
Maximum current sourced by all GPIO ...................................................................................................................65 mA
ESD protection on all pins (HBM) ...........................................................................................................................1.0 kV
ESD protection on all pins (MM)100V
† Notice: Stresses above those listed under “Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. This
is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those indicated in
the operational listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for extended periods
may affect device reliability.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 23
MCP19110/11
4.2
Electrical Characteristics
Electrical Specifications: Unless otherwise noted, VIN = 12V, VREF = 1.2V, FSW = 300 kHz, TA = +25°C.
Boldface specifications apply over the TA range of -40°C to +125°C.
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
Input
Input Voltage
VIN
IQ
4.5
—
—
3
—
5
32
10
2.2
32
V
Input Quiescent Current
Shutdown Current
mA Not switching
mA Note 4
ISHDN
UVLO
1.8
—
Adjustable Input Under-
voltage Lockout Range
V
VINLVL is a LOG DAC
Input Undervoltage Lock-
out Hysteresis
UVLOHYS
—
13
—
%
Hysteresis applied to
adjustable UVLO setpoint
Overcurrent
Overcurrent Minimum
Threshold
OCMIN
OCMAX
OCMID
—
—
160
620
400
—
—
mV
mV
mV
Overcurrent Maximum
Threshold
Overcurrent Mid-Scale
Threshold
240
550
Overcurrent Step Size
OCSTEP_SIZE
LEBmin
10
15
20
mV
ns
Adjustable OC Leading
Edge Blanking Minimum
Set Point
—
114
—
Adjustable OC Leading
Edge Blanking Maximum
Set Point
LEBmax
—
780
—
ns
Current Sense
Current Sense Minimum
AC Gain
IAC_GAIN
IAC_GAIN
—
—
0
—
—
dB
dB
dB
dB
mV
dB
dB
dB
dB
Current Sense Maximum
AC Gain
22.8
11.5
1.5
Current Sense AC Gain
Mid-Set Point
IAC_GAIN
8.5
—
14
Current Sense AC Gain
Step Size
IAC_GAIN_STEP
IAC_OFFSET
IDC_GAIN
—
Current Sense AC Gain
Offset Voltage
-175
—
9
135
—
Current Sense Minimum
DC Gain
19.5
35.7
28.6
2.3
Current Sense Maximum
DC Gain
IDC_GAIN
—
—
Current Sense DC Gain
Mid-Set Point
IDC_GAIN
27
30.3
—
Current Sense DC Gain
Step Size
IDC_GAIN_STEP
—
Note 1: Ensured by design. Not production tested.
2: DD-OUT is the voltage present at the VDD pin. VDD is the internally generated bias voltage.
V
3: This is the total source current for all GPIO pins combined. Individually, each pin can source a maximum of
25 mA.
4: PE1 = 0x00h, ABECON = 0x00h, ATSTCON = 0x80h, WPUGPA = 0x00h, WPUGPB = 0x00h, and
SLEEP command issued to PIC core, see SECTION 16.0.
DS20002331D-page 24
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
4.2
Electrical Characteristics (Continued)
Electrical Specifications: Unless otherwise noted, VIN = 12V, VREF = 1.2V, FSW = 300 kHz, TA = +25°C.
Boldface specifications apply over the TA range of -40°C to +125°C.
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
Current Sense DC Gain
Offset Voltage
IDC_OFFSET
1.4
1.56
1.7
V
Voltage for Zero Current
Voltage Reference
VZC
—
1.45
—
—
V
V
VZCCON = 0x80h
Adjustable VOUT Range
VOUT_RANGE
0.5
3.6
VOUT range with no external
voltage divider
V
OUT Coarse Resolution
OUT Coarse
VOUT_COARSE
10.8
1.85
15.8
2.04
25.8
2.25
mV
V
V
V
OUT_COARSE_MID
Mid Set Point
VOUT Fine Resolution
VOUT_FINE
—
0.8
1
mV
Output Overvoltage
Adjustable Overvoltage
Range
OVRANGE
OVMID
OVR
0
—
2
4.5
2.3
—
V
V
Adjustable Overvoltage
Mid-Set Point
1.8
—
Adjustable Overvoltage
Resolution
15
mV
Output Undervoltage
Adjustable
Undervoltage Range
UVRANGE
UVMID
UVR
0
—
2
4.5
2.3
—
Adjustable Undervoltage
Mid-Set Point
1.8
—
V
Adjustable Undervoltage
Resolution
15
mV
Remote Sense Differential Amplifier
Closed Loop Voltage
Gain
AVOL
0.95
1
1.05
V/V
GND – 0.3
—
V
+ 1.0
Common Mode Range
VCMR
—
V
Note 1
DD
Common Mode
Reject Ratio
CMRR
57
—
—
dB
Differential Amplifier
Offset
VOS
—
40
mV See Section 9.5 “Calibration
Word 5” and Section 9.6
“Calibration Word 6”
Compensation
Minimum Zero Frequency
Maximum Zero Frequency
FZERO_MIN
FZERO_MAX
GEA_MIN
—
—
—
350
35000
0
—
—
—
Hz
Hz
dB
Minimum Error Amplifier
Gain
Maximum Error Amplifier
Gain
GEA_MAX
—
36.15
—
dB
Note 1: Ensured by design. Not production tested.
2: DD-OUT is the voltage present at the VDD pin. VDD is the internally generated bias voltage.
V
3: This is the total source current for all GPIO pins combined. Individually, each pin can source a maximum of
25 mA.
4: PE1 = 0x00h, ABECON = 0x00h, ATSTCON = 0x80h, WPUGPA = 0x00h, WPUGPB = 0x00h, and
SLEEP command issued to PIC core, see SECTION 16.0.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 25
MCP19110/11
4.2
Electrical Characteristics (Continued)
Electrical Specifications: Unless otherwise noted, VIN = 12V, VREF = 1.2V, FSW = 300 kHz, TA = +25°C.
Boldface specifications apply over the TA range of -40°C to +125°C.
Parameter
Oscillator
Symbol
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
Internal Oscillator
Frequency
FOSC
7.60
8.00
8.40
MHz
kHz
Switching Frequency
FSW
N
—
FOSC/N
—
—
Switching Frequency
Range Select
5
80
Maximum Duty Cycle
—
—
(N–1)/N
4
—
—
%/
100
Dead Time Adjustment
Dead Time Step Size
HDRV Output Driver
DTSTEP
ns
HDRV Source
Resistance
RHDRV-SCR
—
—
—
—
1
2
1
2
2.6
3.5
2.6
3.5
Measured at 500 mA
Note 1, High Range
Measured at 500 mA
Note 1, Low Range
HDRV Sink Resistance
RHDRV-SINK
Measured at 500 mA
Note 1, High Range
Measured at 500 mA
Note 1, Low Range
HDRV Source Current
HDRV Sink Current
IHDRV-SCR
IHDRV-SINK
—
—
—
—
—
2
1
—
—
—
—
30
A
A
A
A
Note 1, High Range
Note 1, Low Range
Note 1, High Range
Note 1, Low Range
2
1
HDRV Rise Time
HDRV Fall Time
15
ns Note 1, CLOAD = 3.3 nF,
High Range
tRH
tFH
—
15
30
ns Note 1, CLOAD = 3.3 nF,
High Range
LDRV Output Driver
LDRV
Source Resistance
RLDRV-SCR
RLDRV-SINK
—
—
1
2.5
1.0
Measured at 500 mA
Note 1
LDRV Sink Resistance
0.5
Measured at 500 mA
Note 1
LDRV Source Current
LDRV Sink Current
LDRV Rise Time
ILDRV-SCR
ILDRV-SINK
tRL
—
—
—
—
2
4
—
—
30
15
A
A
Note 1
Note 1
15
7
ns Note 1, CLOAD = 3.3 nF
ns Note 1, CLOAD = 3.3 nF
LDRV Fall Time
tFL
Note 1: Ensured by design. Not production tested.
2: DD-OUT is the voltage present at the VDD pin. VDD is the internally generated bias voltage.
V
3: This is the total source current for all GPIO pins combined. Individually, each pin can source a maximum of
25 mA.
4: PE1 = 0x00h, ABECON = 0x00h, ATSTCON = 0x80h, WPUGPA = 0x00h, WPUGPB = 0x00h, and
SLEEP command issued to PIC core, see SECTION 16.0.
DS20002331D-page 26
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
4.2
Electrical Characteristics (Continued)
Electrical Specifications: Unless otherwise noted, VIN = 12V, VREF = 1.2V, FSW = 300 kHz, TA = +25°C.
Boldface specifications apply over the TA range of -40°C to +125°C.
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
Linear Regulator
Bias Voltage, LDO Output
VDD
4.6
—
5.0
5.0
5.4
—
V
V
VIN = 6.0V to 32V, Note 2
VIN = 6.0V to 32V, Note 2
Internal Circuitry
Bias Voltage
AVDD
Maximum VDD Output
Current
IDD
30
—
—
mA VIN = 6.0V to 20V,
VDD = 5.0V,
Note 2
Line Regulation
Load Regulation
VDD
(VDD x VIN)
/
—
-1.75
—
0.05
-0.8
65
0.1
+0.5
—
%/V (VDD+1.0V) VIN 20V
Note 2
VDD/VDD
%
IDD = 1 mA to 30 mA
Note 2
Output Short
Circuit Current
IDD_SC
mA VIN = (VDD + 1.0V)
Note 2
Dropout Voltage
VIN – VDD
—
0.5
1
V
IDD = 30 mA,
VIN = VDD + 1.0V
Note 2
Power Supply
Rejection Ratio
PSRRLDO
BG
—
60
—
dB f 1000 Hz, IDD = 25 mA,
CIN = 0 µF, CDD = 1 µF
V
Band Gap Voltage
-2.5%
1.23
+2.5%
GPIO Pins
Maximum GPIO
Sink Current
ISINK_GPIO
ISOURCE_GPIO
IPULL-UP_GPIO
VOL
—
—
50
—
—
—
90
90
mA Note 3, Note 1
mA Note 3, Note 1
µA VDD = 5V
Maximum GPIO
Source Current
GPIO Weak
Pull-up Current
250
—
400
0.6
GPIO Output Low
Voltage
V
V
IOL = 7 mA, VDD= 5V,
TA = +90°C
GPIO Output
High Voltage
VOH
VDD – 0.7
—
—
—
IOH = -2.5 mA, VDD = 5V,
TA = +90°C
GPIO Input
Leakage Current
GPIO_IIL
±0.1
±1
µA Negative current is defined as
current sourced by the pin,
TA = +90°C
GPIO Input Low Voltage
VIL
GND
GND
—
0.8
V
I/O Port with TTL buffer
VDD = 5V, TA = +90°C
0.2VDD
V
I/O Port with Schmitt Trigger
buffer, VDD = 5V, TA = +90°C
GND
0.2VDD
V
MCLR, TA = +90°C
Note 1: Ensured by design. Not production tested.
2: DD-OUT is the voltage present at the VDD pin. VDD is the internally generated bias voltage.
V
3: This is the total source current for all GPIO pins combined. Individually, each pin can source a maximum of
25 mA.
4: PE1 = 0x00h, ABECON = 0x00h, ATSTCON = 0x80h, WPUGPA = 0x00h, WPUGPB = 0x00h, and
SLEEP command issued to PIC core, see SECTION 16.0.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 27
MCP19110/11
4.2
Electrical Characteristics (Continued)
Electrical Specifications: Unless otherwise noted, VIN = 12V, VREF = 1.2V, FSW = 300 kHz, TA = +25°C.
Boldface specifications apply over the TA range of -40°C to +125°C.
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
Conditions
GPIO Input High Voltage
VIH
2.0
—
VDD
V
I/O Port with TTL buffer,
VDD = 5V, TA = +90°C
0.8VDD
0.8VDD
—
—
VDD
VDD
V
V
I/O Port with Schmitt Trigger
buffer, VDD = 5V, TA = +90°C
MCLR, TA = +90°C
Thermal Shutdown
Thermal Shutdown
TSHD
—
—
160
20
—
—
°C
°C
Thermal Shutdown
Hysteresis
TSHD_HYS
Note 1: Ensured by design. Not production tested.
2: DD-OUT is the voltage present at the VDD pin. VDD is the internally generated bias voltage.
V
3: This is the total source current for all GPIO pins combined. Individually, each pin can source a maximum of
25 mA.
4: PE1 = 0x00h, ABECON = 0x00h, ATSTCON = 0x80h, WPUGPA = 0x00h, WPUGPB = 0x00h, and
SLEEP command issued to PIC core, see SECTION 16.0.
4.3
Thermal Specifications
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
Test Conditions
Temperature Ranges
Specified Temperature Range
Operating Temperature Range
Maximum Junction Temperature
Storage Temperature Range
Thermal Package Resistances
Thermal Resistance, 24L-QFN 4x4
Thermal Resistance, 28L-QFN 5x5
TA
TA
TJ
TA
-40
-40
—
—
—
—
—
+125
+125
+150
+150
C
C
C
C
-65
JA
JA
—
—
42
—
—
C/W
C/W
35.3
DS20002331D-page 28
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
5.0
5.1
DIGITAL ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Timing Parameter Symbology
The timing parameter symbols have been created with
one of the following formats:
1. TppS2ppS
2. TppS
T
3. TCC:ST
4. Ts
(I2C specifications only)
(I2C specifications only)
F
Frequency
TTime
Lowercase letters (pp) and their meanings:
pp
cc
ck
cs
di
CCP1
CLKOUT
CS
osc
rd
OSC1
RD
rw
sc
ss
t0
RD or WR
SCK
SDI
do
dt
SDO
SS
Data in
I/O port
MCLR
T0CKI
T1CKI
WR
io
t1
mc
wr
Uppercase letters and their meanings:
S
F
Fall
P
R
V
Z
Period
H
High
Rise
I
Invalid (high-impedance)
Low
Valid
L
High-impedance
I2C only
AA
Output access
Bus free
High
Low
High
Low
BUF
TCC:ST (I2C specifications only)
CC
HD
Hold
SU
Setup
ST
DAT
STA
DATA input hold
START condition
STO
STOP condition
FIGURE 5-1:
LOAD CONDITIONS
Load Condition 1
VDD/2
Load Condition 2
RL
CL
CL
Pin
Pin
VSS
VSS
RL = 464
CL = 50 pF for all GPIO pins
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 29
MCP19110/11
5.2
AC Characteristics: MCP19110/11 (Industrial, Extended)
FIGURE 5-2:
EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
OSC
1
2
TABLE 5-1:
EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Param No. Sym.
Characteristic
Min. Typ.†
Max. Units
Conditions
FOSC
Oscillator Frequency(1)
Oscillator Period(1)
Instruction Cycle Time(1)
—
—
—
8
—
—
—
MHz
ns
1
2
*
TOSC
TCY
250
1000
ns
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in “Typ” column is at VIN = 12V (VDD = 5V), +25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for
design guidance only and are not tested.
Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values
are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions
with the device executing code.
FIGURE 5-3:
CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING
Q1
Q4
Q2
Q3
OSC
22
23
19
18
I/O Pin
(input)
15
17
I/O Pin
(output)
new value
old value
20, 21
DS20002331D-page 30
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 5-2:
CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Sym. Characteristic Min.
Param
No.
Typ.†
Max.
Units Conditions
17
TosH2ioV OSC1 (Q1 cycle) to
Port out valid
—
—
50
—
—
150*
300
—
ns
ns
ns
18
19
TosH2ioI OSC1 (Q2 cycle) to Port input invalid
100
(I/O in hold time)
TioV2osH Port input valid to OSC1
0
—
—
ns
(I/O in setup time)
20
21
TioR
TioF
Tinp
Port output rise time
Port output fall time
—
—
10
10
40
40
ns
ns
22
22A
INT pin high
or low time
25
40
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
23
23A
Trbp
Trbp
Port A change INT
high or low time
Tcy
—
—
ns
*
†
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
Data in “Typ” column is at VIN = 12V (VDD = 5V), +25C unless otherwise stated.
FIGURE 5-4:
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND POWER-UP
TIMER TIMING
VDD
MCLR
30
Internal
POR
33
PWRT
Time-out
32
OSC
Time-out
Internal
Reset
Watchdog
Timer
Reset
31
34
34
I/O Pins
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 31
MCP19110/11
TABLE 5-3:
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, AND POWER-UP
TIMER REQUIREMENTS
Param
No.
Sym.
Characteristic
Min.
Typ.†
Max. Units
Conditions
30
31
TMCL
TWDT
MCLR Pulse Width (low)
2
7
—
—
µs
VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C
Watchdog Timer Time-out
Period (No Prescaler)
18
33
ms VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C
32
TOST
Oscillation Start-up Timer
Period
—
1024TOSC
64
—
—
TOSC = OSC1 period
33*
TPWRT
Power-up Timer Period
28
132
ms VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C
µs
(4 x TWDT
)
34
TIOZ
I/O high-impedance from MCLR
Low or Watchdog Timer Reset
—
—
2.0
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in “Typ” column is at VIN = 12V (VDD = 5V), +25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for
design guidance only and are not tested.
FIGURE 5-5:
TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMINGS
T0CKI
41
40
42
TABLE 5-4:
TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK REQUIREMENTS
Param
No.
Sym.
Characteristic
T0CKI High Pulse Width
Min.
Typ.† Max. Units
Conditions
40*
Tt0H
Tt0L
Tt0P
No Prescaler
With Prescaler
No Prescaler
With Prescaler
0.5TCY + 20
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
10
0.5TCY + 20
10
41*
42*
T0CKI Low Pulse Width
T0CKI Period
Greater of:
20 or TCY + 40
N
N = prescale value
(2, 4, ..., 256)
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in “Typ” column is at VIN = 12V (VDD = 5V), +25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for
design guidance only and are not tested.
DS20002331D-page 32
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 5-6:
PWM TIMING
PWM (CLKPIN)
53
54
Note:
Refer to Figure 5-1 for load conditions.
TABLE 5-5:
Param
PWM REQUIREMENTS
Characteristic
Sym.
Min.
Typ.† Max. Units
Conditions
No.
53*
54*
TccR
TccF
PWM (CLKPIN) output rise time
PWM (CLKPIN) output fall time
—
—
10
10
25
25
ns
ns
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in “Typ” column is at VIN = 12V (VDD = 5V), +25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design
guidance only and are not tested.
TABLE 5-6:
MCP19110/11 A/D CONVERTER (ADC) CHARACTERISTICS:
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C TA +125°C
Param
Sym.
No.
Characteristic
Min.
Typ.†
Max.
Units
Conditions
AD01
AD02
AD03
NR Resolution
EIL Integral Error
—
—
—
—
—
—
10
1
1
bit
LSb AVDD = 5.0V
EDL Differential Error
LSb No missing codes to 10 bits
AVDD = 5.0V
AD04
AD07
EOFF Offset Error
—
—
—
+3.0
2
+5.0
5
LSb AVDD = 5.0V
LSb AVDD = 5.0V
V
EGN Gain Error
VREF Reference Voltage(3)
AD06
AVDD
—
AD06A
AD07
AD08
VAIN Full-Scale Range
GND
—
—
—
AVDD
10
V
ZAIN Recommended Impedance
of Analog Voltage Source
k
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in ‘Typ’ column is at VIN = 12V (VDD = 5V), +25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for
design guidance only and are not tested.
Note 1: Total Absolute Error includes integral, differential, offset and gain errors.
2: The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage and has no missing
codes.
3: When ADC is off, it will not consume any current other than leakage current. The power-down current
specification includes any such leakage from the ADC module.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 33
MCP19110/11
TABLE 5-7:
MCP19110/11 A/D CONVERSION REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C TA +125°C
Param
Sym.
No.
Characteristic
Min.
Typ.†
Max. Units
Conditions
AD130* TAD
A/D Clock Period
A/D Internal RC Oscillator
Period
AD131 TCNV Conversion Time
3.0
1.6
—
9.0
6.0
µs TOSC-based, VDD = 5.0V
µs At VDD = 5.0V
4.0
—
11
—
TAD Set GO/DONE bit to new data in
A/D Result register
(not including Acquisition
Time)(1)
AD132* TACQ Acquisition Time
AD133* TAMP Amplifier Settling Time
AD134 TGO Q4 to A/D Clock Start
11.5
—
—
5
µs
µs
—
—
—
TOSC/2
—
—
TOSC
2 + TCY
/
—
—
If the A/D clock source is selected
as RC, a time of TCY is added
before the A/D clock starts. This
allows the SLEEPinstruction to be
executed.
*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
†
Data in ‘Typ’ column is at VIN = 12V (VDD = 5V), +25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for
design guidance only and are not tested.
Note 1: ADRESH and ADRESL registers may be read on the following TCY cycle.
FIGURE 5-7: A/D CONVERSION TIMING (NORMAL MODE)
BSF ADCON0, GO
134
1/2 TCY
131
Q4
130
A/D CLK
9
8
7
6
3
2
1
0
A/D DATA
OLD_DATA
NEW_DATA
ADRES
ADIF
GO
DONE
SAMPLING STOPPED
132
SAMPLE
Note 1: If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This
allows the SLEEPinstruction to be executed.
DS20002331D-page 34
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 5-8:
A/D CONVERSION TIMING (SLEEP MODE)
BSF ADCON0, GO
134
131
Q4
130
A/D CLK
9
8
7
3
2
1
0
6
A/D DATA
NEW_DATA
DONE
OLD_DATA
ADRES
ADIF
GO
SAMPLING STOPPED
132
SAMPLE
Note 1: If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This
allows the SLEEPinstruction to be executed.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 35
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 36
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
The VINLVL<UVLOEN> bit must be set to enable the
input Undervoltage Lockout circuitry.
6.0
CONFIGURING THE
MCP19110/11
The MCP19110/11 is an analog controller with digital
peripheral. This means that device configuration is
handled through register settings instead of adding
external components. The following sections detail how
to set the analog control registers.
Note:
The VINIF interrupt flag bit is set when an
interrupt condition occurs, regardless of
the state of its corresponding enable bit or
the Global Enable bit, GIE, of the INTCON
register.
6.1
Input Undervoltage Lockout
The VINLVL register contains the digital value that sets
the input Undervoltage Lockout. When the input
voltage on the VIN pin to the MCP19110/11 is below this
programmed level, the INTCON<VINIF> flag will be
set. This bit is automatically cleared when the
MCP19110/11 VIN voltage rises above this
programmed level.
REGISTER 6-1:
VINLVL: INPUT UNDERVOLTAGE LOCKOUT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
UVLOEN
bit 7
U-0
—
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
UVLO5
UVLO4
UVLO3
UVLO2
UVLO1
UVLO0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
UVLOEN: Undervoltage Lockout DAC Control bit
1= Undervoltage Lockout DAC is enabled
0= Undervoltage Lockout DAC is disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-0
UVLO<5:0>: Undervoltage Lockout Configuration bits
UVLO<5:0>= 26.5*ln(UVLOSET_POINT/4)
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 37
MCP19110/11
6.2
Output Overcurrent
The MCP19110/11 features a cycle-by-cycle peak
current limit. By monitoring the OCIF interrupt flag,
custom overcurrent fault handling can be implemented.
To detect an output overcurrent, the MCP19110/11
senses the voltage drop across the high-side MOSFET
while it is conducting. Leading edge blanking is
incorporated to mask the overcurrent measurement for
a given amount of time. This helps prevent false
overcurrent readings. When the input voltage is greater
than 20V, or if the RDSON of the high-side MOSFET is
such that the programmed overcurrent threshold does
not produce acceptable peak overcurrent protection,
an alternative method must be used to determine an
output overcurrent situation. An alternative technique
can use the configurable output undervoltage
protection and the PE1<UVTEE> bit to quickly
terminate switching when the output voltage drops
because of an overcurrent event.
When an output overcurrent is sensed, the OCIF flag is
set and the high-side drive signal is immediately
terminated. Without any custom overcurrent handling
implemented, the high-side drive signal will be asserted
high at the beginning of the next clock cycle. If the
overcurrent condition still exists, the high-drive signal
will again be terminated.
The OCIF interrupt flag must be cleared in software.
However, if a subsequent switching cycle without an
overcurrent condition has not occurred, hardware will
immediately set the OCIF interrupt flag.
Register OCCON contains the bits used to configure
both the output overcurrent limit and the amount of
leading edge blanking (see Register 6-2).
The OCCON<OCEN> bit must be set to enable the
input overcurrent circuitry.
Note:
The OCIF interrupt flag bit is set when an
interrupt condition occurs, regardless of
the state of its corresponding enable bit or
the Global Enable bit, GIE, of the INTCON
register.
DS20002331D-page 38
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 6-2:
OCCON: OUTPUT OVERCURRENT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
OCEN
bit 7
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
OOC4
R/W-x
OOC3
R/W-x
OOC2
R/W-x
OOC1
R/W-x
OOC0
OCLEB1
OCLEB0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
OCEN: Output Overcurrent DAC Control bit
1= Output Overcurrent DAC is enabled
0= Output Overcurrent DAC is disabled
bit 6-5
OCLEB<1:0>: Leading Edge Blanking
00= 114 ns blanking
01= 213 ns blanking
10= 400 ns blanking
11= 780 ns blanking
bit 4-0
OOC<4:0>: Output Overcurrent Configuration bits
00000= 160 mV drop
00001= 175 mV drop
00010= 190 mV drop
00011= 205 mV drop
00100= 220 mV drop
00101= 235 mV drop
00110= 250 mV drop
00111= 265 mV drop
01000= 280 mV drop
01001= 295 mV drop
01010= 310 mV drop
01011= 325 mV drop
01100= 340 mV drop
01101= 355 mV drop
01110= 370 mV drop
01111= 385 mV drop
10000= 400 mV drop
10001= 415 mV drop
10010= 430 mV drop
10011= 445 mV drop
10100= 460 mV drop
10101= 475 mV drop
10110= 490 mV drop
10111= 505 mV drop
11000= 520 mV drop
11001= 535 mV drop
11010= 550 mV drop
11011= 565 mV drop
11100= 580 mV drop
11101= 595 mV drop
11110= 610 mV drop
11111= 625 mV drop
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 39
MCP19110/11
6.3
Current Sense AC Gain
The current measured across the inductor is a square
wave that is averaged by the capacitor (CS) connected
between +ISEN and -ISEN. This very small voltage plus
the ripple can be amplified by the current sense AC
gain circuitry. The amount of gain is controlled by the
CSGSCON register.
REGISTER 6-3:
CSGSCON: CURRENT SENSE AC GAIN CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
CSGS3
CSGS2
CSGS1
CSGS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
bit 3-0
Reserved
CSGS<3:0>: Current Sense AC Gain Setting bits
0000= 0 dB
0001= 1.0 dB
0010= 2.5 dB
0011= 4.0 dB
0100= 5.5 dB
0101= 7.0 dB
0110= 8.5 dB
0111= 10.0 dB
1000= 11.5 dB
1001= 13.0 dB
1010= 14.5 dB
1011= 16.0 dB
1100= 17.5 dB
1101= 19.0 dB
1110= 20.5 dB
1111= 22.0 dB
DS20002331D-page 40
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
6.4
Current Sense DC Gain
DC gain can be added to the sensed inductor current to
allow it to be read by the ADC. The amount of DC gain
added is controlled by the CSDGCON register.
Adding DC gain to the current sense signal used by the
control loop may also be needed in some multi-phase
systems to account for device and component
differences. The CSDGEN bit determines if the gained
current sense signal is added back to the AC current
signal (see Register 6-4). If the CSDGEN bit is cleared,
DC gain can still be added, but the gained signal is not
added back to the AC current signal.
REGISTER 6-4:
CSDGCON: CURRENT SENSE DC GAIN CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
CSDGEN
bit 7
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
Reserved
CSDG2
CSDG1
CSDG0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
CSDGEN: Current Sense DC Gain Enable bit
1= DC gain current sense signal used in control loop.
0= DC gain current sense signal only read by ADC.
bit 6-4
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Reserved
bit 2-0
CSDG<2:0>: Current Sense DC Gain Setting bits
000= 19.5 dB
001= 21.8 dB
010= 24.1 dB
011= 26.3 dB
100= 28.6 dB
101= 30.9 dB
110= 33.2 dB
111= 35.7 dB
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 41
MCP19110/11
6.5
Voltage for Zero Current
In multi-phase systems it may be necessary to provide
some offset to the sensed inductor current. The
VZCCON register can be used to provide a positive or
negative offset in the sensed current. Typically, the
VZCCON will be set to 0x80h, which corresponds to
the sensed inductor current centered around 1.45V.
However, by adjusting the VZCCON register, this
centered voltage can be shifted up or down by
approximately 3.28 mV per step.
REGISTER 6-5:
VZCCON: VOLTAGE FOR ZERO CURRENT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
VZC7
R/W-x
VZC6
R/W-x
VZC5
R/W-x
VZC4
R/W-x
VZC3
R/W-x
VZC2
R/W-x
VZC1
R/W-x
VZC0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-0
VZC<7:0>: Voltage for Zero Current Setting bits
00000000= -420.00 mV Offset
00000001= -416.72 mV Offset
•
•
•
10000000= 0 mV Offset
•
•
•
11111110= +413.12 mV Offset
11111111= +416.40 mV Offset
DS20002331D-page 42
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 6-1:
SIMPLIFIED
COMPENSATION
6.6
Compensation Setting
The MCP19110/11 uses a peak current mode control
architecture. A control reference is used to regulate the
peak current of the converter directly. The inner current
loop essentially turns the inductor into a voltage-
controlled current source. This reduces the control-to-
output transfer function to a simple single-pole model of
a current source feeding a capacitor. The desired
response of the overall loop can be tuned by proper
placement of the compensation zero frequency and
gain. Figure 6-1 shows a simplified drawing of the
internal compensation. See Register 6-6 for the
adjustable zero frequency and gain settings.
+VSEN
-VSEN
VREF
REGISTER 6-6:
CMPZCON: COMPENSATION SETTING CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
CMPZF3
bit 7
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
CMPZF2
CMPZF1
CMPZF0
CMPZG3
CMPZG2
CMPZG1
CMPZG0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
CMPZF<3:0>: Compensation Zero Frequency Setting bits
0000= 1500 Hz
0001= 1850 Hz
0010= 2300 Hz
0011= 2840 Hz
0100= 3460 Hz
0101= 4300 Hz
0110= 5300 Hz
0111= 6630 Hz
1000= 8380 Hz
1001= 9950 Hz
1010= 12200 Hz
1011= 14400 Hz
1100= 18700 Hz
1101= 23000 Hz
1110= 28400 Hz
1111= 35300 Hz
bit 3-0
CMPZG<3:0>: Compensation Gain Setting bits
0000= 36.15 dB
0001= 33.75 dB
0010= 30.68 dB
0011= 28.43 dB
0100= 26.10 dB
0101= 23.81 dB
0110= 21.44 dB
0111= 19.10 dB
1000= 16.78 dB
1001= 14.32 dB
1010= 12.04 dB
1011= 9.54 dB
1100= 7.23 dB
1101= 4.61 dB
1110= 2.28 dB
1111= 0.00 dB
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 43
MCP19110/11
The amount of negative slope added to the error ampli-
fier output is controlled by Register 6-7.
6.7
Slope Compensation
A negative voltage slope is added to the output of the
error amplifier. This is done to prevent subharmonic
instability when:
The slope compensation is enabled by setting the
SLCPBY bit in the ABECON register.
1. the operating duty cycle is greater than 50%
2. wide changes in the duty cycle occur.
REGISTER 6-7:
SLPCRCON: SLOPE COMPENSATION RAMP CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
SLPG3
bit 7
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
SLPG2
SLPG1
SLPG0
SLPS3
SLPS2
SLPS1
SLPS0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
SLPG<3:0>: Slope Compensation Amplitude Configuration bits
0000= 0.017 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
0001= 0.022 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
0010= 0.030 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
0011= 0.040 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
0100= 0.053 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
0101= 0.070 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
0110= 0.094 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
0111= 0.125 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
1000= 0.170 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
1001= 0.220 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
1010= 0.300 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
1011= 0.400 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
1100= 0.530 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
1101= 0.700 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
1110= 0.940 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
1111= 1.250 VPK-PK, measured for 50% duty cycle waveform
bit 3-0
6.7.1
SLPS<3:0>: Slope Compensation V/t Configuration bits
SLPS<3:0> CONFIGURATION
6.7.2
SLPG<3:0> CONFIGURATION
The SLPS<3:0> directly controls the V/t of the
added ramp. This byte should be set proportional to
the switching frequency according to the following
equation:
The SLPG<3:0> controls the amplitude of the added
ramp. The values listed above correspond to a 50%
duty cycle waveform and is true only if the SLPS<3:0>
bits are set according to the equation in Section 6.7.1
“SLPS<3:0> Configuration”. If less amplitude is
required, the SLPS<3:0> bits can be adjusted to a
lower switching frequency.
EQUATION 6-1:
FSW
--------------------
n =
– 1
100 000
Where:
FSW = Device switching frequency
n = Decimal equivalent of SLPS<3:0>
DS20002331D-page 44
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
6.8
MASTER Error Signal Gain
Note:
The SLVGNCON register is configured in
the multi-phase SLAVE device.
When operating in a multi-phase system, the output of
the MASTER’s error amplifier is used by all SLAVE
devices as their control signal. It is important to balance
the current in all phases to maintain a uniform
temperature across all phases. Component tolerances
make this balancing difficult. Each SLAVE device has
the ability to gain or attenuate the MASTER error signal
depending upon the settings of Register 6-8.
REGISTER 6-8:
SLVGNCON: MASTER ERROR SIGNAL INPUT GAIN CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
SLVGN4
SLVGN3
SLVGN2
SLVGN1
SLVGN0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
bit 4-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
SLVGN<4:0>: MASTER Error Signal Gain bits
00000= -3.3 dB
00001= -3.1 dB
00010= -2.9 dB
00011= -2.7 dB
00100= -2.5 dB
00101= -2.3 dB
00110= -2.1 dB
00111= -1.9 dB
01000= -1.7 dB
01001= -1.4 dB
01010= -1.2 dB
01011= -1.0 dB
01100= -0.8 dB
01101= -0.6 dB
01110= -0.4 dB
01111= -0.2 dB
10000= 0.0 dB
10001= 0.2 dB
10010= 0.4dB
10011= 0.7 dB
10100= 0.9 dB
10101= 1.1 dB
10110= 1.3 dB
10111= 1.5 dB
11000= 1.7 dB
11001= 1.9 dB
11010= 2.1 dB
11011= 2.3 dB
11100= 2.6 dB
11101= 2.8 dB
11110= 3.0 dB
11111= 3.2 dB
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 45
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 6-2:
MOSFET DRIVER
DEAD TIME
6.9
MOSFET Driver Programmable
Dead Time
The turn-on delay of the high-side and low-side drive
signals can be configured independently to allow differ-
ent MOSFETs and circuit board layouts to be used to
construct an optimized system. See Figure 6-2.
HDRV
HDLY
Setting the HDLYBY and LDLYBY bits of the PE1
register enables the high-side and low-side delay,
respectively. The amount of delay added is controlled
in the DEADCON register. See Register 6-9 for more
information.
LDLY
LDRV
REGISTER 6-9:
DEADCON: DRIVER DEAD TIME CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
HDLY3
bit 7
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
LDLY3
R/W-x
LDLY2
R/W-x
LDLY1
R/W-x
LDLY0
HDLY2
HDLY1
HDLY0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
HDLY<3:0>: High-Side Dead Time Configuration bits
0000= 11 ns delay
0001= 15 ns delay
0010= 19 ns delay
0011= 23 ns delay
0100= 27 ns delay
0101= 31 ns delay
0110= 35 ns delay
0111= 39 ns delay
1000= 43 ns delay
1001= 47 ns delay
1010= 51 ns delay
1011= 55 ns delay
1100= 59 ns delay
1101= 63 ns delay
1110= 67 ns delay
1111= 71 ns delay
bit 3-0
LDLY<3:0>: Low-Side Dead Time Configuration bits
0000= 4 ns delay
0001= 8 ns delay
0010= 12 ns delay
0011= 16 ns delay
0100= 20 ns delay
0101= 24 ns delay
0110= 28 ns delay
0111= 32 ns delay
1000= 36 ns delay
1001= 40 ns delay
1010= 44 ns delay
1011= 48 ns delay
1100= 52 ns delay
1101= 56 ns delay
1110= 60 ns delay
1111= 64 ns delay
DS20002331D-page 46
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
6.10 Output Voltage Configuration
Note:
Note:
The OVFCON<VOUTEN> bit must be set
to enable the output voltage setting
registers.
Two registers control the error amplifier reference
voltage. The reference is coarsely set in 15 mV steps
and then finely adjusted in 0.82 mV steps above the
coarse setting (see Registers 6-10 and 6-11). Higher
output voltages can be achieved by using a voltage
divider connected between the output and the +VSEN
pin. Care must be taken to ensure maximum voltage
rating compliance on all pins.
The units for the OVC<7:0> and
OVF<4:0> equations are volts.
REGISTER 6-10: OVCCON: OUTPUT VOLTAGE SET POINT COARSE CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
OVC7
R/W-0
OVC6
R/W-0
OVC5
R/W-0
OVC4
R/W-0
OVC3
R/W-0
OVC2
R/W-0
OVC1
R/W-0
OVC0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-0
OVC<7:0>: Output Voltage Set Point Coarse Configuration bits (Note)
OVC<7:0>= (VOUT/0.0158)-1
REGISTER 6-11: OVFCON: OUTPUT VOLTAGE SET POINT FINE CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
OVF4
R/W-0
OVF3
R/W-0
OVF2
R/W-0
OVF1
R/W-0
OVF0
VOUTEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
VOUTEN: Output Voltage DAC Enable bit
1= Output Voltage DAC is enabled
0= Output Voltage DAC is disabled
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-5
bit 4-0
OVF<4:0>: Output Voltage Set Point Fine Configuration bits (Note)
OVF<4:0>= (VOUT – VOUT_COARSE)/0.0008
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 47
MCP19110/11
6.11 Output Undervoltage
Note:
The units for the OUV<7:0> equation are
volts.
The output voltage is monitored, and when it is below
the output undervoltage threshold, the UVIF flag is set.
This flag must be cleared in software. See
Section 15.3.1.4 “PIR2 Register” for more
information.
The output undervoltage threshold is controlled by the
OUVCON register, as shown in Register 6-12.
REGISTER 6-12: OUVCON: OUTPUT UNDERVOLTAGE DETECT LEVEL CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
OUV7
R/W-x
OUV6
R/W-x
OUV5
R/W-x
OUV4
R/W-x
OUV3
R/W-x
OUV2
R/W-x
OUV1
R/W-x
OUV0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-0
OUV<7:0>: Output Undervoltage Detect Level Configuration bits
OUV<7:0>= (VOUT_UV_Detect_Level)/0.015
6.12 Output Overvoltage
Note:
The units for the OOV<7:0> equation are
volts.
The output voltage is monitored, and when it is above
the output overvoltage threshold, the OVIF flag is set.
This flag must be cleared in software. See
Section 15.3.1.4 “PIR2 Register” for more
information.
The output overvoltage threshold is controlled by the
OOVCON register, as shown in Register 6-13.
REGISTER 6-13: OOVCON: OUTPUT OVERVOLTAGE DETECT LEVEL CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-x
OOV7
R/W-x
OOV6
R/W-x
OOV5
R/W-x
OOV4
R/W-x
OOV3
R/W-x
OOV2
R/W-x
OOV1
R/W-x
OOV0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-0
OOV<7:0>: Output Overvoltage Detect Level Configuration bits
OOV<7:0>= (VOUT_OV_Detect_Level)/0.015
DS20002331D-page 48
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
6.13.4
OUTPUT VOLTAGE SENSE
PULL-UP/PULL-DOWN
6.13 Analog Peripheral Control
The MCP19110/11 has various analog peripherals.
These peripherals can be configured to allow custom-
izable operation. Refer to Register 6-14 more informa-
tion.
A high-impedance pull-up on the +VSEN pin can be
configured by setting the PE1<PUEN> bit. When set,
the +VSEN pin is internally pulled-up to VDD
.
A high-impedance pull-down on the -VSEN can be
configured by setting the PE1<PDEN> bit. When set,
the -VSEN pin is internally pulled-down to ground.
6.13.1
DIODE EMULATION MODE
The MCP19110/11 can operate in either diode
emulation or synchronous rectification mode. When
operating in diode emulation mode, the LDRV signal is
terminated when the voltage across the low-side
MOSFET is approximately 0V. This condition is true
when the inductor current reaches approximately 0A.
Both the HDRV and LDRV signals are low until the
beginning of the next switching cycle. At that time, the
HDRV signal is asserted high, turning on the high-side
MOSFET.
6.13.5
OUTPUT UNDERVOLTAGE
ACCELERATOR
The MCP19110/11 has additional control circuitry to
allow it to respond quickly to an output undervoltage
condition. The enabling of this circuitry is handled by
the PE1<UVTEE> bit. When this bit is set, the
MCP19110/11 will respond to an output undervoltage
condition by setting both the HDRV and LDRV signals
low and turning off both the high-side and low-side
MOSFETs.
When operating in Synchronous Rectification mode,
the LDRV signal is held high until the beginning of the
next switching cycle. At that time, the HDRV signal is
asserted high, turning on the high-side MOSFET.
6.13.6
OUTPUT OVERVOLTAGE
ACCELERATOR
The PE1<DECON> bit controls the operating mode of
the MCP19110/11.
The MCP19110/11 has additional control circuitry to
allow it to respond quickly to an output overvoltage
condition. The enabling of this circuitry is handled by
the PE1<OVTEE> bit. When this bit is set, the
MCP19110/11 will respond to an output overvoltage
condition by setting both the HDRV and LDRV signals
low and turning off both the high-side and low-side
MOSFETs.
6.13.2
HIGH-SIDE DRIVE STRENGTH
The peak source and sink current of the high-side
driver can be configured to either be 1A source/sink or
2A source/sink. The PE1<DVRSTR> bit determines
the high-side drive strength.
6.13.3
MOSFET DRIVER DEAD TIME
As described in Section 6.9 “MOSFET Driver
Programmable Dead Time”, the MOSFET drive dead
time can be adjusted. In order to enable dead time
settings, the proper bypass bits must be cleared.
PE1<HDLYBY> and PE1<LDLYBY> control the delay
circuits. Clearing the respective bits allows the dead
time programmed by the DEADCON register to be
added to the appropriate turn-on edge.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 49
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 6-14: PE1: ANALOG PERIPHERAL ENABLE 1 CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PDEN
R/W-0
PUEN
R/W-0
R/W-0
DECON
DVRSTR
HDLYBY
LDLYBY
UVTEE
OVTEE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
DECON: Diode Emulation Mode bit
1= Diode emulation mode enabled
0= Synchronous rectification mode enabled
DVRSTR: High-Side Drive Strength Configuration bit
1= High-side 1A source/sink drive strength
0= High-side 2A source/sink drive strength
HDLYBY: High-Side Dead Time Bypass bit
1= High-side dead time bypass is enabled
0= High-side dead time bypass is disabled
LDLYBY: Low-Side Dead Time Bypass bit
1= Low-side dead time bypass is enabled
0= Low-side dead time bypass is disabled
PDEN: -VSEN Weak Pull Down Enable bit
1= -VSEN weak pull down is enabled
0= -VSEN weak pull down is disabled
PUEN: +VSEN Weak Pull Up Enable bit
1= +VSEN weak pull up is enabled
0= +VSEN weak pull up is disabled
UVTEE: Output Undervoltage Accelerator Enable bit
1= Output undervoltage accelerator is enabled
0= Output undervoltage accelerator is disabled
OVTEE: Output Overvoltage Accelerator Enable bit
1= Output overvoltage accelerator is enabled
0= Output overvoltage accelerator is disabled
DS20002331D-page 50
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
6.14.6
INTERNAL TEMPERATURE
MEASUREMENT CONTROL
6.14 Analog Blocks Enable Control
Various analog circuit blocks can be enabled or
disabled, as shown in Register 6-15. Additional enable
bits are located in the ATSTCON register.
The internal temperature of the silicon can be
measured with the ADC. To enable the internal
temperature
measurement
circuitry,
the
ABECON<TMPSEN> bit must be set.
6.14.1
OUTPUT OVERVOLTAGE ENABLE
The output overvoltage is enabled by setting the
ABECON<OVDCEN> bit. Clearing this bit will disable
the output overvoltage circuitry and cause the setting in
the OOVCON register to be ignored.
6.14.7
RELATIVE EFFICIENCY CIRCUITY
CONTROL
Section 10.0 “Relative Efficiency Measurement”
describes the procedure used to measure the relative
6.14.2
OUTPUT UNDERVOLTAGE ENABLE
efficiency
of
the
system.
Setting
the
ABECON<RECIREN> bit enables the relative
efficiency measurement circuitry.
The output undervoltage is enabled by setting the ABE-
CON<UVDCEN> bit. Clearing this bit will disable the
output undervoltage circuitry and cause the setting in
the OUVCON register to be ignored.
6.14.8
SIGNAL CHAIN CONTROL
Setting the ABECON<PATHEN> bit enables the
voltage control path. Under normal operation, this bit is
set.
6.14.3
RELATIVE EFFICIENCY
MEASUREMENT CONTROL
Section 10.0 “Relative Efficiency Measurement”
describes the procedure used to measure the relative
efficiency
of
the
system.
Setting
the
ABECON<MEASEN> bit initiates the relative
measurement.
6.14.4
SLOPE COMPENSATION CONTROL
The slope compensation described in Register 6-7 can
be bypassed by setting the ABECON<SLCPBY> bit.
Under normal operation, this bit will always be set.
6.14.5
CURRENT MEASUREMENT
CONTROL
The peak current measurement circuitry is controlled
by the ABECON<CRTMEN> bit. Setting this bit
enables the current measurement circuitry. Under
normal operation, this bit will be set.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 51
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 6-15: ABECON: ANALOG BLOCK ENABLE CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
OVDCEN
UVDCEN
MEASEN
SLCPBY
CRTMEN
TMPSEN
RECIREN
PATHEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
OVDCEN: Output overvoltage DAC control bit
1= Output overvoltage DAC is enabled
0= Output overvoltage DAC is disabled
UVDCEN: Output undervoltage DAC control bit
1= Output undervoltage DAC is enabled
0= Output undervoltage DAC is disabled
MEASEN: Relative efficiency measurement control bit
1= Initiate relative efficiency measurement
0= Relative efficiency measurement not in progress
SLCPBY: Slope compensation bypass control bit
1= Slope compensation is disabled
0= Slope compensation is enabled
CRTMEN: Current measurement circuitry control bit
1= Current measurement circuitry is enabled
0= Current measurement circuitry is disabled
TMPSEN: Internal temperature sensor and over temperature control bit
1= Internal temperature sensor and over temperature circuitry is enabled
0= Internal temperature sensor and over temperature circuitry is disabled
RECIREN: Relative efficiency circuitry control bit
1= Relative efficiency measurement circuitry is enabled
0= Relative efficiency measurement circuitry is disabled
PATHEN: Signal chain circuitry control bit
1= Signal chain circuitry is enabled
0= Signal chain circuitry is disabled
DS20002331D-page 52
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
7.0
TYPICAL PERFORMANCE CURVES
Note:
The graphs and tables provided following this note are a statistical summary based on a limited number of
samples and are provided for informational purposes only. The performance characteristics listed herein
are not tested or guaranteed. In some graphs or tables, the data presented may be outside the specified
operating range (e.g., outside specified power supply range) and therefore, outside the warranted range.
Note: Unless otherwise indicated, VIN = 12V, FSW = 300 kHz, TA = +25°C.
1.0
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
5.6
5.4
5.2
5.0
4.8
4.6
4.4
4.2
0.0
-0.2
-0.4
-0.6
-0.8
-1.0
-40 -25 -10
5
20 35 50 65 80 95 110 125
Temperature (ºC)
0
2
4
6
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32
CODE
FIGURE 7-1:
I vs. Temperature.
FIGURE 7-4:
OVFCON DAC INL vs.
Q
Code and Temperature (-40°C to +125°C).
0.2
0.0
0.0016
0.0014
0.0012
0.0010
0.0008
0.0006
0.0004
0.0002
0.0000
-0.2
-0.4
-0.6
-0.8
-1.0
-1.2
0
0
2
4
6
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32
CODE
64
128
192
256
CODE
FIGURE 7-2:
OVCCON DAC INL vs.
FIGURE 7-5:
OVFCON DAC DNL vs.
Code and Temperature (-40°C to +125°C).
Code and Temperature (-40°C to +125°C).
0.030
0.025
0.020
0.015
0.010
0.005
5.09
IDD = 1 mA
5.08
5.07
5.06
5.05
5.04
-40ºC
+125ºC
+25ºC
0
64
128
CODE
192
256
6
8
10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32
Input Voltage, VIN (V)
FIGURE 7-3:
OVCCON DAC DNL vs.
FIGURE 7-6:
V
vs. Input Voltage.
DD
Code and Temperature (-40°C to +125°C).
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 53
MCP19110/11
Note: Unless otherwise indicated, VIN = 12V, FSW = 300 kHz, TA = +25°C.
5.07
5.06
5.05
5.04
5.03
5.02
5.01
5.00
4.99
3.35
3.34
3.33
3.32
3.31
3.30
3.29
3.28
3.27
3.26
3.25
OVCCON = 0xDCh
+125ºC
+25ºC
- 40ºC
0
2
4
6
8
10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30
Current (mA)
-40 -25 -10
5
20 35 50 65 80 95 110 125
Temperature (ºC)
FIGURE 7-7:
V
vs. Output Current.
FIGURE 7-10:
V
vs. Temperature
REGREF
DD
(V
= 3.3V).
REGREF
80
70
60
50
40
0.63
0.62
0.61
0.60
0.59
0.58
0.57
OVCCON = 0x28h
-40ºC
+125ºC
30
20
10
+25ºC
4
0
2
6
8
10
12
14
16
-40 -25 -10
5
20 35 50 65 80 95 110 125
Temperature (ºC)
HDLY CODE
FIGURE 7-8:
V
vs. Temperature
FIGURE 7-11:
HDRV Dead Time vs.
REGREF
(V
= 0.6V).
HDLY Code.
REGREF
1.84
1.83
1.82
1.81
1.80
1.79
1.78
1.77
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
OVCCON = 0x78h
+25ºC
+125ºC
-40ºC
-40 -25 -10
5
20 35 50 65 80 95 110 125
Temperature (ºC)
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
LDLY CODE
FIGURE 7-9:
(V = 1.8V).
V
vs. Temperature
FIGURE 7-12:
LDLY Code.
LDRV Dead Time vs.
REGREF
REGREF
DS20002331D-page 54
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
Note: Unless otherwise indicated, VIN = 12V, FSW = 300 kHz, TA = +25°C.
1.4
1.3
1.2
1.1
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
8.05
8.04
8.03
8.02
8.01
8.00
7.99
7.98
7.97
7.96
7.95
DRVSTR = 0
RHDRV-SOURCE
RHDRV-SINK
-40 -25 -10
5
20 35 50 65 80 95 110 125
Temperature (ºC)
-40 -25 -10
5
20 35 50 65 80 95 110 125
Temperature (ºC)
FIGURE 7-13:
HDRV R
vs.
FIGURE 7-16:
Oscillator Frequency vs.
DSon
Temperature.
Temperature.
3.0
1.64
RIND = 3.0 m
DRVSTR = 1
1.63
1.62
1.61
1.60
1.59
1.58
1.57
1.56
1.55
1.54
1.53
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
RHDRV-SOURCE
RHDRV-SINK
-40 -25 -10
5
20 35 50 65 80 95 110 125
Temperature (ºC)
0
5
10
15
20
25
30
Output Current (A)
FIGURE 7-14:
HDRV R
vs.
FIGURE 7-17:
CRNT Voltage vs. Output
DSon
Temperature.
Current.
24%
22%
20%
18%
16%
14%
12%
10%
1.6
1.4
1.2
1.0
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
RLDRV-SOURCE
6%
4%
RLDRV-SINK
2%
0%
30
38
47
56
64
73
81
90 100
-40 -25 -10
5
20 35 50 65 80 95 110 125
Temperature (ºC)
CMRR (dB)
FIGURE 7-15:
LDRV R
vs.
FIGURE 7-18:
Remote Sense Amplifier
DSon
Temperature.
CMRR.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 55
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 56
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
8.1
Analog Bench Test Control
8.0
SYSTEM BENCH TESTING
To allow for easier system design and bench testing,
the MCP19110/11 family of devices feature a multi-
plexer used to output various internal analog signals.
These signals can be measured on the GPA0 pin
through a unity gain buffer. The configuration control of
the GPA0 pin is found in the ATSTCON register, as
shown in Register 8-1.
8.1.1
ATSTCON REGISTER
The ATSTCON register contains the bits used to dis-
able the MOSFET drivers and configure the GPA0 pin
as the unity gain buffer out, as shown in Register 8-1.
Note 1: The DRVDIS bit is reset to ‘1’ so the high-
side and low-side drivers are in a known
state after reset. This bit must be cleared
by software for normal operation.
Control of the signals present at the output of the unity
gain buffer is found in the BUFFCON register, as shown
in Register 8-2.
REGISTER 8-1:
ATSTCON: ANALOG BENCH TEST CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-1
Reserved
bit 7
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
R/W-0
HIDIS
R/W-0
LODIS
R/W-0
R/W-1
Reserved
BNCHEN
DRVDIS
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Reserved
bit 6-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Reserved
bit 3
HIDIS: High-side driver control bit
1= High-side driver is disabled
0= High-side driver is enabled
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
LODIS: Low-side driver control bit
1= Low-side driver is disabled
0= Low-side driver is enabled
BNCHEN: GPA0 bench test configuration control bit
1= GPA0 is configured for analog bench test output
0= GPA0 is configured for normal operation
DRVDIS: MOSFET driver disable control bit
1= High-side and low-side drivers are set low, PHASE pin is floating
0= High-side and low-side drivers are set for normal operation
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 57
MCP19110/11
When measuring signals with the unity gain buffer, the
buffer offset must be added to the measured signal.
The factory measured buffer offset can be read from
memory location 2087h. Refer to Section 11.1.1
“Reading Program Memory as Data” for more infor-
mation.
8.2
Unity Gain Buffer
The unity gain buffer module is used during a multi-
phase application and while operating in Bench Test
mode.
When the ATSTCON<BNCHEN> bit is set, the device
is in Bench Test mode and the ASEL<4:0> bits of the
BUFFCON register determine which internal analog
signal can be measured on the GPA0 pin.
REGISTER 8-2:
BUFFCON: UNITY GAIN BUFFER CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
MLTPH2
bit 7
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
MLTPH1
MLTPH0
ASEL4
ASEL3
ASEL2
ASEL1
ASEL0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
bit 4-0
MLTPH<2:0>: System configuration bits
000= Device set as stand-alone unit
001= Device set as multiple output MASTER
010= Device set as multiple output SLAVE
011= Device set as multi-phase MASTER
100= Device set as multi-phase SLAVE
ASEL<4:0>: Multiplexer output control bit
00000= Voltage proportional to current in the inductor
00001= Error amplifier output plus slope compensation, input to PWM comparator
00010= Input to slope compensation circuitry
00011= Band gap reference
00100= Output voltage reference
00101= Output voltage after internal differential amplifier
00110= Unimplemented
00111= Voltage proportional to the internal temperature
01000= Internal ground for current sense circuitry, see Section 6.5 “Voltage for Zero Current”
01001= Output overvoltage comparator reference
01010= Output undervoltage comparator reference
01011= Error amplifier output
01100= For a multi-phase SLAVE, error amplifier signal received from MASTER
01101= For multi-phase SLAVE, error signal received from MASTER with gain,
see Section 6.8 “MASTER Error Signal Gain”
01110= VIN divided down by 13
01111= DC inductor valley current
10000= Unimplemented
•
•
•
11100= Unimplemented
11101= Overcurrent reference
11110= Unimplemented
11111= Unimplemented
DS20002331D-page 58
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
9.1
Calibration Word 1
9.0
DEVICE CALIBRATION
The DOV<3:0> bits at memory location 2080h set the
offset calibration for the output voltage remote sense
differential amplifier. Firmware must read these values
and write them to the DOVCAL register for proper
calibration.
Read-only memory locations 2080h through 208Fh
contain factory calibration data. Refer to Section 18.0
“Flash Program Memory Control” for information on
how to read from these memory locations.
The FCAL<6:0> bits at memory location 2080h set the
internal oscillator calibration. Firmware must read
these values and write them to the OSCCAL register
for proper calibration.
REGISTER 9-1:
CALWD1: CALIBRATION WORD 1 REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
DOV3
R/P-1
DOV2
R/P-1
DOV1
R/P-1
DOV0
bit 13
bit 8
U-0
—
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
FCAL6
FCAL5
FCAL4
FCAL3
FCAL2
FCAL1
FCAL0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 13-12
bit 11-8
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
DOV<3:0>: Output voltage remote sense differential amplifier offset calibration bits.
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-0
FCAL<6:0>: Internal oscillator calibration bits.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 59
MCP19110/11
The BGR<3:0> bits at memory location 2082h calibrate
the internal band gap. Firmware must read these
values and write them to the BGRCAL register for
proper calibration.
9.2
Calibration Word 2
The VRO<3:0> bits at memory location 2082h calibrate
the offset of the buffer amplifier of the output voltage
regulation reference set point. This effectively changes
the band gap reference. Firmware must read these
values and write them to the VROCAL register for
proper calibration.
REGISTER 9-2:
CALWD2: CALIBRATION WORD 2 REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
VRO3
R/P-1
VRO2
R/P-1
VRO1
R/P-1
VRO0
bit 13
bit 8
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
BGR3
R/P-1
BGR2
R/P-1
BGR1
R/P-1
BGR0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 13-12
bit 11-8
bit 7-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
VRO<3:0>: Reference voltage offset calibration bits.
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
BGR<3:0>: Internal band gap calibration bits.
DS20002331D-page 60
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
9.3
Calibration Word 3
The TTA<3:0> bits at memory location 2083h calibrate
the overtemperature shutdown threshold point. Firm-
ware must read these values and write them to the
TTACAL register for proper calibration.
The ZRO<3:0> bits at memory location 2083h calibrate
the offset of the error amplifier. Firmware must read
these values and write them to the ZROCAL register for
proper calibration.
REGISTER 9-3:
CALWD3: CALIBRATION WORD 3 REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
TTA3
R/P-1
TTA2
R/P-1
TTA1
R/P-1
TTA0
bit 13
bit 8
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
ZRO3
R/P-1
ZRO2
R/P-1
ZRO1
R/P-1
ZRO0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 13-12
bit 11-8
bit 7-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
TTA<3:0>: Overtemperature shutdown threshold calibration bits.
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
ZRO<3:0>: Error amplifier offset voltage calibration bits.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 61
MCP19110/11
9.4
Calibration Word 4
The TANA<9:0> bits at memory location 2084h contain
the ADC reading from the internal temperature sensor
when the silicon temperature is at +30°C. The
temperature coefficient of the internal temperature
sensor is 16 mV/°C.
REGISTER 9-4:
CALWD4: CALIBRATION WORD 4 REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
R/P-1
TANA9
TANA8
bit 13
bit 8
R/P-1
TANA7
bit 7
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
TANA6
TANA5
TANA4
TANA3
TANA2
TANA1
TANA0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 13-10
bit 9-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
TANA<9:0>: ADC internal temperature sensor at +30°C calibration bits
TANA<9:0>= (Temperature x 13.3 mV/°C) +1.75
DS20002331D-page 62
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
9.5
Calibration Word 5
The DIFC<7:0> bits at memory location 2085h contain
the offset voltage information for the output voltage
difference amplifier. The value is an 8-bit two’s
complement number that represents the number of the
OVCCON counts needed to adjust for the differential
amplifier offset. This value can be used to completely
remove the differential amplifier offset.
For example, the offset of the differential amplifier is
measured to be -64 mV. Since one OVCCON count
equals 16 mV, this represents four counts of the
OVCCON register. Therefore, the value stored at
location 2085h would be 0xFCh, where the setting of
the DIFC7 bit represents a negative number.
REGISTER 9-5:
CALWD5: CALIBRATION WORD 5 REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
bit 13
bit 8
R/P-1
DIFC7
bit 7
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
DIFC6
DIFC5
DIFC4
DIFC3
DIFC2
DIFC1
DIFC0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 13-8
bit 7-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
DIFC<7:0>: OVCCON counts to adjust for differential amplifier offset calibration bits
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 63
MCP19110/11
9.6
Calibration Word 6
The DIFF<7:0> bits at memory location 2086h contain
the offset voltage information for the output voltage
difference amplifier. The value is an 8-bit two’s
complement number that represents the number of the
OVFCON counts needed to adjust for the differential
amplifier offset. This value can be used to completely
remove the differential amplifier offset.
For example, the offset of the differential amplifier is
measured to be +4.2 mV. Since one OVFCON count
equals 0.7 mV, this represents six counts of the
OVFCON register. Therefore the value stored at
location 2086h would be 0x06h, where clearing the
DIFF7 bit represents a positive number.
REGISTER 9-6:
CALWD6: CALIBRATION WORD 6 REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
bit 13
bit 8
R/P-1
DIFF7
bit 7
R/P-1
DIFF6
R/P-1
DIFF5
R/P-1
DIFF4
R/P-1
DIFF3
R/P-1
DIFF2
R/P-1
DIFF1
R/P-1
DIFF0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 13-8
bit 7-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
DIFF<7:0>: OVFCON counts to adjust for differential amplifier offset calibration bits
DS20002331D-page 64
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
9.7
Calibration Word 7
The BUFF<7:0> bits at memory location 2087h
represent the offset voltage of the unity gain buffer in
millivolts. This is an 8-bit two’s complement number.
The MSB is the sign bit. If the MSB is set to 1, the
resulting number is negative.
REGISTER 9-7:
CALWD7: CALIBRATION WORD 7 REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
bit 13
bit 8
R/P-1
BUFF7
bit 7
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
BUFF6
BUFF5
BUFF4
BUFF3
BUFF2
BUFF1
BUFF0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 13-8
bit 7-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
BUFF<7:0>: Unity gain buffer offset voltage calibration bits
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 65
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 66
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
7. Whenthemeasurementiscomplete,usetheADC
toreadtheRELEFFchannel.Thisvaluebecomes
the Fractional variable in Equation 10-1. This
reading should be accomplished approximately
50ms after the RELESS<MSDONE> bit is set.
10.0 RELATIVE EFFICIENCY
MEASUREMENT
With a constant input voltage, output voltage and load
current, any change in the high-side MOSFET on-time
represents a change in the system efficiency. The
MCP19110/11 is capable of measuring the on-time of
the high-side MOSFET. Therefore, the relative
efficiency of the system can be measured and
optimized by changing the system parameters, such as
switching frequency, driver dead time or high-side drive
strength.
8. Read the value of the RE<6:0> bits in the
RELEFF register and store the reading as
Whole.
9. Clear the ABECON<MEASEN> bit.
10. The relative efficiency is then calculated by the
following equation:
EQUATION 10-1:
10.1 Relative Efficiency Measurement
Procedure
Fractional – Low
High – Low
PR2 + 1
--------------------------------------------------
Whole +
To measure the relative efficiency, the RELEFF regis-
ter, ABECON<MEASEN> and ABECON<RECIREN>
bits, and the ADC RELEFF input are used. The
following steps outlines the measurement process:
Duty Cycle = -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Where:
Whole = Value obtained in Step 8 of the
measurement procedure
1. Set the ABECON<RECIREN> bit to enable the
measurement circuitry.
Fractional = Value obtained in Step 7 of the
measurement procedure
2. Clear the ABECON<MEASEN> bit.
3. With the ADC, read the RELEFF channel and
store this reading as the High.
High = Value obtained in Step 3 of the
measurement procedure
4. With the ADC, read the VZC channel and store
this reading as the Low.
Low = Value obtained in Step 4 of the
measurement procedure
5. Set the ABECON<MEASEN> bit to initiate a
measurement cycle.
6. Monitor the RELEFF<MSDONE> bit. When set,
it indicates the measurement is complete.
Note 1: The RELEFF<MSDONE> bit is set and
cleared automatically.
REGISTER 10-1: RELEFF: RELATIVE EFFICIENCY MEASUREMENT REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
RE6
R/W-0
RE5
R/W-0
RE4
R/W-0
RE3
R/W-0
RE2
R/W-0
RE1
R/W-0
RE0
MSDONE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
MSDONE: Relative efficiency measurement done bit
1= Relative efficiency measurement is complete
0= Relative efficiency measurement is not complete
bit 6-0
RE<6:0>: Whole clock counts for relative efficiency measurement result
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 67
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 68
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 11-1:
PROGRAM MEMORY MAP
AND STACK FOR
MCP19110/11
11.0 MEMORY ORGANIZATION
There are two types of memory in the MCP19110/11:
• Program Memory
PC<12:0>
• Data Memory
CALL, RETURN
RETFIE, RETLW
- Special Function Registers (SFRs)
- General Purpose RAM
13
Stack Level 1
11.1 Program Memory Organization
The MCP19110/11 has a 13-bit program counter
capable of addressing an 8K x 14 program memory
space. Only the first 4K x 14 (0000h-0FFFh) is
physically implemented. Addressing a location above
this boundary will cause a wrap-around within the first
4K x 14 space. The Reset vector is at 0000h and the
interrupt vector is at 0004h (see Figure 11-1). The width
of the program memory bus (instruction word) is
14-bits. Since all instructions are a single word, the
MCP19110/11 has space for 4K of instructions.
Stack Level 8
Reset Vector
0000h
0004h
0005h
Interrupt Vector
On-Chip Program
Memory
0FFFh
1000h
Shadows 000-FFFh
1FFFh
2000h
2003h
User IDs(1)
ICD Instruction(1)
Manufacturing Codes(1)
Device ID (hardcoded)(1)
2004h
2005h
2006h
Config Word(1)
Reserved
2007h
2008h
200Ah
200Bh
Reserved for
Manufacturing & Test(1)
207Fh
2080h
Calibration Words(1)
Unimplemented
208Fh
2090h
20FFh
2100h
Shadows 2000-20FFh
3FFFh
Note 1: Not code protected.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 69
MCP19110/11
The STATUS register can be the destination for any
instruction, like any other register. If the STATUS
register is the destination for an instruction that affects
the Z, DC or C bits, then the write to these three bits is
disabled. These bits are set or cleared according to the
device logic. Furthermore, the TO and PD bits are not
writable. Therefore, the result of an instruction with the
STATUS register as destination may be different than
intended.
11.1.1
READING PROGRAM MEMORY AS
DATA
There are two methods of accessing constants in
program memory. The first method is to use tables of
RETLW instructions. The second method is to set a
Files Select Register (FSR) to point to the program
memory.
11.1.1.1
RETLWInstruction
For example, CLRF STATUSwill clear the upper three
bits and set the Z bit. This leaves the STATUS register
as ‘000u u1uu’ (where u= unchanged).
The RETLWinstruction can be used to provide access
to tables of constants. The recommended way to create
such a table is shown in Example 11-1.
Therefore, it is recommended that only BCF, BSF,
SWAPF and MOVWF instructions are used to alter the
STATUS register, because these instructions do not
affect any Status bits. For other instructions not
affecting any Status bits, see the Section 29.0
“Instruction Set Summary”.
EXAMPLE 11-1:
constants
RETLW INSTRUCTION
RETLW DATA0
RETLW DATA1
RETLW DATA2
RETLW DATA3
;Index0 data
;Index1 data
Note 1: The C and DC bits operate as Borrow
and Digit Borrow out bits, respectively, in
subtraction.
my_function
;… LOTS OF CODE…
MOVLW DATA_INDEX
call constants
;… THE CONSTANT IS IN W
11.2 Data Memory Organization
The data memory (see Table 11-1) is partitioned into
four banks, which contain the General Purpose
Registers (GPR) and the Special Function Registers
(SFR). The Special Function Registers are located in
the first 32 locations of each bank. Register locations
20h-7Fh in Bank 0, A0h-EFh in Bank 1 and 120h-16Fh
in Bank 2 are General Purpose Registers,
implemented as static RAM. All other RAM is
unimplemented and returns ‘0’ when read. The
RP<1:0> bits of the STATUS register are the bank
select bits.
RP1
0
RP0
0
-> Bank 0 is selected
-> Bank 1 is selected
-> Bank 2 is selected
-> Bank 3 is selected
0
1
1
0
1
1
To move values from one register to another register,
the value must pass throught the W register. This
means that for all register-to-register moves, two
instruction cycles are required.
The STATUS register, shown in Register 11-1,
contains:
• the arithmetic status of the ALU
• the Reset status
• the bank select bits for data memory (RAM)
DS20002331D-page 70
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 11-1: STATUS: STATUS REGISTER
R/W-0
IRP
R/W-0
RP1
R/W-0
RP0
R-1
TO
R-1
PD
R/W-x
Z
R/W-x
DC(1)
R/W-x
C(1)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
IRP: Register Bank Select bit (used for Indirect addressing)
1= Bank 2 & 3 (100h – 1FFh)
0= Bank 0 & 1 (00h – FFh)
bit 6-5
RP<1:0>: Register Bank Select bits (used for Direct addressing)
00= Bank 0 (00h - 7Fh)
01= Bank 1 (80h - FFh)
10= Bank 2 (100h - 17Fh)
11= Bank 3 (180h - 1FFh)
bit 4
TO: Time-out bit
1= After power-up, CLRWDTinstruction or SLEEPinstruction
0= A WDT time-out occurred
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
PD: Power-down bit
1= After power-up or by the CLRWDTinstruction
0= By execution of the SLEEPinstruction
Z: Zero bit
1= The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero
0= The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero
DC: Digit Carry/Digit Borrow bit(1) (ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW, SUBWFinstructions)
1= A carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result occurred
0= No carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result
C: Carry/Borrow bit(1) (ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW, SUBWF instructions)(1)
1= A carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
0= No carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
Note 1: For Borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the two’s complement of the
second operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either the high-order or low-order
bit of the source register.
11.2.1
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS
The Special Function Registers are registers used by
the CPU and peripheral functions for controlling the
desired operation of the device (see Table 11-1). These
registers are static RAM.
The special registers can be classified into two sets:
core and peripheral. The Special Function Registers
associated with the microcontroller core are described
in this section. Those related to the operation of the
peripheral features are described in the associated
section for that peripheral feature.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 71
MCP19110/11
11.3 DATA MEMORY
TABLE 11-1: MCP19110/11 DATA MEMORY MAP
File
File
File
File
Address
Address
Address
Address
Indirect addr.(1)
TMR0
00h
01h
02h
03h
04h
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
0Ah
0Bh
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
12h
13h
14h
15h
16h
17h
18h
19h
1Ah
1Bh
1Ch
1Dh
1Eh
1Fh
20h
Indirect addr. (1) 80h
Indirect addr.(1)
TMR0
100h
101h
102h
103h
104h
105h
106h
107h
108h
109h
10Ah
10Bh
10Ch
10Dh
10Eh
10Fh
110h
111h
112h
113h
114h
115h
116h
117h
118h
119h
11Ah
11Bh
11Ch
11Dh
11Eh
11Fh
120h
Indirect addr. (1) 180h
OPTION_REG
PCL
81h
82h
83h
84h
85h
86h
87h
88h
89h
8Ah
8Bh
8Ch
8Dh
8Eh
8Fh
90h
91h
92h
93h
94h
95h
96h
97h
98h
99h
9Ah
9Bh
9Ch
9Dh
9Eh
9Fh
A0h
OPTION_REG
PCL
181h
182h
183h
184h
185h
186h
187h
188h
189h
18Ah
18Bh
18Ch
18Dh
18Eh
18Fh
190h
191h
192h
193h
194h
195h
196h
197h
198h
199h
19Ah
19Bh
19Ch
19Dh
19Eh
19Fh
1A0h
PCL
PCL
STATUS
FSR
STATUS
FSR
STATUS
FSR
STATUS
FSR
PORTGPA
PORTGPB
PIR1
TRISGPA
TRISGPB
PIE1
WPUGPA
WPUGPB
PE1
IOCA
IOCB
ANSELA
ANSELB
PIR2
PIE2
BUFFCON
ABECON
PCLATH
INTCON
PCON
APFCON
PCLATH
INTCON
PCLATH
INTCON
TMR1L
TMR1H
T1CON
TMR2
PCLATH
INTCON
PORTICD(2)
TRISICD(2)
ICKBUG(2)
BIGBUG(2)
PMCON1
PMCON2
PMADRL
PMADRH
PMDATL
T2CON
PR2
VINLVL
SSPADD
SSPBUF
OCCON
SSPCON1
SSPCON2
SSPCON3
SSPMSK
SSPSTAT
SSPADD2
SSPMSK2
PWMPHL
PWMPHH
PWMRL
CSGSCON
CSDGCON
PMDATH
PWMRH
VZCCON
CMPZCON
OUVCON
OSCCAL
DOVCAL
TTACAL
BGRCAL
VROCAL
ZROCAL
OVCCON
OVFCON
OSCTUNE
ADRESL
ADRESH
ADCON0
ADCON1
OOVCON
DEADCON
SLPCRCON
SLVGNCON
RELEFF
ATSTCON
General
Purpose
Register
80 Bytes
General
Purpose
Register
General
Purpose
Register
80 bytes
EFh
F0h
16F
1EF
96 Bytes
Accesses
Bank 0
Accesses
Bank 0
170h
Accesses
Bank 0
1F0h
7Fh
FFh
17Fh
1FFh
Bank 0
Bank 1
Bank2
Bank3
Unimplemented data memory locations, read as '0'.
Note 1: Not a physical register.
2: Only accessible when DBGEN = 0 and ICKBUG<INBUG> = 1.
DS20002331D-page 72
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 11-2: MCP19110/11 SPECIAL REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 0
Value on
Value on
Adr
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
all other
POR Reset
(1)
resets
Bank 0
00h INDF
01h TMR0
02h PCL
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register)
Timer0 Module’s Register
xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu
Program Counter's (PC) Least Significant byte
03h STATUS
IRP
RP1
RP0
TO
PD
Z
DC
C
04h FSR
Indirect data memory address pointer
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
05h PORTGPA
GPA7
GPA6
GPA5
GPB5
BCLIF
OCIF
—
GPA4
GPB4
SSPIF
OVIF
—
GPA3
—
GPA2
GPB2
—
GPA1
GPB1
GPA0
GPB0
06h PORTGPB
07h PIR1
GPB7
—
GPB6
ADIF
—
xxx- xxxx uuu- uuuu
-000 --00 -000 --00
—
TMR2IF
VINIF
TMR1IF
08h PIR2
UVIF
—
—
DCERIF 0-00 --00 0-00 --00
09h PCON
---- -qq- ---- -uu-
—
—
—
—
—
OT
POR
—
0Ah PCLATH
0Bh INTCON
0Ch TMR1L
—
Write buffer for upper 5 bits of program counter
INTE IOCE T0IF INTF
---0 0000 ---0 0000
(3)
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
IOCF
0000 000x 0000 000u
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
Holding register for the Least Significant byte of the 16-bit TMR1
Holding register for the Most Significant byte of the 16-bit TMR1
TMR1H
0Dh
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
T1CON
0Eh
—
—
—
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0
—
—
TMR1CS
TMR1ON --00 --00
--uu --uu
uuuu uuuu
---- -000
1111 1111
—
0Fh TMR2
10h T2CON
11h PR2
Timer2 Module Register
0000 0000
—
—
—
—
TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
---- -000
1111 1111
—
Timer2 Module Period Register
Unimplemented
12h
—
13h PWMPHL
14h PWMPHH
15h PWMRL
16h PWMRH
SLAVE Phase Shift Register
SLAVE Phase Shift Register
PWM Register Low Byte
PWM Register High Byte
Unimplemented
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
17h
18h
—
—
—
—
—
—
Unimplemented
19h OVCCON
1Ah OVFCON
OVC7
OVC6
—
OVC5
—
OVC4
OVF4
OVC3
OVF3
OVC2
OVF2
OVC1
OVF1
OVC0
OVF0
0000 0000 0000 0000
VOUTON
0--0 0000 0--0 0000
---0 0000 ---0 0000
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
1Bh OSCTUNE
—
—
—
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
ADRESL
1Ch
Least significant 8 bits of the right-shifted result
Most significant 2 bits of right-shifted result
ADRESH
1Dh
---- --xx uuuu uuuu
1Eh ADCON0
1Fh ADCON1
CHS3
—
—
CHS4
CHS2
CHS1
—
CHS0
—
GO/DONE
—
ADON
—
-000 0000 -000 0000
-000 ---- -000 ----
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
Legend:
Note 1:
— = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition, shaded = unimplemented
Other (non power-up) resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation.
IRP & RP1 bits are reserved, always maintain these bits clear.
MCLR and WDT reset does not affect the previous value data latch. The IOCF bit will be cleared upon reset but will set again if the
mismatch exists.
2:
3:
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 73
MCP19110/11
TABLE 11-3: MCP19110/11 SPECIAL REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 1
Values on
all other
resets
Value on
POR Reset
Addr
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
(1)
Bank 1
80h
INDF
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
81h
OPTION_REG
1111 1111 1111 1111
RAPU
INTEDG
T0CS
Program Counter's (PC) Least Significant byte
RP0 TO PD
Indirect data memory address pointer
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
82h
83h
PCL
0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu
(2)
(2)
STATUS
IRP
RP1
Z
DC
C
84h
85h
86h
87h
88h
89h
FSR
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
TRISGPA
TRISGPB
PIE1
TRISA7
TRISB7
—
TRISA6
TRISB6
ADIE
TRISA5
TRISB5
BCLIE
OCIE
TRISA4
TRISB4
SSPIE
OVIE
TRISA3
TRISA2
TRISB2
—
TRISA1
TRISB1
TMR2IE
VINIE
—
TRISA0 1111 1111 1111 1111
TRISB0 1111 1111 1111 1111
—
—
—
—
TMR1IE -000 --00 -000 --00
DCERIE 0-00 --00 0-00 --00
CLKSEL ---- ---0 ---- ---0
PIE2
UVIE
—
—
APFCON
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
8Ah
8Bh
8Ch
8Dh
8Eh
8Fh
90h
PCLATH
INTCON
—
Write buffer for upper 5 bits of program counter
---0 0000 ---0 0000
0000 000x 0000 000u
(4)
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
IOCE
T0IF
INTF
IOCF
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VINLVL
UVLOEN
OCEN
—
—
OCLEB1
—
UVLO5
UVLO4
OOC4
UVLO3
OOC3
UVLO2
OOC2
UVLO1
OOC1
UVLO0
OOC0
0-xx xxxx 0-uu uuuu
0xxx xxxx 0uuu uuuu
--xx xxxx --uu uuuu
-xxx xxxx -uuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0--- xxxx 0--- uuuu
---- xxxx ---- uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
---x xxxx ---u uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
91h
92h
93h
94h
95h
96h
97h
98h
99h
9Ah
9Bh
OCCON
—
OCLEB0
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
CSGS3 CSGS2 CSGS1 CSGS0
CSGSCON
—
—
Reserved Reserved Reserved
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
CSDGCON
—
CSDGEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Reserved
Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved
VZC3 VZC2 VZC1 VZC0
CSDG2
CSDG1
CSDG0
VZCCON
CMPZCON
OUVCON
OOVCON
DEADCON
VZC7
VZC6
VZC5
VZC4
CMPZF3 CMPZF2 CMPZF1 CMPZF0 CMPZG3 CMPZG2 CMPZG1 CMPZG0
OUV7
OOV7
HDLY3
SLPG3
—
OUV6
OOV6
HDLY2
SLPG2
—
OUV5
OOV5
HDLY1
SLPG1
—
OUV4
OOV4
HDLY0
SLPG0
SLVGN4
RE4
OUV3
OOV3
LDLY3
SLPS3
SLVGN3
RE3
OUV2
OOV2
LDLY2
SLPS2
SLVGN2
RE2
OUV1
OOV1
LDLY1
SLPS1
SLVGN1
RE1
OUV0
OOV0
LDLY0
SLPS0
SLVGN0
RE0
9Ch SLPCRCON
9Dh SLVGNCON
9Eh
9Fh
RELEFF
—
MSDONE
RE6
RE5
Unimplemented
—
—
Legend:
Note 1:
— = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition, shaded = unimplemented
Other (non power-up) resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation.
IRP & RP1 bits are reserved, always maintain these bits clear.
RA3 pull-up is enabled when pin is configured as MCLR in Configuration Word.
MCLR and WDT Reset does not affect the previous value data latch. The IOCF bit will be cleared upon reset but will set again if the
mismatch exists.
2:
3:
4:
DS20002331D-page 74
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 11-4: MCP19110/11 SPECIAL REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 2
Value on
Value on
Adr
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
all other
POR Reset
(1)
resets
Bank 2
100h INDF
101h TMR0
102h PCL
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register)
Timer0 Module’s Register
xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu
Program Counter's (PC) Least Significant byte
(2)
(2)
103h STATUS
IRP
RP1
RP0
TO
PD
Z
DC
C
104h FSR
Indirect data memory address pointer
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
--1- 1111 --u- uuuu
105h WPUGPA
—
—
WPUA5
—
WPUA3
WPUA2
WPUA1
WPUA0
106h WPUGPB
107h PE1
WPUB7
DECON
WPUB6
DVRSTR
MLTPH1
1111 -11- uuuu -uu-
WPUB5
WPUB4
LDLYBY
—
WPUB2
PUEN
WPUB1
UVTEE
—
HDLYBY
PDEN
OVTEE
0000 1100 0000 1100
0000 0000 0000 0000
108h BUFFCON MLTPH2
MLTPH0
ASEL4
ASEL3
ASEL2
ASEL1
ASEL0
109h ABECON
OVDCEN UVDCEN MEASEN
SLCPBY
CRTMEN
TMPSEN RECIREN
PATHEN
0000 0000 0000 0000
---0 0000 ---0 0000
0000 000x 0000 000u
10Ah PCLATH
10Bh INTCON
—
—
—
Write buffer for upper 5 bits of program counter
(3)
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
IOCE
T0IF
INTF
IOCF
10Ch
10Dh
—
—
—
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
10Eh
10Fh
—
Unimplemented
ADD<7:0>
—
—
110h SSPADD
111h SSPBUF
112h SSPCON1
113h SSPCON2
114h SSPCON3
115h SSPMSK
116h SSPSTAT
117h SSPADD2
118h SSPMSK2
0000 0000 0000 0000
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
WCOL
GCEN
SSPOV
ACKSTAT
PCIE
SSPEN
ACKDT
SCIE
CKP
ACKEN
BOEN
SSPM>3:0>
RCEN
PEN
RSEN
AHEN
SEN
ACKTIM
SDAHT
SBCDE
DHEN
MSK<7:0>
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
—
—
ADD2<7:0>
MSK2<7:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
1111 1111 1111 1111
119h
11Ah
11Bh
—
—
—
—
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
11Ch
11Dh
11Eh
11Fh
—
—
—
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
—
—
Legend:
Note 1:
— = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition, shaded = unimplemented
Other (non power-up) resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation.
IRP & RP1 bits are reserved, always maintain these bits clear.
MCLR and WDT reset does not affect the previous value data latch. The IOCF bit will be cleared upon reset but will set again if the
mismatch exists.
2:
3:
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 75
MCP19110/11
TABLE 11-5: MCP19110/11 SPECIAL REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 3
Values on
all other
resets
Value on
POR Reset
Addr
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
(1)
Bank 3
180h INDF
Addressing this location uses contents of FSR to address data memory (not a physical register) xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
181h OPTION_REG
1111 1111 1111 1111
RAPU
INTEDG
T0CS
Program Counter's (PC) Least Significant byte
RP0 TO PD
Indirect data memory address pointer
T0SE
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
182h PCL
0000 0000 0000 0000
0001 1xxx 000q quuu
(2)
(2)
183h STATUS
IRP
RP1
Z
DC
C
184h FSR
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 -000 0000 -000
---- 1111 ---- 1111
--11 -11- --11 -11-
185h IOCA
186h IOCB
187h ANSELA
188h ANSELB
IOCA7
IOCB7
—
IOCA6
IOCB6
—
IOCA5
IOCB5
—
IOCA4
IOCB4
—
IOCA3
—
IOCA2
IOCB2
ANSA2
ANSB2
IOCA1
IOCB1
ANSA1
ANSB1
IOCA0
IOCB0
ANSA0
—
ANSA3
—
—
—
ANSB5
ANSB4
189h
—
Unimplemented
Write buffer for upper 5 bits of program counter
INTE IOCE T0IF INTF IOCF
—
—
18Ah PCLATH
18Bh INTCON
18Ch PORTICD
—
—
—
---0 0000 ---0 0000
0000 000x 0000 000u
(4)
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
(5)
(5)
In-Circuit Debug Port Register
In-Circuit Debug TRIS Register
In-Circuit Debug Register
18Dh TRISICD
(5)
18Eh ICKBUG
18Fh BIGBUG
0--- ---- 0--- ----
---- ---- ---- ----
-0-- -000 -0-- -000
---- ---- ---- ----
0000 0000 0000 0000
---- 0000 ---- 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
--00 0000 --00 0000
(5)
In-Circuit Debug Breakpoint Register
WREN
190h PMCON1
191h PMCON2
192h PMADRL
193h PMADRH
194h PMDATL
195h PMDATH
—
CALSEL
—
—
—
WR
RD
Program Memory Control Register 2 (not a physical register)
PMADRL7
PMADRL6
PMADRL5
PMADRL4
PMADRL3
PMADRL2
PMADRH2
PMDATL2
PMDATH2
PMADRL1
PMADRH1
PMDATL1
PMDATH1
PMADRL0
PMADRH0
PMDATL0
PMDATH0
—
—
—
—
PMADRH3
PMDATL3
PMDATH3
PMDATL7
PMDATL6
PMDATL5
PMDATH5
PMDATL4
PMDATH4
—
—
196h
197h
—
—
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
—
—
—
—
198h OSCCAL
199h DOVCAL
19Ah TTACAL
19Bh BGRCAL
—
—
—
FCALT6
FCALT5
FCALT4
FCALT3
DOVT3
TTA3
FCALT2
DOVT2
TTA2
FCALT1
DOVT1
TTA1
FCALT0
DOVT0
TTA0
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
—
—
—
—
—
—
Reserve Reserved Reserved Reserved
d
BGRT3
BGRT2
BGRT1
BGRT0
19Ch VROCAL
19Dh ZROCAL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
VROT3
ZROT3
VROT2
ZROT2
VROT1
ZROT1
VROT0
ZROT0
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu
19Eh
—
Unimplemented
HIDIS
—
—
19Fh ATSTCON
—
—
—
—
LODIS
BNCHEN
DRVDIS
1--0 0001 1--0 0001
Legend:
Note 1:
— = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition, shaded = unimplemented
Other (non power-up) resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation.
IRP & RP1 bits are reserved, always maintain these bits clear.
RA3 pull-up is enabled when pin is configured as MCLR in Configuration Word.
MCLR and WDT Reset does not affect the previous value data latch. The IOCF bit will be cleared upon reset but will set again if the
mismatch exists.
2:
3:
4:
5:
Only accessible when DBGEN = 0 and ICKBUG<INBUG> = 1.
DS20002331D-page 76
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
11.3.0.1
OPTION Register
Note 1: To achieve a 1:1 prescaler assignment
for Timer0, assign the prescaler to the
WDT by setting PSA bit to ‘1’ of the
OPTION register. See Section 23.1.3
“Software Programmable Prescaler”
The OPTION register is a readable and writable
register, which contains various control bits to
configure:
• Timer0/WDT prescaler
• External GPA2/INT interrupt
• Timer0
• Weak pull-ups on PORTGPA and PORTGPB
REGISTER 11-2: OPTION_REG: OPTION REGISTER (Note 1)
R/W-1
RAPU
R/W-1
R/W-1
T0CS
R/W-1
T0SE
R/W-1
PSA
R/W-1
PS2
R/W-1
PS1
R/W-1
PS0
INTEDG
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2-0
RAPU: Port GPx Pull-up Enable bit
1= Port GPx pull-ups are disabled
0= Port GPx pull-ups are enabled
INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit
0= Interrupt on rising edge of INT pin
1= Interrupt on falling edge of INT pin
T0CE: TMR0 Clock Source Select bit
1= Transition on T0CKI pin
0= Internal instruction cycle clock
T0SE: TMR0 Source Edge Select bit
1= Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin
0= Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin
PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit
1= Prescaler is assigned to WDT
0= Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module
PS<2:0>: Prescaler Rate Select bits
TMR0
Rate
Bit Value
WDT Rate
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
1: 2
1: 4
1: 1
1: 2
1: 8
1: 4
1: 16
1: 32
1: 64
1: 128
1: 256
1: 8
1: 16
1: 32
1: 64
1: 128
Note 1: Individual WPUx bit must also be enabled.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 77
MCP19110/11
11.4.3
COMPUTED FUNCTION CALLS
11.4 PCL and PCLATH
A computed function CALLallows programs to maintain
tables of functions and provides another way to
execute state machines or look-up tables. When
performing a table read using a computed function
CALL, care should be exercised if the table location
crosses a PCL memory boundary (each 256-byte
block).
The Program Counter (PC) is 13 bits wide. The low byte
comes from the PCL register, which is a readable and
writable register. The high byte (PC<12:8>) is not directly
readable or writable and comes from PCLATH. On any
Reset, the PC is cleared. Figure 11-2 shows the two
situations for loading the PC. The upper example in
Figure 11-2 shows how the PC is loaded on a write to PCL
(PCLATH<4:0> PCH). The lower example in
Figure 11-2 shows how the PC is loaded during a CALLor
GOTOinstruction (PCLATH<4:3> PCH).
If using the CALLinstruction, the PCH<2:0> and PCL
registers are loaded with the operand of the CALL
instruction. PCH<4:3> is loaded with PCLATH<4:3>.
11.4.4
STACK
FIGURE 11-2:
LOADING OF PC IN
DIFFERENT SITUATIONS
The MCP19110/11 has an 8-level x 13-bit wide hard-
ware stack (refer to Figure 11-1). The stack space is
not part of either program or data space and the Stack
Pointer is not readable or writable. The PC is PUSHed
onto the stack when a CALLinstruction is executed or
an interrupt causes a branch. The stack is POPed in
the event of a RETURN, RETLWor a RETFIEinstruction
execution. PCLATH is not affected by a PUSH or POP
operation.
PCH
PCL
12
8 7
0
Instruction with
Destination
PC
8
PCLATH<4:0>
5
ALU Result
PCLATH
PCL
The stack operates as a circular buffer. This means that
after the stack has been PUSHed eight times, the ninth
push overwrites the value that was stored from the first
push. The tenth push overwrites the second push (and
so on).
PCH
12 11 10 8 7
0
GOTO, CALL
PC
PCLATH<4:3>
11
2
Opcode <10:0>
Note 1: There are no Status bits to indicate Stack
PCLATH
MODIFYING PCL
Overflow or Stack Underflow conditions.
2: There are no instructions/mnemonics
called PUSH or POP. These are actions
that occur from the execution of the
CALL, RETURN, RETLW and RETFIE
instructions or the vectoring to an
interrupt address.
11.4.1
Executing any instruction with the PCL register as the
destination simultaneously causes the Program
Counter PC<12:8> bits (PCH) to be replaced by the
contents of the PCLATH register. This allows the entire
content of the program counter to be changed by
writing the desired upper 5 bits to the PCLATH register.
When the lower 8 bits are written to the PCL register, all
13 bits of the program counter will change to the values
contained in the PCLATH register and those being
written to the PCL register.
11.5 Indirect Addressing, INDF and
FSR Registers
The INDF register is not a physical register. Addressing
the INDF register will cause indirect addressing.
Indirect addressing is possible by using the INDF
register. Any instruction using the INDF register
actually accesses data pointed to by the File Select
Register (FSR). Reading INDF itself indirectly will
produce 00h. Writing to the INDF register directly
results in a no operation (although Status bits may be
affected). An effective 9-bit address is obtained by
concatenating the 8-bit FSR and the IRP bit of the
STATUS register, as shown in Figure 11-3.
11.4.2
COMPUTED GOTO
A computed GOTOis accomplished by adding an offset
to the program counter (ADDWF PCL). Care should be
exercised when jumping into a look-up table or
program branch table (computed GOTO) by modifying
the PCL register. Assuming that PCLATH is set to the
table start address, if the table length is greater than
255 instructions or if the lower 8 bits of the memory
address rolls over from 0xFFh to 0X00h in the middle
of the table, then PCLATH must be incremented for
each address rollover that occurs between the table
beginning and the table location within the table.
A simple program to clear RAM location 40h-7Fh using
indirect addressing is shown in Example 11-2.
For more information, refer to Application Note AN556
– “Implementing a Table Read” (DS00556).
DS20002331D-page 78
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
EXAMPLE 11-2:
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
MOVLW
MOVWF
0x40
FSR
;initialize pointer
;to RAM
NEXT
CLRF
INCF
BTFSS
GOTO
INDF
FSR
FSR,7
NEXT
;clear INDF register
;inc pointer
;all done?
;no clear next
;yes continue
CONTINUE
FIGURE 11-3:
DIRECT/INDIRECT ADDRESSING
Direct Addressing
Indirect Addressing
From Opcode
7
File Select Register
RP1 RP0
6
0
0
IRP
Bank Select
180h
Location Select
Bank Select
Location Select
00h
00
01
10
11
Data
Memory
7Fh
1FFh
Bank 0
Bank 1 Bank 2
Bank 3
For memory map detail, see Figure 11-2.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 79
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 80
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
12.0 DEVICE CONFIGURATION
Note:
The DBGEN bit in Configuration Word is
Device Configuration consists of Configuration Word,
and Code Protection.
managed
automatically
by
device
development tools, including debuggers
and programmers. For normal device
operation, this bit should be maintained as
a '1'.
12.1 Configuration Word
There are several Configuration Word bits that allow
different timers to be enabled and memory protection
options. These are implemented as Configuration
Word at 2007h.
REGISTER 12-1: CONFIG – CONFIGURATION WORD REGISTER
R/P-1
U-1
—
R/P-1
WRT1
R/P-1
U-1
—
U-1
—
DBGEN
WRT0
bit 13
bit 8
bit 0
U-1
—
R/P-1
CP
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
U-1
—
U-1
—
U-1
—
MCLRE
PWRTE
WDTE
bit 7
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 13
DBGEN: ICD Debug bit
1= ICD debug mode disabled
0= ICD debug mode enabled
bit 12
Unimplemented: Read as ‘1’
bit 11-10
WRT<1:0>: Flash Program Memory Self Write Enable bit
11= Write protection off
10= 000h to 3FFh write protected, 400h to FFFh may be modified by PMCON1 control
01= 000h to 7FFh write protected, 800h to FFFh may be modified by PMCON1 control
00= 000h to FFFh write protected, entire program memory is write protected.
bit 9-7
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘1’
CP: Code Protection
1= Program memory code protection is disabled
0= Program memory code protection is enabled
bit 5
MCLRE: MCLR Pin Function Select
1= MCLR pin is MCLR function and weak internal pull-up is enabled
0= MCLR pin is alternate function, MCLR function is internally disabled
bit 4
PWRTE: Power-up Timer Enable bit
1= PWRT disabled
0= PWRT enabled
bit 3
WDTE: Watchdog Timer Enable bit
1= WDT enabled
0= WDT disabled
bit 2-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘1’
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 81
MCP19110/11
12.2 Code Protection
12.3 Write Protection
Code protection allows the device to be protected from
unauthorized access. Internal access to the program
memory is unaffected by any code protection setting.
Write protection allows the device to be protected from
unintended self-writes. Applications, such as
bootloader software, can be protected while allowing
other regions of the program memory to be modified.
12.2.1
PROGRAM MEMORY PROTECTION
The WRT<1:0> bits in the Configuration Word define
the size of the program memory block that is protected.
The entire program memory space is protected from
external reads and writes by the CP bit in the
Configuration Word. When CP = 0, external reads and
writes of the program memory are inhibited and a read
will return all ‘0’s. The CPU can continue to read
program memory, regardless of the protection bit
settings. Writing the program memory is dependent
upon the write protection setting. See Section 12.3
“Write Protection” for more information.
12.4 ID Locations
Four memory locations (2000h – 2003h) are
designated as ID locations where the user can store
checksum or other code identification numbers. These
locations are not accessible during normal execution
but are readable and writable during Program/Verify
mode. Only the Least Significant seven bits of the ID
locations are reported when using MPLAB Integrated
Development Environment (IDE).
DS20002331D-page 82
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
13.3 Frequency Tuning in User Mode
13.0 OSCILLATOR MODES
In addition to the factory calibration, the base
frequency can be tuned in the user's application. This
frequency tuning capability allows the user to deviate
from the factory-calibrated frequency. The user can
tune the frequency by writing to the OSCTUNE
register (see Register 13-1).
The MCP19110/11 has one oscillator configuration
which is an 8 MHz internal oscillator.
13.1 Internal Oscillator (INTOSC)
The Internal Oscillator module provides a system
clock source of 8 MHz. The frequency of the internal
oscillator can be trimmed with a calibration value in the
OSCTUNE register.
13.2 Oscillator Calibration
The 8 MHz internal oscillator is factory calibrated. The
factory calibration values reside in the read-only
Calibration Word 1 register. These values must be read
from the Calibration Word 1 register and stored in the
OSCCAL register. Refer to Section 18.0 “Flash
Program Memory Control” for the procedure on
reading from program memory.
Note 1: The FCAL<6:0> bits from the Calibration
Word 1 register must be written into the
OSCCAL register to calibrate the internal
oscillator.
REGISTER 13-1: OSCTUNE – OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
TUN4
R/W-0
TUN3
R/W-0
TUN2
R/W-0
TUN1
R/W-0
TUN0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
bit 4-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
TUN<4:0>: Frequency Tuning bits
01111= Maximum frequency
01110=
•
•
•
00001=
00000= Center frequency. Oscillator Module is running at the calibrated frequency.
11111=
•
•
•
10000= Minimum frequency
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 83
MCP19110/11
On power up, the device is held in reset by the
power-up time, if the power-up timer is enabled.
13.3.1
OSCILLATOR DELAY UPON
POWER-UP, WAKE-UP AND
BASE FREQUENCY CHANGE
Following a wake-up from Sleep mode or POR, an
internal delay of ~10 µs is invoked to allow the
memory bias to stabilize before program execution
can begin.
In applications where the OSCTUNE register is used to
shift the frequency of the internal oscillator, the
application should not expect the frequency of the
internal oscillator to stabilize immediately. In this case,
the frequency may shift gradually toward the new
value. The time for this frequency shift is less than eight
cycles of the base frequency.
TABLE 13-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH CLOCK SOURCES
Register
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
OSCTUNE
—
—
—
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
83
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by clock sources.
TABLE 13-2: SUMMARY OF CALIBRATION WORD ASSOCIATED WITH CLOCK SOURCES
Register
on Page
Name
Bits Bit -/7 Bit -/6
Bit 13/5
Bit 12/4
Bit 11/3
Bit 10/2
Bit 9/1
Bit 8/0
CALWD1
13:8
7:0
—
—
—
—
—
DOV3
DOV2
DOV1
DOV0
59
FCAL6
FCAL5
FCAL4
FCAL3
FCAL2
FCAL1
FCAL0
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by clock sources.
DS20002331D-page 84
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
Some registers are not affected in any Reset condition;
their status is unknown on POR and unchanged in any
other Reset. Most other registers are reset to a “Reset
state” on:
14.0 RESETS
The Reset logic is used to place the MCP19110/11 into
a known state. The source of the Reset can be
determined by using the device status bits.
• Power-on Reset
• MCLR Reset
There are multiple ways to reset this device:
• Power-on Reset (POR)
• Overtemperature Reset (OT)
• MCLR Reset
• MCLR Reset during Sleep
• WDT Reset
WDT wake-up does not cause register resets in the
same manner as a WDT Reset, since wake-up is
viewed as the resumption of normal operation. TO and
PD bits are set or cleared differently in different Reset
situations, as indicated in Table 14-1. Software can use
these bits to determine the nature of the Reset. See
Table 14-2 for a full description of Reset states of all
registers.
• WDT Reset
To allow VDD to stabilize, an optional power-up timer
can be enabled to extend the Reset time after a POR
event.
A simplified block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit
is shown in Figure 14-1.
The MCLR Reset path has a noise filter to detect and
ignore small pulses. See Section 5.0 “Digital
Electrical
Characteristics”
for
pulse-width
specifications.
FIGURE 14-1:
SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT
External
Reset
MCLR/VPP pin
Sleep
WDT
WDT
Module
Time-out
Reset
VDD Rise
Detect
Power-on Reset
VDD
S
R
PWRT
Chip_Reset
On-Chip
RC OSC
11-bit Ripple Counter
Q
Enable PWRT
Note 1: Refer to the Configuration Word register (Register 12-1).
TABLE 14-1: TIME-OUT IN VARIOUS
SITUATIONS
Power-up
Wake-up from
Sleep
PWRTE = 0
PWRTE = 1
TPWRT
—
—
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 85
MCP19110/11
TABLE 14-2: STATUS/PCON BITS AND THEIR SIGNIFICANCE
POR
TO
PD
Condition
0
u
u
1
0
0
1
u
0
Power-on Reset
WDT Reset
WDT Wake-up
u
u
u
1
u
0
MCLR Reset during normal operation
MCLR Reset during Sleep
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown
14.1 Power-on Reset (POR)
14.2 MCLR
The on-chip POR circuit holds the chip in Reset until
VDD has reached a high enough level for proper
operation. To take advantage of the POR, simply
connect the MCLR pin through a resistor to VDD. This
will eliminate external RC components usually needed
to create Power-on Reset.
MCP19110/11 has a noise filter in the MCLR Reset
path. The filter will detect and ignore small pulses.
It should be noted that a WDT Reset does not drive
MCLR pin low.
Voltages applied to the MCLR pin that exceed its
specification can result in both MCLR Resets and
excessive current beyond the device specification
during the ESD event. For this reason, Microchip
recommends that the MCLR pin no longer be tied
directly to VDD. The use of an RC network, as shown in
Figure 14-2, is suggested.
Note:
The POR circuit does not produce an
internal Reset when VDD declines. To
re-enable the POR, VDD must reach VSS
for a minimum of 100 µs.
When the device starts normal operation (exits the
Reset condition), device operating parameters (i.e.,
voltage, frequency, temperature, etc.) must be met to
ensure proper operation. If these conditions are not
met, the device must be held in Reset until the
operating conditions are met.
An internal MCLR option is enabled by clearing the
MCLRE bit in the Configuration Word register. When
MCLRE = 0, the Reset signal to the chip is generated
internally. When the MCLRE = 1, the MCLR pin
becomes an external Reset input. In this mode, the
MCLR pin has a weak pull-up to VDD
.
FIGURE 14-2:
RECOMMENDED MCLR
CIRCUIT
VDD
R1
1 k (or greater)
R2
MCLR
100
(needed with
capacitor)
C1
SW1
(optional)
0.1 µF
(optional, not critical)
DS20002331D-page 86
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
14.3 Power-up Timer (PWRT)
14.5 Power-Up Timer
The Power-up Timer provides a fixed 64 ms (nominal)
time-out on power-up only, from POR Reset. The
Power-up Timer operates from an internal RC
oscillator. The chip is kept in Reset as long as PWRT is
active. The PWRT delay allows the VDD to rise to an
acceptable level. A Configuration bit (PWRTE), can
disable (if set) or enable (if cleared or programmed) the
Power-up Timer.
The Power-up Timer optionally delays device execution
after a POR event. This timer is typically used to allow
VDD to stabilize before allowing the device to start
running.
The Power-up Timer is controlled by the PWRTE bit of
Configuration Word.
14.6 Start-up Sequence
The Power-up Timer delay will vary from chip-to-chip
due to:
Upon the release of a POR, the following must occur
before the device will begin executing:
• VDD variation
• Power-up Timer runs to completion (if enabled)
• Oscillator start-up timer runs to completion
• MCLR must be released (if enabled)
• Temperature variation
• Process variation
Note:
Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR
pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA,
may cause latch-up. Thus, a series resis-
tor of 50-100 should be used when
applying a “low” level to the MCLR pin,
The total time-out will vary based on PWRTE bit status.
For example, with PWRTE bit erased (PWRT disabled),
there will be no time-out at all. Figures 14-3, 14-4
and 14-5 depict time-out sequences.
Since the time-outs occur from the POR pulse, if MCLR
is kept low long enough, the time-outs will expire. Then,
bringing MCLR high will begin execution immediately
(see Figure 14-4). This is useful for testing purposes or
to synchronize more than one MCP19110/11 device
operating in parallel.
rather than pulling this pin directly to VSS
.
14.4 Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset
The Watchdog Timer generates a Reset if the firmware
does not issue a CLRWDTinstruction within the time-out
period. The TO and PD bits in the STATUS register are
changed to indicate the WDT Reset. See Section 17.0
“Watchdog Timer (WDT)” for more information.
14.6.1
POWER CONTROL (PCON)
REGISTER
The Power Control register PCON (address 8Eh) has
two Status bits to indicate what type of Reset occurred
last.
FIGURE 14-3:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (DELAYED MCLR): CASE 1
VDD
MCLR
Internal POR
TPWRT
PWRT Time-out
OST Time-out
Internal Reset
TIOSCST
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 87
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 14-4:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (DELAYED MCLR): CASE 2
VDD
MCLR
Internal POR
TPWRT
PWRT Time-out
OST Time-out
Internal Reset
TIOSCST
FIGURE 14-5:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR WITH V
)
DD
VDD
MCLR
Internal POR
TPWRT
PWRT Time-out
OST Time-out
Internal Reset
TIOSCST
DS20002331D-page 88
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 14-3: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS
Wake-up from Sleep through
Interrupt
Wake-up from Sleep through
WDT Time-out
Power-on
Reset
MCLR Reset
WDT Reset
Register
Address
W
—
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
INDF
00h/80h/
100h/180h
TMR0
PCL
01h/101h
xxxx xxxx
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PC + 1(3)
02h/82h/
102h/182h
STATUS
FSR
03h/83h/
103h/183h
0001 1xxx
xxxx xxxx
000q quuu(4)
uuuu uuuu
uuuq quuu(4)
uuuu uuuu
04h/84h/
104h/184h
PORTGPA
PORTGPB
PIR1
05h
06h
07h
08h
09h
xxxx xxxx
xxx- xxxx
-000 --00
0-00 --00
---- -qq-
---0 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuu- uuuu
-000 --00
0-00 --00
---- -uu-
---0 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuu- uuuu
-uuu --uu
u-uu --uu
---- -uu-
---u uuuu
PIR2
PCON
PCLATH
0Ah/8Ah/
10Ah/18Ah
INTCON
0Bh/8Bh/
0000 000x
0000 000u
uuuu uuuu(2)
10Bh/18Bh
TMR1L
0Ch
0Dh
0Eh
0Fh
10h
11h
13h
14h
15h
16h
19h
1Ah
1Bh
1Ch
1Dh
1Eh
1Fh
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
--00 --00
0000 0000
---- -000
1111 1111
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
0000 0000
0--0 0000
---0 0000
xxxx xxxx
---- --xx
-000 0000
-000 ----
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu --uu
uuuu uuuu
---- -000
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
0--0 0000
---0 0000
uuuu uuuu
---- --uu
-000 0000
-000 ----
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu --uu
uuuu uuuu
---- -uuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
u--u uuuu
---u uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---- ---uu
-uuu uuuu
-uuu ----
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR1H
T1CON
TMR2
T2CON
PR2
PWMPHL
PWMPHH
PWMRL
PWMRH
OVCCON
OVFCON
OSCTUNE
ADRESL(1)
ADRESH(1)
ADCON0(1)
ADCON1(1)
OPTION_REG 81h/181h
TRISGPA
TRISGPB
Legend:
85h
86h
u= unchanged, x= unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q= value depends on condition.
Note 1: If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently.
2: One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIRx will be affected (to cause wake-up).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h).
4: See Table 14-5 for Reset value for specific condition.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 89
MCP19110/11
TABLE 14-3: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Wake-up from Sleep through
Power-on
Reset
MCLR Reset
WDT Reset
Interrupt
Wake-up from Sleep through
WDT Time-out
Register
Address
PIE1
87h
88h
-000 --00
0-00 --00
---- ---0
0-xx xxxx
0xxx xxxx
-xxx xxxx
0--- xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
---x xxxx
0000 0000
--1- 1111
1111 -11-
0000 1100
000- 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
xxxx xxxx
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
1111 1111
-000 --00
0-00 --00
---- ---0
0-uu uuuu
0uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
0--- uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---u uuuu
0000 0000
--u- uuuu
uuuu -uu-
0000 1100
000- 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
-uuu --uu
u-uu --uu
---- ---u
u-uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
u--- uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---u uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--u- uuuu
uuuu -uu-
uuuu uuuu
uuu- uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PIE2
APFCON
VINLVL
89h
90h
OCCON
91h
CSGSCON
CSDGCON
VZCCON
CMPZCON
OUVCON
OOVCON
DEADCON
SLPCRCON
SLVGNCON
RELEFF
WPUGPA
WPUGPB
PE1
93h
95h
97h
98h
99h
9Ah
9Bh
9Ch
9Dh
9Eh
105h
106h
107h
108h
109h
110h
111h
112h
113h
114h
115h
116h
117h
118h
185h
186h
187h
188h
190h
191h
192h
193h
194h
BUFFCON
ABECON
SSPADD
SSPBUF
SSPCON1
SSPCON2
SSPCON3
SSPMSK
SSPSTAT
SSPADD2
SSPMSK2
IOCA
1111 1111
0000 0000
1111 1111
0000 0000
0000 -000
---- 1111
--11 -11-
-0-- -000
---- ----
0000 0000
---- -000
0000 0000
0000 0000
1111 1111
0000 0000
0000 -000
---- 1111
--11 -11-
-0-- -000
---- ----
0000 0000
---- -000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu -uuu
---- uuuu
--uu -uu-
-u-- -uuu
---- ----
uuuu uuuu
---- -uuu
uuuu uuuu
IOCB
ANSELA
ANSELB
PMCON1
PMCON2
PMADRL
PMADRH
PMDATL
Legend:
u= unchanged, x= unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q= value depends on condition.
Note 1: If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently.
2: One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIRx will be affected (to cause wake-up).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h).
4: See Table 14-5 for Reset value for specific condition.
DS20002331D-page 90
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 14-3: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Wake-up from Sleep through
Interrupt
Wake-up from Sleep through
WDT Time-out
Power-on
Reset
MCLR Reset
WDT Reset
Register
Address
PMDATH
195h
198h
199h
19Ah
19Bh
19Ch
19Dh
19F
--00 0000
-xxx xxxx
---- xxxx
---- xxxx
---- xxxx
---- xxxx
---- xxxx
1--- 0001
--00 0000
-uuu uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
1--- 0001
--uu uuuu
-uuu uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
u--- uuuu
OSCCAL
DOVCAL
TTACAL
BGRCAL
VROCAL
ZROCAL
ATSTCON
Legend:
u= unchanged, x= unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q= value depends on condition.
Note 1: If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently.
2: One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIRx will be affected (to cause wake-up).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h).
4: See Table 14-5 for Reset value for specific condition.
14.7 Determining the Cause of a Reset
TABLE 14-4: RESET STATUS BITS AND
THEIR SIGNIFICANCE
Upon any Reset, multiple bits in the STATUS and
PCON register are updated to indicate the cause of the
Reset. Table 14-4 and Table 14-5 show the Reset
conditions of these registers.
POR TO PD
Condition
0
u
u
u
u
1
0
0
1
u
1
u
0
0
u
Power-on Reset
WDT Reset
WDT Wake-up from Sleep
Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep
MCLR Reset during normal
operation
u
0
0
1
0
x
0
x
0
MCLR Reset during Sleep
Not allowed. TO is set on POR
Not allowed. PD is set on POR
TABLE 14-5: RESET CONDITION FOR SPECIAL REGISTERS (Note 2)
Program
Counter
STATUS
PCON
Register
Condition
Register
0001 1xxx
000u uuuu
Power-on Reset
0000h
0000h
---- -u0-
---- -uu-
MCLR Reset during normal operation
MCLR Reset during Sleep
WDT Reset
0000h
0000h
0001 0uuu
0000 uuuu
uuu0 0uuu
uuu1 0uuu
---- -uu-
---- -uu-
---- -uu-
---- -uu-
WDT Wake-up from Sleep
Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep
PC + 1
PC + 1(1)
Legend:
u= unchanged, x= unknown, -= unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’.
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and Global Enable bit (GIE) is set, the return address is pushed on the stack
and PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h) after execution of PC + 1.
2: If a Status bit is not implemented, that bit will be read as ‘0’.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 91
MCP19110/11
14.8 Power Control (PCON) Register
The Power Control (PCON) register contains flag bits
to differentiate between a:
• Power-on Reset (POR)
• Overtemperature (OT)
The PCON register bits are shown in Register 14-1.
REGISTER 14-1: PCON – POWER CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
OT
R/W-0
POR
U-0
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-3
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as '0'
OT: Overtemperature Reset Status bit
1= No Overtemperature Reset occurred
0= An Overtemperature Reset occurred (must be set in software after an Overtemperature occurs)
bit 1
bit 0
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit
1= No Power-on Reset occurred
0= A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs)
Unimplemented: Read as '0'
TABLE 0-1:
Name
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH RESETS
Register
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
on Page
PCON
—
—
—
—
—
OT
Z
POR
DC
—
C
92
71
STATUS
IPR
RP1
RP0
TO
PD
Legend: — = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by Resets.
Note 1: Other (non Power-up) Resets include MCLR Reset and Watchdog Timer Reset during normal operation.
DS20002331D-page 92
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
15.1 Interrupt Latency
15.0 INTERRUPTS
For external interrupt events, such as the INT pin or
PORTGPx change interrupt, the interrupt latency will
be three or four instruction cycles. The exact latency
depends upon when the interrupt event occurs (see
Figure 15-2). The latency is the same for one or
two-cycle instructions.
The MCP19110/11 has multiple sources of interrupt:
• External Interrupt (INT pin)
• Interrupt-On-Change (IOC) Interrupts
• Timer0 Overflow Interrupt
• Timer1 Overflow Interrupt
• Timer2 Match Interrupt
• ADC Interrupt
15.2 GPA2/INT Interrupt
• System Overvoltage Error
• System Undervoltage Error
• System Overcurrent Error
• SSP
The external interrupt on the GPA2/INT pin is
edge-triggered; either on the rising edge, if the INTEDG
bit of the OPTION register is set, or the falling edge, if
the INTEDG bit is cleared. When a valid edge appears
on the GPA2/INT pin, the INTF bit of the INTCON
register is set. This interrupt can be disabled by
clearing the INTE control bit of the INTCON register.
The INTF bit must be cleared by software in the
Interrupt Service Routine before re-enabling this
interrupt. The GPA2/INT interrupt can wake-up the
processor from Sleep, if the INTE bit was set prior to
going into Sleep. See Section 16.0 “Power-Down
Mode (Sleep)” for details on Sleep, and Section 16.1
“Wake-up from Sleep” for timing of wake-up from
Sleep through GPA2/INT interrupt.
• BCL
• System Input Undervoltage Error
The Interrupt Control register (INTCON) and Peripheral
Interrupt Request Registers (PIRx) record individual
interrupt requests in flag bits. The INTCON register
also has individual and global interrupt enable bits.
The Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE of the INTCON
register, enables (if set) all unmasked interrupts, or
disables (if cleared) all interrupts. Individual interrupts
can be disabled through their corresponding enable
bits in the INTCON register and PIEx registers. GIE is
cleared on Reset.
Note:
The ANSEL register must be initialized to
configure an analog channel as a digital
input. Pins configured as analog inputs
will read ‘0’ and cannot generate an
interrupt.
When an interrupt is serviced, the following actions
occur automatically:
• The GIE is cleared to disable any further interrupt.
• The return address is pushed onto the stack.
• The PC is loaded with 0004h.
The firmware within the Interrupt Service Routine (ISR)
should determine the source of the interrupt by polling
the interrupt flag bits. The interrupt flag bits must be
cleared before exiting the ISR, to avoid repeated
interrupts. Because the GEI bit is cleared, any interrupt
that occurs while executing the ISR will be recorded
through its interrupt flag, but will not cause the
processor to redirect to the interrupt vector.
Note 1: Individual interrupt flag bits are set,
regardless of the status of their
corresponding mask bit or the GIE bit.
2: When an instruction that clears the GIE
bit is executed, any interrupts that were
pending for execution in the next cycle
are ignored. The interrupts, which were
ignored, are still pending to be serviced
when the GIE bit is set again.
The RETFIEinstruction exists the ISR by popping the
previous address from the stack, restoring the saved
context from the shadow registers and setting the GIE
bit.
For additional information on a specific Interrupt’s oper-
ation, refer to its Peripheral chapter.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 93
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 15-1:
INTERRUPT LOGIC
UVIF
UVIE
OVIF
OVIE
OCIF
OCIE
VINIF
VINIE
T0IF
T0IE
Wake-up (If in Sleep mode)
Interrupt to CPU
INTF
INTE
ADIF
ADIE
IOCF
IOCE
BCLIF
BCLIE
PEIF
PEIE
SSPIF
SSPIE
GIE
TMR2IF
TMR2IE
TMR1IF
TMR1IE
FIGURE 15-2:
INT PIN INTERRUPT TIMING
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
CLKIN
(3)
CLKOUT
(4)
INT pin
(1)
(1)
(5)
(2)
Interrupt Latency
INTF flag
(INTCON reg.)
GIE bit
(INTCON reg.)
INSTRUCTION FLOW
PC
PC + 1
—
0004h
0005h
PC
PC + 1
Instruction
Fetched
Inst (PC + 1)
Inst (0004h)
Inst (PC)
Inst (0005h)
Inst (0004h)
Instruction
Executed
Dummy Cycle
Dummy Cycle
Inst (PC)
Inst (PC – 1)
Note 1: INTF flag is sampled here (every Q1).
2: Asynchronous interrupt latency = 3-4 T . Synchronous latency = 3 T , where T = instruction cycle time.
CY
CY
CY
Latency is the same whether Inst (PC) is a single cycle or a 2-cycle instruction.
3: CLKOUT is available only in INTOSC and RC Oscillator modes.
4: For minimum width of INT pulse, refer to AC specifications in Section 5.0 “Digital Electrical Characteristics”.
5: INTF is enabled to be set any time during the Q4-Q1 cycles.
DS20002331D-page 94
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
15.3 Interrupt Control Registers
Note:
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the Global
Enable bit, GIE, of the INTCON register.
User software should ensure the appropri-
ate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to
enabling an interrupt.
15.3.1
INTCON REGISTER
The INTCON register is a readable and writable regis-
ter, that contains the various enable and flag bits for the
TMR0 register overflow, interrupt-on-change and exter-
nal INT pin interrupts.
REGISTER 15-1: INTCON – INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
GIE
R/W-0
PEIE
R/W-0
T0IE
R/W-0
INTE
R/W-0
IOCE
R/W-0
T0IF
R/W-0
INTF
R/W-x
IOCF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
GIE: Global Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables all unmasked interrupts
0= Disables all interrupts
PEIE: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables all unmasked peripheral interrupts
0= Disables all peripheral interrupts
T0IE: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the TMR0 interrupt
0= Disables the TMR0 interrupt
INTE: INT External Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the INT external interrupt
0= Disables the INT external interrupt
IOCE: Interrupt-on-Change Enable bit(1)
1 = Enables the interrupt-on-change
0 = Disables the interrupt-on-change
T0IF: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit(2)
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
1= TMR0 register has overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0= TMR0 register did not overflow
INTF: External Interrupt Flag bit
1= The external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0= The external interrupt did not occur
IOCF: Interrupt-on-Change Interrupt Flag bit
1= When at least one of the interrupt-on-change pins changed state
0= None of the interrupt-on-change pins have changed state
Note 1: IOC register must also be enabled.
2: T0IF bit is set when TMR0 rolls over. TMR0 is unchanged on Reset and should be initialized before clear-
ing T0IF bit.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 95
MCP19110/11
15.3.1.1
PIE1 Register
The PIE1 register contains the Peripheral Interrupt
Enable bits, as shown in Register 15-2.
Note 1: Bit PEIE of the INTCON register must be
set to enable any peripheral interrupt.
REGISTER 15-2: PIE1 – PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 1
U-0
—
R/W-0
ADIE
R/W-0
BCLIE
R/W-0
SSPIE
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
ADIE: ADC Interrupt Enable bit
bit 6-0
1= Enables the ADC interrupt
0= Disables the ADC interrupt
bit 6-0
bit 6-0
BCLIE: MSSP Bus Collision Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the MSSP Bus Collision Interrupt
0 = Disables the MSSP Bus Collision Interrupt
SSPIE: Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the MSSP interrupt
0 = Disables the MSSP interrupt
bit 6-0
bit 6-0
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as 0
TMR2IE: Timer2 Interrupt Enable
1= Enables the Timer2 interrupt
0= Disables the Timer2 interrupt
bit 6-0
TMR1IE: Timer1 Interrupt Enable
1= Enables the Timer1 interrupt
0= Disables the Timer1 interrupt
DS20002331D-page 96
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
15.3.1.2
PIE2 Register
The PIE2 register contains the Peripheral Interrupt
Enable bits, as shown in Register 15-3.
Note 1: Bit PEIE of the INTCON register must be
set to enable any peripheral interrupt.
REGISTER 15-3: PIE2 – PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 2
U-0
U-0
—
R/W-0
OCIE
R/W-0
OVIE
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
VINIE
U-0
—
UVIE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
UVIE: Output Undervoltage Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the UV interrupt
0= Disables the UV interrupt
bit 6
bit 5
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
OCIE: Output Overcurrent Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the OC interrupt
0= Disables the OC interrupt
bit 4
OVIE: Output Overvoltage Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the OV interrupt
0= Disables the OV interrupt
bit 3-2
bit 1
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
VINIE: VIN UVLO Interrupt Enable
1= Enables the VIN UVLO interrupt
0= Disables the VIN UVLO interrupt
bit 0
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 97
MCP19110/11
15.3.1.3
PIR1 Register
The PIR1 register contains the Peripheral Interrupt
Flag bits, as shown in Register 15-4.
Note 1: Interrupt flag bits are set when an
interrupt condition occurs, regardless of
the state of its corresponding enable bit
or the Global Enable bit, GIE of the
INTCON register. User software should
ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt.
REGISTER 15-4: PIR1 – PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT FLAG REGISTER 1
U-0
—
R/W-0
ADIF
R/W-0
BCLIF
R/W-0
SSPIF
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
ADIF: ADC Interrupt Flag bit
1= ADC conversion complete
0= ADC conversion has not completed or has not been started
BCLIF: MSSP Bus Collision Interrupt Flag bit
1= Interrupt is pending
bit 5
bit 4
0= Interrupt is not pending
SSPIF: Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) Interrupt Flag bit
1= Interrupt is pending
0= Interrupt is not pending
bit 3-2
bit 1
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
TMR2IF: Timer2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Flag
1= Timer2 to PR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0= Timer2 to PR2 match did not occur
TMR1IF: Timer1 Interrupt Flag
bit 0
1= Timer1 rolled over (must be cleared in software)
0= Timer1 has not rolled over
DS20002331D-page 98
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
15.3.1.4
PIR2 Register
The PIR2 register contains the Peripheral Interrupt
Flag bits, as shown in Register 15-5.
Note 1: Interrupt flag bits are set when an
interrupt condition occurs, regardless of
the state of its corresponding enable bit
or the Global Enable bit, GIE of the
INTCON register. User software should
ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt.
REGISTER 15-5: PIR2 – PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT FLAG REGISTER 2
R/W-0
UVIF
U-0
—
R/W-0
OCIF
R/W-0
OVIF
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
VINIF
U-0
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
UVIF: Output Undervoltage Error Interrupt Flag bit
1= Output undervoltage error has occurred
0= Output undervoltage error has not occurred
bit 6
bit 5
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
OCIF: Output Overcurrent Error Interrupt Flag bit
1= Output overcurrent error has occurred
0= Output overcurrent error has not occurred
bit 4
OVIF: Output Overvoltage Error Interrupt Flag bit
1= Output overvoltage error has occurred
0= Output overvoltage error has not occurred
bit 3-2
bit 1
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
VINIF: VIN Status bit
1= VIN is below acceptable level
0= VIN is at acceptable level
UNIMPLEMENTED: Read as '0'
bit 0
TABLE 15-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH INTERRUPTS
Register
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
GIE
RAPU
—
PEIE
INTEDG
ADIE
—
T0IE
T0CE
BCLIE
OCIE
BCLIF
OCIF
INTE
T0SE
SSPIE
OVIE
SSPIF
OVIF
IOCE
PSA
—
T0IF
PS2
—
INTF
PS1
IOCF
PS0
95
77
96
97
98
99
OPTION_REG
PIE1
TMR2IE TMR1IE
VINIE
TMR2IF TMR1IF
VINIF
PIE2
UVIE
—
—
—
—
PIR1
ADIF
—
—
—
PIR2
UVIF
—
—
—
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by Interrupts.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 99
MCP19110/11
15.4 Context Saving During Interrupts
During an interrupt, only the return PC value is saved
on the stack. Typically, users may wish to save key
registers during an interrupt (e.g., W and STATUS
registers). This must be implemented in software.
Temporary
holding
registers
W_TEMP
and
STATUS_TEMP should be placed in the last 16 bytes
of GPR (see Figure 11-2). These 16 locations are
common to all banks and do not require banking. This
makes context save and restore operations simpler.
The code shown in Example 15-1 can be used to:
• Store the W register
• Store the STATUS register
• Execute the ISR code
• Restore the Status (and Bank Select Bit register)
• Restore the W register
Note:
The MCP19110/11 device does not
require saving the PCLATH. However, if
computed GOTOs are used in both the ISR
and the main code, the PCLATH must be
saved and restored in the ISR.
EXAMPLE 15-1:
SAVING STATUS AND W REGISTERS IN RAM
MOVWF
SWAPF
W_TEMP
STATUS,W
;Copy W to TEMP register
;Swap status to be saved into W
;Swaps are used because they do not affect the status bits
;Save status to bank zero STATUS_TEMP register
MOVWF
:
STATUS_TEMP
:(ISR)
:
;Insert user code here
SWAPF
STATUS_TEMP,W
;Swap STATUS_TEMP register into W
;(sets bank to original state)
;Move W into STATUS register
;Swap W_TEMP
MOVWF
SWAPF
SWAPF
STATUS
W_TEMP,F
W_TEMP,W
;Swap W_TEMP into W
DS20002331D-page 100
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
16.1 Wake-up from Sleep
16.0 POWER-DOWN MODE (SLEEP)
The device can wake-up from Sleep through one of the
following events:
The Power-Down mode is entered by executing a
SLEEPinstruction.
1. External Reset input on MCLR pin, if enabled
2. POR Reset
Upon entering Sleep mode, the following conditions
exist:
3. Watchdog Timer, if enabled
4. Any external interrupt
1. WDT will be cleared but keeps running, if
enabled for operation during Sleep.
2. PD bit of the STATUS register is cleared.
3. TO bit of the STATUS register is set.
4. CPU clock is not disabled.
5. Interrupts by peripherals capable of running
during Sleep (see individual peripheral for more
information)
The first two events will cause a device Reset. The last
three events are considered a continuation of program
execution. To determine whether a device Reset or
Wake-up event occurred, refer to Section 14.7
“Determining the Cause of a Reset”.
5. Timer1 oscillator is unaffected, and peripherals
that operate from it may continue operation in
Sleep.
6. ADC is unaffected.
7. I/O ports maintain the status they had before
SLEEP was executed (driving high, low or
high-impedance).
The following peripheral interrupts can wake the device
from Sleep:
8. Resets other than WDT are not affected by
Sleep mode.
1. Timer1 interrupt. Timer1 must be operating as
an asynchronous counter
9. Analog circuitry is unaffected by execution of
2. A/D conversion
SLEEPinstruction.
3. Interrupt-on-change
4. External Interrupt from INT pin
Refer to individual chapters for more details on
peripheral operation during Sleep.
When the SLEEPinstruction is being executed, the next
instruction (PC + 1) is prefetched. For the device to
wake-up through an interrupt event, the corresponding
interrupt enable bit must be enabled. Wake-up will
occur regardless of the state of the GIE bit. If the GIE
bit is disabled, the device continues execution at the
instruction after the SLEEPinstruction. If the GIE bit is
enabled, the device executes the instruction after the
SLEEPinstruction, the device will then call the Interrupt
Service Routine. In cases where the execution of the
instruction following SLEEP is not desirable, the user
should have an NOPafter the SLEEPinstruction.
To minimize current consumption, the following
conditions should be considered:
• I/O pins should not be floating
• External circuitry sinking current from I/O pins
• Internal circuitry sourcing current from I/O pins
• Current draw from pins with internal weak pull-ups
• Modules using Timer1 oscillator
I/O pins that are high-impedance inputs should be
pulled to VDD or GND externally to avoid switching
currents caused by floating inputs.
The WDT is cleared when the device wakes up from
Sleep, regardless of the source of wake-up.
The SLEEP instruction does not affect the analog
circuitry. The enable state of the analog circuitry does
not change with the execution of the SLEEPinstruction.
Examples of internal circuitry that might be sourcing
current include modules, such as the DAC. See
Section 22.0 “Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Module” for more information on this module.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 101
MCP19110/11
• If the interrupt occurs during or after the
execution of a SLEEPinstruction:
16.1.1
WAKE-UP USING INTERRUPTS
When global interrupts are disabled (GIE cleared) and
any interrupt source has both its interrupt enable bit
and interrupt flag bit set, one of the following will occur:
- SLEEPinstruction will be completely
executed
- Device will immediately wake-up from Sleep
- WDT and WDT prescaler will be cleared
- TO bit of the STATUS register will be set
- PD bit of the STATUS register will be cleared
• If the interrupt occurs before the execution of a
SLEEPinstruction:
- SLEEPinstruction will execute as an NOP
- WDT and WDT prescaler will not be cleared
- TO bit of the STATUS register will not be set
Even if the flag bits were checked before executing a
SLEEP instruction, it may be possible for flag bits to
become set before the SLEEPinstruction completes. To
determine whether a SLEEPinstruction executed, test
the PD bit. If the PD bit is set, the SLEEP instruction
was executed as an NOP.
- PD bit of the STATUS register will not be
cleared
FIGURE 16-1:
OSC
WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP THROUGH INTERRUPT
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
TOST
(1)
Interrupt flag
Interrupt Latency
GIE bit
(INTCON reg.)
Processor in
Sleep
Instruction Flow
PC
PC
PC + 1
PC + 2
PC + 2
PC + 2
0004h
0005h
Instruction
Fetched
Inst(0004h)
Inst(PC + 1)
Inst(PC + 2)
Inst(0005h)
Inst(PC) = Sleep
Instruction
Dummy Cycle Dummy Cycle
Sleep
Inst(PC + 1)
Inst(PC - 1)
Inst(0004h)
Executed
Note 1: GIE = 1assumed. In this case, after wake-up, the processor calls the ISR at 0004h. If GIE = 0, execution
will continue in-line.
TABLE 16-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH POWER-DOWN MODE
Register on
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Page
INTCON
IOCA
IOCB
PIE1
GIE
IOCA7
IOCB7
—
PEIE
IOCA6
IOCB6
ADIE
—
T0IE
IOCA5
IOCB5
BCLIE
OCIE
BCLIF
OCIF
INTE
IOCA4
IOCB4
SSPIE
OVIE
SSPIF
OVIF
IOCE
IOCA3
—
T0IF
IOCA2
IOCB2
—
INTF
IOCA1
IOCB1
IOCF
IOCA0
IOCB0
95
122
122
96
—
TMR2IE TMR1IE
VINIE
TMR2IF TMR1IF
PIE2
UVIE
—
—
—
—
97
PIR1
ADIF
—
—
—
98
PIR2
UVIF
IRP
—
—
VINIF
DC
—
C
99
STATUS
RP1
RP0
TO
PD
Z
71
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used in Power-down mode.
DS20002331D-page 102
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
17.2 WDT Period
17.0 WATCHDOG TIMER (WDT)
The WDT has a nominal time-out period of 18 ms (with
no prescaler). The time-out periods vary with
temperature, VDD and process variations from part to
part (see Table 5-4). If longer time-out periods are
desired, a prescaler with a division ratio of up to 1:128
can be assigned to the WDT under software control by
writing to the OPTION register. Thus, time-out periods
up to 2.3 seconds can be realized.
The Watchdog Timer is a free-running timer. The WDT
is enabled by setting the WDTE bit of the Configuration
Word (default setting).
During normal operation, a WDT time-out generates a
device Reset. If the device is in Sleep mode, a WDT
time-out causes the device to wake-up and continue
with normal operation.
The WDT can be permanently disabled by clearing the
WDTE bit of the Configuration word. See Section 12.1
“Configuration Word” for more information.
The CLRWDT and SLEEP instructions clear the WDT
and the prescaler, if assigned to the WDT, and prevent
it from timing out and generating a device Reset.
The TO bit in the STATUS register will be cleared upon
a Watchdog Timer time-out.
17.1 Watchdog Timer (WDT) Operation
During normal operation, a WDT time-out generates a
device RESET. If the device is in SLEEP mode, a WDT
time-out causes the device to wake-up and continue
with normal operation; this is known as a WDT wake-
up. The WDT can be permanently disabled by clearing
the WDTE configuration bit.
17.3 WDT Programming
Considerations
Under worst-case conditions (i.e., VDD = Minimum,
Temperature = Maximum, Maximum WDT prescaler), it
may take several seconds before a WDT time-out
occurs.
The postscaler assignment is fully under software
control and can be changed during program execution.
FIGURE 17-1:
WATCHDOG TIMER WITH SHARED PRESCALER BLOCK DIAGRAM
FOSC/4
Data Bus
0
1
8
1
Sync
TMR0
2 TCY
T0CKI
pin
0
0
1
Set Flag bit T0IF
on Overflow
PSA
T0CS
T0SE
8-bit
Prescaler
PSA
8
1
0
PS<2:0>
WDT
Time-out
Watchdog
Timer
PSA
WDTE
Note 1: T0SE, T0CS, PSA, PS<2:0> are bits in the OPTION_REG register.
2: WDTE bit is in the Configuration Word register.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 103
MCP19110/11
TABLE 17-1: WDT STATUS
Conditions
WDT
WDTE = 0
CLRWDTCommand
Exit Sleep
Cleared
TABLE 17-2: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH WATCHDOG TIMER
Register on
Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
OPTION_REG
RAPU
INTEDG
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
PS<2:0>
77
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by the Watchdog Timer.
TABLE 17-3: SUMMARY OF CONFIGURATION WORD ASSOCIATED WITH WATCHDOG TIMER
Register
Name
Bits Bit -/7 Bit -/6
Bit 13/5
Bit 12/4
Bit 11/3
Bit 10/2
Bit 9/1
Bit 8/0
on Page
CONFIG
13:8
7:0
—
—
—
DBGEN
MCLRE
—
WRT1
WDTE
WRT0
—
—
—
—
—
81
CP
PWRTE
Legend: — = unimplemented location, read as ‘1’. Shaded cells are not used by Watchdog Timer.
DS20002331D-page 104
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
18.1 PMADRH and PMADRL Registers
18.0 FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
CONTROL
The PMADRH and PMADRL registers can address up
to a maximum of 4K words of program memory.
The Flash program memory is readable and writable
during normal operation (full VIN range). This memory
is not directly mapped in the register file space.
Instead, it is indirectly addressed through the Special
Function Registers (SFR) (see Registers 18-1 to 18-
5). There are six SFRs used to read and write this
memory:
When selecting a program address value, the Most
Significant Byte (MSB) of the address is written to the
PMADRH register and the Least Significant Byte
(LSB) is written to the PMADRL register.
18.2 PMCON1 and PMCON2 Registers
• PMCON1
• PMCON2
• PMDATL
• PMDATH
• PMADRL
• PMADRH
PMCON1 is the control register for the data program
memory accesses.
Control bits RD and WR initiate read and write,
respectively. These bits cannot be cleared, only set in
software. They are cleared in hardware at completion
of the read or write operation. The inability to clear the
WR bit in software prevents the accidental premature
termination of a write operation.
When interfacing the program memory block, the
PMDATL and PMDATH registers form a two-byte
word, which holds the 14-bit data for read/write, and
the PMADRL and PMADRH registers form a two-byte
word, which holds the 13-bit address of the FLASH
location being accessed. These devices have 4K
words of program Flash with an address range from
0000h to 0FFFh.
The WREN bit, when set, will allow a write operation.
On power-up, the WREN bit is clear.
The CALSEL bit allows the user to read locations in
test memory in case there are calibration bits stored in
the calibration word locations that need to be
transferred to SFR trim registers. The CALSEL bit is
only for reads, and if a write operation is attempted
with CALSEL = 1, no write will occur.
The program memory allows single word read and a
four-word write. A four-word write automatically erases
the row of the location and writes the new data (erase
before write).
PMCON2 is not a physical register. Reading PMCON2
will read all '0's. The PMCON2 register is used
exclusively in the flash memory write sequence.
The write time is controlled by an on-chip timer. The
write/erase voltages are generated by an on-chip
charge pump rated to operate over the voltage range
of the device for byte or word operations.
When the device is code protected, the CPU may
continue to read and write the Flash program memory.
Depending on the settings of the Flash Program
Memory Enable (WRT<1:0>) bits, the device may or
may not be able to write certain blocks of the program
memory, however, reads of the program memory are
allowed.
When the Flash Program Memory Code Protection
(CP) bit is enabled, the program memory is code
protected, and the device programmer (ICSP) cannot
access data or program memory.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 105
MCP19110/11
18.3 Flash Program Memory
Control Registers
REGISTER 18-1: PMDATL: PROGRAM MEMORY DATA LOW BYTE REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
bit 0
PMDATL<7:0>
bit 7
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-0
PMDATL<7:0>: 8 Least Significant Data bits Read from Program Memory
REGISTER 18-2: PMADRL: PROGRAM MEMORY ADDRESS LOW BYTE REGISTER
R/W-0
bit 7
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
bit 0
PMADRL<7:0>
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-0
PMADRL<7:0>: 8 Least Significant Address bits for Program Memory Read/Write Operation
REGISTER 18-3: PMDATH: PROGRAM MEMORY DATA HIGH BYTE REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
bit 0
PMDATH<5:0>
bit 7
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
bit 5-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
PMDATH<5:0>: 6 Most Significant Data bits Read from Program Memory
DS20002331D-page 106
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 18-4: PMADRH: PROGRAM MEMORY ADDRESS HIGH BYTE REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
bit 0
PMADRH<3:0>
bit 7
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
PMADRH<3:0>: Specifies the 4 Most Significant Address bits or High bits for Program Memory Reads.
REGISTER 18-5: PMCON1: PROGRAM MEMORY CONTROL REGISTER 1
U-1
—
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
WREN
R/S-0
WR
R/S-0
RD
CALSEL
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
S = Bit can only be set
bit 7
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as '1'
CALSEL: Program Memory Calibration Space Select bit
1= Select test memory area for reads only (for loading calibration trim registers)
0= Select user area for reads
bit 5-3
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as '0'
WREN: Program Memory Write Enable bit
1= Allows write cycles
0= Inhibits write to the Flash Program Memory
bit 1
bit 0
WR: Write Control bit
1= Initiates a write cycle to program memory. (The bit is cleared by hardware when write is complete.
The WR bit can only be set (not cleared) in software.)
0= Write cycle to the Flash memory is complete
RD: Read Control bit
1= Initiates a program memory read. (The read takes one cycle. The RD is cleared in hardware; the
RD bit can only be set (not cleared) in software).
0= Does not initiate a Flash memory read
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 107
MCP19110/11
18.3.1
READING THE FLASH PROGRAM
MEMORY
To read a program memory location, the user must
write two bytes of the address to the PMADRL and
PMADRH registers, and then set control bit RD
(PMCON1<0>). Once the read control bit is set, the
program memory Flash controller will use the second
instruction cycle after to read the data. This causes the
second instruction immediately following the “BSF
PMCON1,RD” instruction to be ignored. The data is
available, in the very next cycle, in the PMDATL and
PMDATH registers; it can be read as two bytes in the
following instructions. PMDATL and PMDATH regis-
ters will hold this value until another read or until it is
written to by the user (during a write operation).
EXAMPLE 18-1:
FLASH PROGRAM READ
BANKSELPM_ADR; Change STATUS bits RP1:0 to select bank with PMADR
MOVLWMS_PROG_PM_ADDR;
MOVWFPMADRH; MS Byte of Program Address to read
MOVLWLS_PROG_PM_ADDR;
MOVWFPMADRL; LS Byte of Program Address to read
BANKSELPMCON1; Bank to containing PMCON1
BSF PMCON1, RD; EE Read
NOP
NOP
; First instruction after BSF PMCON1,RD executes normally
; Any instructions here are ignored as program
; memory is read in second cycle after BSF PMCON1,RD
;
BANKSELPMDATL; Bank to containing PMADRL
MOVFPMDATL, W; W = LS Byte of Program PMDATL
MOVFPMDATH, W; W = MS Byte of Program PMDATL
FIGURE 18-1:
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY READ CYCLE EXECUTION – NORMAL MODE
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Flash ADDR
Flash DATA
PMADRH,PMADRL
PC
PC + 1
PC+3
PC + 4
PC + 5
INSTR (PC) INSTR (PC + 1)
PMDATH,PMDATL
INSTR (PC + 3) INSTR (PC + 4)
BSF PMCON1,RD
Executed here
INSTR (PC - 1)
Executed here
INSTR (PC + 1)
Executed here
NOP
Executed here
INSTR (PC + 3)
Executed here
INSTR (PC + 4)
Executed here
RD bit
PMDATH
PMDATL
Register
EERHLT
DS20002331D-page 108
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
The user must follow the same specific sequence to
initiate the write for each word in the program block,
writing each program word in sequence (000, 001,
010, 011). When the write is performed on the last
word (PMADRL<1:0> = 11), a block of sixteen words is
automatically erased and the content of the four-word
buffer registers are written into the program memory.
18.3.2
WRITING TO THE FLASH
PROGRAM MEMORY
A word of the Flash program memory may only be
written to if the word is in an unprotected segment of
memory, as defined in Section 12.1 “Configuration
Word” (bits WRT1:WRT0).
After the “BSF PMCON1,WR” instruction, the processor
requires two cycles to set up the erase/write operation.
The user must place two NOPinstructions after the WR
bit is set. Since data is being written to buffer registers,
the writing of the first three words of the block appears
to occur immediately. The processor will halt internal
operations for the typical 4 ms, only during the cycle in
which the erase takes place (i.e., the last word of the
sixteen-word block erase). This is not Sleep mode, as
the clocks and peripherals will continue to run. After
the four-word write cycle, the processor will resume
operation with the third instruction after the PMCON1
write instruction. The above sequence must be
repeated for the higher 12 words.
Note: The write protect bits are used to protect the
users’ program from modification by the
user’s code. They have no effect when
programming is performed by ICSP. The
code-protect bits, when programmed for
code protection, will prevent the program
memory from being written via the ICSP
interface.
Flash program memory must be written in four-word
blocks. See Figures 18-2 and 18-3 for more details. A
block consists of four words with sequential addresses,
with a lower boundary defined by an address, where
PMADRL<1:0> = 00. All block writes to program
memory are done as 16-word erase by four-word write
operations. The write operation is edge-aligned and
cannot occur across boundaries.
Note: An erase is only initiated for the write of four
words, just after
a row boundary; or
PMCON1<WR> set with PMADRL<3:0> =
xxxx0011.
To write program data, the WREN bit must be set and
the data must first be loaded into the buffer registers
(see Figure 18-2). This is accomplished by first writing
the destination address to PMADRL and PMADRH,
and then writing the data to PMDATL and PMDATH.
After the address and data have been set, then the
following sequence of events must be executed:
Refer to Figure 18-2 for a block diagram of the buffer
registers and the control signals for test mode.
18.3.3 PROTECTION AGAINST SPURIOUS
WRITE
1. Write 55h, then AAh, to PMCON2 (Flash
programming sequence).
There are conditions when the device should not write
to the program memory. To protect against spurious
writes, various mechanisms have been built in. On
power-up, WREN is cleared. Also, the Power-up Timer
(72 ms duration) prevents program memory writes.
2. Set the WR control bit of the PMCON1 register.
All four buffer register locations should be written to
with correct data. If less than four words are being writ-
ten to in the block of four words, then a read from the
program memory location(s) not being written to must
be performed. This takes the data from the program
memory location(s) not being written and loads it into
the PMDATL and PMDATH registers. Then the
sequence of events to transfer data to the buffer regis-
ters must be executed.
The write initiate sequence, and the WREN bit, help
prevent an accidental write during a power glitch or
software malfunction.
18.3.4 OPERATION DURING CODE PROTECT
When the device is code protected, the CPU is able to
read and write unscrambled data to the program
memory. The test mode access is disabled.
To transfer data from the buffer registers to the program
memory, the PMADRL and PMADRH must point to the
18.3.5 OPERATION DURING WRITE PROTECT
last
location
in
the
four-word
block
(PMADRL<1:0> = 11). Then the following sequence of
events must be executed:
When the program memory is write protected, the
CPU can read and execute from the program memory.
The portions of program memory that are write pro-
tected can not be modified by the CPU using the
PMCON registers. The write protection has no effect in
ICSP mode.
1. Write 55h, then AAh, to PMCON2 (Flash
programming sequence).
2. Set control bit WR of the PMCON1 register to
begin the write operation.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 109
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 18-2:
BLOCK WRITES TO 4K FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
If at new row
7
5
0
0 7
sixteen words of
Flash are erased,
then four buffers
are transferred to
Flash automatically
after this word is
written
PMDATH
6
PMDATL
8
First word of block
to be written
14
14
14
14
PMADRL<1:0> = 00
Buffer Register
PMADRL<1:0> = 01
PMADRL<1:0> = 10
PMADRL<1:0> = 11
Buffer Register
Buffer Register
Buffer Register
Program Memory
FIGURE 18-3:
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY LONG WRITE CYCLE EXECUTION
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Flash
PMADRH,PMADRL
PMDATH,PMDATL
PC + 1
PC + 2
PC + 3
PC + 4
ADDR
INSTR
(PC + 1)
ignored
read
INSTR
(PC)
Flash
DATA
INSTR (PC+3)
INSTR (PC+2)
(INSTR (PC + 2)
NOP
Executed here
Processor halted
EE Write Time
BSF PMCON1,WR
Executed here
INSTR (PC + 1)
Executed here
INSTR (PC + 3)
Executed here
NOP
Executed here
Flash
Memory
Location
WR bit
PMWHLT
DS20002331D-page 110
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
19.0 I/O PORTS
In general, when a peripheral is enabled, that pin may
not be used as a general purpose I/O pin.
Each port has two registers for its operation. These
registers are:
• TRISGPx registers (data direction register)
• PORTGPx registers (reads the levels on the pins
of the device)
Some ports may have one or more of the following
additional registers. These registers are:
• ANSELx (analog select)
• WPUx (weak pull-up)
Ports with analog functions also have an ANSELx
register, which can disable the digital input and save
power. A simplified model of a generic I/O port, without
the interfaces to other peripherals, is shown in
Figure 19-1.
FIGURE 19-1:
GENERIC I/O PORTGPX
OPERATION
TRISx
Read LATx
Q
D
Write LATx
Write PORTx
VDD
CK
Data Register
Data Bus
I/O pin
Read PORTx
To peripherals
VSS
ANSELx
EXAMPLE 19-1:
INITIALIZING PORTA
; This code example illustrates
; initializing the PORTGPA register. The
; other ports are initialized in the same
; manner.
BANKSELPORTGPA;
CLRF
PORTGPA;Init PORTA
BANKSELANSELA;
CLRF
ANSELA;digital I/O
BANKSELTRISGPA;
MOVLW
MOVWF
B'00011111';Set GPA<4:0> as
;inputs
TRISGPA;and set GPA<7:6> as
;outputs
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 111
MCP19110/11
This bit has no effect on the values of any TRIS
register. PORT and TRIS overrides will be routed to the
correct pin. The unselected pin will be unaffected.
19.1 Alternate Pin Function
The Alternate Pin Function Control (APFCON) register
is used to steer specific peripheral input and output
functions between different pins. The APFCON register
is shown in Register 19-1. For the MCP19111 device,
the following function can be moved between different
pins:
• Frequency Synchronization Clock Input/Output
REGISTER 19-1: APFCON: ALTERNATE PIN FUNCTION CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
CLKSEL
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-1
bit 0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
CLKSEL: Pin Selection bit
1= Multi-phase or multiple output clock function is on GPB5
0= Multi-phase or multiple output clock function is on GPA1
19.2.1
INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE
19.2 PORTGPA and TRISGPA Registers
Each PORTGPA pin is individually configurable as an
interrupt-on-change pin. Control bits IOCA<7:0>
enable or disable the interrupt function for each pin.
The interrupt-on-change feature is disabled on a
Power-on Reset. Reference Section 20.0 “Interrupt-
On-Change” for more information.
PORTGPA is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port consisting
of five CMOS I/O, two open-drain I/O, and one open-
drain input-only pin. The corresponding data direction
register is TRISGPA (Register 19-3). Setting
a
TRISGPA bit (= 1) will make the corresponding
PORTGPA pin an input (i.e., disable the output driver).
Clearing
a
TRISGPA bit (= 0) will make the
19.2.2
WEAK PULL-UPS
corresponding PORTGPA pin an output (i.e., enables
output driver). The exception is GPA5, which is input
only and its TRISGPA bit will always read as ‘1’.
Example 19-1 shows how to initialize an I/O port.
PORTGPA <3:0> and PORTGPA5 have an internal weak
pull-up. PORTGPA<7:6> are special ports for the SSP
module and do not have weak pull-ups. Individual control
bits can enable or disable the internal weak pull-ups (see
Register 19-4). The weak pull-up is automatically turned
off when the port pin is configured as an output, an
alternative function or on a Power-on Reset setting the
RAPU bit of the OPTION register. The weak pull-up on
GPA5 is enabled when configured as MCLR pin by setting
bit 5 of the Configuration word, and disabled when GPA5
is an I/O. There is no software control of the MCLR
pull-up.
Reading the PORTGPA register (Register 19-2) reads
the status of the pins, whereas writing to it will write to
the PORT latch. All write operations are read-modify-
write operations.
The TRISGPA register (Register 19-3) controls the
PORTGPA pin output drivers, even when they are
being used as analog inputs. The user must ensure the
bits in the TRISGPA register are maintained set when
using them as analog inputs. I/O pins configured as
analog input always read ‘0’. If the pin is configured for
a digital output (either port or alternate function), the
TRISGPA bit must be cleared in order for the pin to
drive the signal, and a read will reflect the state of the
pin.
DS20002331D-page 112
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
Analog input functions, such as ADC, are not shown in
the priority lists. These inputs are active when the I/O
pin is set for Analog mode using the ANSELA registers.
Digital output functions may control the pin when it is in
Analog mode with the priority shown in Table 19-1.
19.2.3
ANSELA REGISTER
The ANSELA register (Register 19-5) is used to
configure the Input mode of an I/O pin to analog.
Setting the appropriate ANSELA bit high will cause all
digital reads on the pin to be read as ‘0’ and allows
analog functions on the pin to operate correctly.
TABLE 19-1: PORTGPA OUTPUT PRIORITY
The state of the ANSELA bits has no effect on the
digital output functions. A pin with TRISGPA clear and
ANSELA set will still operate as a digital output, but the
Input mode will be analog. This can cause unexpected
Pin Name
Function Priority(1)
GPA0
GPA0
AN0
ANALOG_TEST
behavior
when
executing
read-modify-write
instructions on the affected port.
GPA1
GPA2
GPA1
AN1
CLKPIN
Note:
The ANSELA bits default to the Analog
mode after Reset. To use any pins as
digital general purpose or peripheral
inputs, the corresponding ANSELA bits
must be initialized to ‘0’ by user software.
GPA2
AN2
T0CKI
INT
GPA3
GPA3
AN3
19.2.4
PORTGPA FUNCTIONS AND
OUTPUT PRIORITIES
GPA4
GPA5
GPA6
GPA4 (open-drain input/output)
GPA5 (open-drain data input only)
Each PORTGPA pin is multiplexed with other functions.
The pins, their combined functions and their output
priorities are shown in Table 19-1. For additional
information, refer to the appropriate section in this data
sheet.
GPA6
ICSPDAT (MCP19110 Only)
GPA7
GPA7 (open-drain output)
SCL
PORTGPA pins GPA7 and GPA4 are true open-drain
pins with no connection back to VDD
.
ICSPCLK (MCP19110 Only)
Note 1: Priority listed from highest to lowest.
When multiple outputs are enabled, the actual pin
control goes to the peripheral with the highest priority.
REGISTER 19-2: PORTGPA: PORTGPA REGISTER
R/W-x
GPA7
R/W-x
GPA6
R-x
R-x
R/W-x
GPA3
R/W-x
GPA2
R/W-x
GPA1
R/W-x
GPA0
GPA5
GPA4
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
GPA7: General Purpose Open-Drain I/O pin.
GPA6: General Purpose I/O pin.
1= Port pin is > VIH
0= Port pin is < VIL
bit 5
GPA5/MCLR: General Purpose Open-Drain I/O pin.
GPA4: General Purpose Open-Drain I/O pin.
bit 4
bit 3-0
GPA<3:0>: General Purpose I/O pin.
1= Port pin is > VIH
0= Port pin is < VIL
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 113
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 19-3: TRISGPA: PORTGPA TRI-STATE REGISTER
R/W-1
R/W-1
R-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
TRISA7
TRISA6
TRISA5
TRISA4
TRISA3
TRISA2
TRISA1
TRISA0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
TRISA<7:6>: PORTGPA Tri-State Control bit
1= PORTGPA pin configured as an input (tri-stated)
0= PORTGPA pin configured as an output
bit 5
TRISA5: GPA5 Port Tri-State Control bit
This bit is always ‘1’ as GPA5 is an input only
bit 4-0
TRISA<4:0>: PORTGPA Tri-State Control bit
1= PORTGPA pin configured as an input (tri-stated)
0= PORTGPA pin configured as an output
REGISTER 19-4: WPUGPA: WEAK PULL-UP PORTGPA REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-1
U-0
—
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
WPUA5
WPUA3
WPUA2
WPUA1
WPUA0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
WPUA5: Weak Pull-up Register bit
1= Pull-up enabled.
0= Pull-up disabled.
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
WPUA<3:0>: Weak Pull-up Register bit
1= Pull-up enabled.
0= Pull-up disabled.
Note 1: The weak pull-up device is enabled only when the global RAPU bit is enabled, the pin is in input mode
(TRISGPA = 1), and the individual WPUA bit is enabled (WPUA = 1), and the pin is not configured as an
analog input.
2: GPA5 weak pull-up is also enabled when the pin is configured as MCLR in Configuration word.
DS20002331D-page 114
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 19-5: ANSELA: ANALOG SELECT PORTGPA REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-1
—
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
ANSA3
ANSA2
ANSA1
ANSA0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
ANSA<3:0>: Analog Select PORTGPA Register bit
1= Analog input. Pin is assigned as analog input.(1)
0= Digital I/O. Pin is assigned to port or special function.
Note 1: Setting a pin to an analog input automatically disables the digital input circuitry, weak pull-ups, and
interrupt-on-change if available. The corresponding TRIS bit must be set to Input mode in order to allow
external control of the voltage on the pin.
TABLE 19-2: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTGPA
Register
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
on Page
ANSELA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ANSA3
—
ANSA2
—
ANSA1
—
ANSA0
115
112
APFCON
CLKSEL
OPTION_REG
PORTGPA
TRISGPA
RAPU INTEDG
GPA7 GPA6
TRISA7 TRISA6
T0CS
GPA5
T0SE
GPA4
PSA
PS2
PS1
PS0
77
GPA3
GPA2
GPA1
GPA0
113
114
114
TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3
WPUA5 WPUA3
TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0
WPUA2 WPUA1 WPUA0
WPUGPA
—
—
—
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTGPA.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 115
MCP19110/11
Input mode will be analog. This can cause unexpected
behavior when executing read-modify-write instructions
on the affected port.
19.3 PORTGPB and TRISGPB
Registers
PORTGPB is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port consisting
of seven general purpose I/O ports. The corresponding
data direction register is TRISGPB (Register 19-7).
Setting a TRISGPB bit (= 1) will make the corresponding
PORTGPB pin an input (i.e., disable the output driver).
Note:
The ANSELB bits default to the Analog
mode after Reset. To use any pins as
digital general purpose or peripheral
inputs, the corresponding ANSELB bits
must be initialized to ‘0’ by the user’s
software.
Clearing
a
TRISGPB bit (= 0) will make the
corresponding PORTGPB pin an output (i.e., enable the
output driver). Example 19-1 shows how to initialize an
I/O port.
19.3.4
PORTGPB FUNCTIONS AND
OUTPUT PRIORITIES
Some pins for PORTGPB are multiplexed with an
alternate function for the peripheral, or a clock function.
In general, when a peripheral or clock function is
enabled, that pin may not be used as a general purpose
I/O pin.
Each PORTGPB pin is multiplexed with other functions.
The pins, their combined functions and their output
priorities are shown in Table 19-3. For additional
information, refer to the appropriate section in this data
sheet.
Reading the PORTGPB register (Register 19-6) reads
the status of the pins, whereas writing to it will write to the
PORT latch. All write operations are read-modify-write
operations.
PORTGPB pin GPB0 is a true open-drain pin with no
connection back to VDD
.
When multiple outputs are enabled, the actual pin
control goes to the peripheral with the highest priority.
The TRISGPB register (Register 19-7) controls the
PORTGPB pin output drivers, even when they are being
used as analog inputs. The user should ensure the bits in
the TRISGPB register are maintained set when using
them as analog inputs. I/O pins configured as analog
input always read ‘0’. If the pin is configured for a digital
output (either port or alternate function), the TRISGPB bit
must be cleared in order for the pin to drive the signal and
a read will reflect the state of the pin.
Analog input functions, such as ADC, and some digital
input functions are not included in the list below. These
inputs are active when the I/O pin is set for Analog
mode using the ANSELB registers. Digital output
functions may control the pin when it is in Analog mode,
with the priority shown in Table 19-3.
TABLE 19-3: PORTGPB OUTPUT PRIORITY
Function Priority(1)
19.3.1
INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE
Pin Name
Each PORTGPB pin is individually configurable as an
interrupt-on-change pin. Control bits IOCB<7:4> and
IOCB<2:0> enable or disable the interrupt function for
each pin. The interrupt-on-change feature is disabled
GPB0
GPB0 (open-drain input/output)
SDA
GPB1
GPB1
AN4
EAPIN
on
a Power-on Reset. Reference Section 20.0
“Interrupt-On-Change” for more information.
GPB2
GPB4
GPB2
AN5
19.3.2
WEAK PULL-UPS
Each of the PORTGPB pins has an individually
configurable internal weak pull-up. Control bits
WPUB<7:4> and WPUB<2:1> enable or disable each
pull-up (see Register 19-8). Each weak pull-up is
automatically turned off when the port pin is configured
as an output. All pull-ups are disabled on a Power-on
Reset by the RAPU bit of the OPTION register.
GPB4
AN6
ICSPDAT/ICDDAT (MCP19111 Only)
GPB5
GPB5
AN7
ICSPCLK/ICDCLK (MCP19111 Only)
ALT_CLKPIN (MCP19111 Only)
GPB6
GPB7
GPB6
GPB7
19.3.3
ANSELB REGISTER
The ANSELB register (Register 19-9) is used to
configure the Input mode of an I/O pin to analog.
Setting the appropriate ANSELB bit high will cause all
digital reads on the pin to be read as ‘0’ and allows
analog functions on the pin to operate correctly.
Note 1: Priority listed from highest to lowest.
The state of the ANSELB bits has no effect on the digital
output functions. A pin with TRISGPB clear and
ANSELB set will still operate as a digital output, but the
DS20002331D-page 116
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 19-6: PORTGPB: PORTGPB REGISTER
R/W-x
GPB7(1)
R/W-x
GPB6(1)
R/W-x
GPB5(1)
R/W-x
GPB4(1)
U-x
—
R/W-x
GPB2
R/W-x
GPB1
R/W-x
GPB0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
GPB<7:4>: General Purpose I/O Pin bit
1= Port pin is > VIH
0= Port pin is < VIL
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
GPB<2:0>: General Purpose I/O Pin bit
1= Port pin is > VIH
0= Port pin is < VIL
Note 1: Not implemented on MCP19110.
REGISTER 19-7: TRISGPB: PORTGPB TRI-STATE REGISTER
R/W-1
TRISB7(1)
R/W-1
TRISB6(1)
R/W-1
TRISB5(1)
R/W-1
TRISB4(1)
U-1
—
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
TRISB2
TRISB1
TRISB0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7-4
TRISB<7:4>: PORTGPB Tri-State Control bit
1= PORTGPB pin configured as an input (tri-stated)
0= PORTGPB pin configured as an output
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘1’
bit 2-0
TRISB<2:0>: PORTGPB Tri-State Control bit
1= PORTGPB pin configured as an input (tri-stated)
0= PORTGPB pin configured as an output
Note 1: Not implemented on MCP19110.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 117
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 19-8: WPUGPB: WEAK PULL-UP PORTGPB REGISTER
R/W-1
WPUB7(2)
R/W-1
WPUB6(2)
R/W-1
WPUB5(2)
R/W-1
WPUB4(2)
U-0
—
R/W-1
R/W-1
U-0
—
WPUB2
WPUB1
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7-4
WPUB<7:4>: Weak Pull-up Register bit
1= Pull-up enabled
0= Pull-up disabled
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-1
WPUB<2:1>: Weak Pull-up Register bit
1= Pull-up enabled
0= Pull-up disabled
bit 0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Note 1: The weak pull-up device is enabled only when the global RAPU bit is enabled, the pin is in Input mode
(TRISGPA = 1), the individual WPUB bit is enabled (WPUB = 1), and the pin is not configured as an
analog input.
2: Not implemented on MCP19110.
REGISTER 19-9: ANSELB: ANALOG SELECT PORTGPB REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-1
ANSB5(2)
R/W-1
ANSB4(2)
U-0
—
R/W-1
R/W-1
U-0
—
ANSB2
ANSB1
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
bit 5-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
ANSB<5:4>: Analog Select PORTGPB Register bit
1= Analog input. Pin is assigned as analog input(1)
.
0= Digital I/O. Pin is assigned to port or special function.
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-1
ANSB<2:1>: Analog Select PORTGPB Register bit
1= Analog input. Pin is assigned as analog input(1)
.
0= Digital I/O. Pin is assigned to port or special function.
bit 0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Note 1: Setting a pin to an analog input automatically disables the digital input circuitry, weak pull-ups and
interrupt-on-change if available. The corresponding TRIS bit must be set to Input mode in order to allow
external control of the voltage on the pin.
2: Not implemented on MCP19110.
DS20002331D-page 118
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 19-4: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTGPB
Register
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
ANSELB
APFCON
—
—
—
—
ANSB5
—
ANSB4
—
—
—
ANSB2
—
ANSB1
—
—
118
112
CLKSEL
OPTION_REG RAPU
INTEDG
GPB6
T0CS
GPB5
T0SE
GPB4
PSA
—
PS2
PS1
PS0
77
PORTGPB
TRISGPB
WPUGPB
GPB7
GPB2
GPB1
GPB0
117
117
118
TRISB7 TRISB6 TRISB5 TRISB4
WPUB7 WPUB6 WPUB5 WPUB4
—
TRISB2 TRISB1 TRISB0
WPUB2 WPUB1
—
—
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTGPB.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 119
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 120
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
20.3 Clearing Interrupt Flags
20.0 INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE
The user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, clears the
interrupt by:
Each PORTGPA and PORTGPB pin is individually
configurable as an interrupt-on-change pin. Control bits
IOCA and IOCB enable or disable the interrupt function
for each pin. Refer to Register 20-1 and Register 20-2.
The interrupt-on-change is disabled on a Power-on
Reset.
a) Any read of PORTGPA or PORTGPB AND
Clear flag bit IOCF. This will end the mismatch
condition;
OR
The interrupt-on-change on GPA5 is disabled when
configured as MCLR pin in the Configuration Word.
b) Any write of PORTGPA or PORTGPB AND
Clear flag bit IOCF will end the mismatch
condition;
For enabled interrupt-on-change pins, the values are
compared with the old value latched on the last read of
PORTGPA or PORTGPB. The mismatched outputs of
the last read of all the PORTGPA and PORTGPB pins
are OR’ed together to set the Interrupt-on-Change
Interrupt Flag bit (IOCF) in the INTCON register
(Register 15-1).
A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit IOCF.
Reading PORTGPA or PORTGPB will end the
mismatch condition and allow flag bit IOCF to be
cleared. The latch holding the last read value is not
affected by a MCLR Reset. After this Reset, the IOCF
flag will continue to be set if a mismatch is present.
20.1 Enabling the Module
Note:
If a change on the I/O pin should occur
when any PORTGPA or PORTGPB
operation is being executed, then the
IOCF interrupt flag may not get set.
To allow individual port pins to generate an interrupt, the
IOCIE bit of the INTCON register must be set. If the
IOCIE bit is disabled, the edge detection on the pin will
still occur, but an interrupt will not be generated.
20.4 Operation in Sleep
20.2 Individual Pin Configuration
The interrupt-on-change interrupt sequence will wake
the device from Sleep mode, if the IOCE bit is set.
To enable a pin to detect an interrupt-on-change, the
associated IOCAx or IOCBx bit of the IOCA or IOCB
register is set.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 121
MCP19110/11
20.5 Interrupt-On-Change Registers
REGISTER 20-1: IOCA: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE PORTGPA REGISTER
R/W-0
IOCA7
R/W-0
IOCA6
R/W-0
IOCA5
R/W-0
IOCA4
R/W-0
IOCA3
R/W-0
IOCA2
R/W-0
IOCA1
R/W-0
IOCA0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
IOCA<7:6>: Interrupt-on-Change PORTGPA Register bits
1= Interrupt-on-change enabled on the pin
0= Interrupt-on-change disabled on the pin
bit 5
IOCA<5>: Interrupt-on-Change PORTGPA Register bits(1)
1= Interrupt-on-change enabled on the pin
0= Interrupt-on-change disabled on the pin
bit 4-0
IOCA<4:0>: Interrupt-on-Change PORTGPA Register bits
1= Interrupt-on-change enabled on the pin
0= Interrupt-on-change disabled on the pin
Note 1: The Interrupt-on-change on GPA5 is disabled if GPA5 is configured as MCLR.
REGISTER 20-2: IOCB: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE PORTGPB REGISTER
R/W-0
IOCB7(1)
R/W-0
IOCB6(1)
R/W-0
IOCB5(1)
R/W-0
IOCB4(1)
U-0
—
R/W-0
IOCB2
R/W-0
IOCB1
R/W-0
IOCB0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
IOCB<7:4>: Interrupt-on-Change PORTGPB Register bits
1= Interrupt-on-change enabled on the pin
0= Interrupt-on-change disabled on the pin
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
IOCB<2:0>: Interrupt-on-Change PORTGPB Register bits
1= Interrupt-on-change enabled on the pin
0= Interrupt-on-change disabled on the pin
Note 1: Not implemented on MCP19111.
TABLE 20-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE
Register
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
ANSELA
ANSELB
INTCON
IOCA
—
—
—
—
—
ANSA3
—
ANSA2
ANSB2
T0IF
ANSA1
ANSB1
INTF
ANSA0
—
115
118
96
—
ANSB5
T0IE
ANSB4
INTE
GIE
PEIE
IOCA6
IOCB6
TRISA6
IOCE
IOCA3
—
IOCF
IOCA7
IOCB7
TRISA7
IOCA5
IOCB5
TRISA5
IOCA4
IOCB4
TRISA4
IOCA2
IOCB2
TRISA2
IOCA1
IOCB1
TRISA1
IOCA0
IOCB0
TRISA0
122
122
114
117
IOCB
TRISGPA
TRISA3
TRISGPB
TRISB7
TRISB6
TRISB5
TRISB4
—
TRISB2
TRISB1
TRISB0
Legend:
— = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by interrupt-on-change.
DS20002331D-page 122
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
21.2 Temperature Output
21.0 INTERNAL TEMPERATURE
INDICATOR MODULE
The output of the circuit is measured using the internal
analog-to-digital converter. Channel 10 is reserved for
the temperature circuit output. Refer to Section 22.0
“Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module” for
detailed information.
The MCP19110/11 is equipped with a temperature
circuit designed to measure the operating temperature
of the silicon die. The circuit's range of the operating
temperature falls between -40°C and +125°C. The
output is a voltage that is proportional to the device
temperature. The output of the temperature indicator is
internally connected to the device ADC.
The temperature of the silicon die can be calculated by
the ADC measurement by using Equation 21-1.
EQUATION 21-1: SILICON DIE
TEMPERATURE
21.1 Circuit Operation
The TMPSEN bit in the ABECON register,
Register 6-15, is set to enable the internal temperature
ADC READING – 1.75
----------------------------------------------------------
TEMP_DIE=
13.3mV/C
measurement
circuit.
The
MCP19110/11
overtemperature shutdown feature is also controlled by
this bit.
FIGURE 21-1:
TEMPERATURE CIRCUIT
DIAGRAM
V
DD
TMPSEN
V
OUT
ADC
MUX
ADC
n
CHS bits
(ADCON0 register)
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 123
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 124
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
The internal band gap supplies the voltage reference to
the ADC.
22.0 ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER (ADC) MODULE
The ADC can generate an interrupt upon completion of
a conversion. This interrupt can be used to wake-up the
device from Sleep.
The Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) allows
conversion of an analog input signal to a 10-bit binary
representation of that signal. This device uses analog
inputs, which are multiplexed into a single sample and
hold circuit. The output of the sample and hold is
connected to the input of the converter. The converter
generates a 10-bit binary result via successive
approximation and stores the right justified conversion
result into the ADC result registers (ADRESH:ADRESL
register pair). Figure 22-1 shows the block diagram of
the ADC.
FIGURE 22-1:
ADC BLOCK DIAGRAM
00000
VIN_ANA
00001
00010
00011
00100
00101
00110
00111
01000
01001
01010
01011
01100
VREF
OVREF
UVREF
VBGR
VREF
VOUT
CRT
VZC
DEMAND
RELEFF
TEMP_ANA
ANA_IN
DCI
ADC
GO/DONE
10
10000
10001
10010
10011
10100
10101
10110
10111
ADON
GPA0
GPA1
ADRESH ADRESL
VSS
GPA2
GPA3
GPB1
GPB2
GPB4(3)
GPB5(3)
CHS4:CHS0
Note 1: When ADON = 0, all multiplexer inputs are disconnected.
2: See ADCON0 register (Register 22-1) for detailed analog channel selection per device.
3: Not implemented on MCP19110.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 125
MCP19110/11
22.1.3
ADC CONVERSION CLOCK
22.1 ADC Configuration
The source of the conversion clock is software
selectable via the ADCS bits of the ADCON1 register.
There are five possible clock options:
When configuring and using the ADC, the following
functions must be considered:
• Port configuration
• Channel selection
• ADC conversion clock source
• Interrupt control
• FOSC/8
• FOSC/16
• FOSC/32
• FOSC/64
• Result formatting
• FRC (clock derived from internal oscillator with a
divisor of 16)
22.1.1
PORT CONFIGURATION
The time to complete one bit conversion is defined as
TAD. One full 10-bit conversion requires 11 TAD periods
as shown in Figure 22-2.
The ADC can be used to convert both analog and
digital signals. When converting analog signals, the I/O
pin should be configured for analog by setting the
associated TRIS and ANSEL bits. Refer to
Section 19.0 “I/O Ports” for more information.
For
a correct conversion, the appropriate TAD
specification must be met. Refer to the A/D conversion
requirements in Section 5.0 “Digital Electrical
Characteristics” for more information. Table 22-1
gives examples of appropriate ADC clock selections.
Note:
Analog voltages on any pin that is defined
as a digital input may cause the input
buffer to conduct excess current.
Note:
Unless using the FRC, any changes in the
system clock frequency will change the
ADC clock frequency, which may
adversely affect the ADC result.
22.1.2
CHANNEL SELECTION
There are up to 19 channel selections available on the
MCP19110 and 21 channel selections available on the
MCP19111:
• AN<6:0> pins
TABLE 22-1: ADC CLOCK PERIOD (T ) VS.
AD
DEVICE OPERATING
FREQUENCIES
• VIN_ANA: 1/13 of the input voltage (VIN)
• VREGREF: VOUT reference voltage
• OV_REF: reference for OV comparator
• UV_REF: reference for UV comparator
• VBGR: band gap reference
Device
ADC Clock Period (TAD
)
Frequency
(FOSC
)
• VOUT: output voltage
ADC
Clock Source
ADCS<2:0>
8 MHz
• CRT: voltage proportional to the AC inductor
current
FOSC/8
001
101
010
110
x11
1.0 µs(2)
2.0 µs
• VZC: an internal ground, Voltage for Zero Current
• DEMAND: input to slope compensation circuitry
• RELEFF: relative efficient measurement channel
FOSC/16
F
F
OSC/32
OSC/64
FRC
4.0 µs
8.0 µs(3)
2.0 – 6.0 µs(1,4)
• TMP_ANA: voltage proportional to silicon die tem-
perature
• ANA_IN: for a multi-phase slave, error amplifier
signal received from master
Legend: Shaded cells are outside of recommended
range.
• DCI: DC inductor valley current
Note 1: The FRC source has a typical TAD time of
4 µs for VDD > 3.0V.
The CHS<4:0> bits of the ADCON0 register determine
which channel is connected to the sample and hold
circuit.
2: These values violate the minimum
required TAD time.
3: For faster conversion times, the selection
When changing channels, a delay is required before
starting the next conversion. Refer to Section 22.2
“ADC Operation” for more information.
of another clock source is recommended.
4: The FRC clock source is only
recommended if the conversion will be
preformed during Sleep.
DS20002331D-page 126
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 22-2:
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERSION T CYCLES
AD
TCY - T
TAD8 TAD9 TAD10 TAD11
7
AD TAD1 TAD2 TAD3 TAD4 TAD
5
TAD6 TAD
b4
b1
b0
b9
Conversion starts
b8
b7
b6
b5
b3
b2
Holding capacitor is disconnected from analog input (typically 100 ns)
Set GO/DONE bit
On the following cycle:
ADRESH:ADRESL is loaded, GO bit is cleared,
ADIF bit is set, holding capacitor is connected to analog input.
This interrupt can be generated while the device is
operating, or while in Sleep. If the device is in Sleep,
22.1.4
INTERRUPTS
The ADC module allows for the ability to generate an
interrupt upon completion of an Analog-to-Digital
conversion. The ADC Interrupt Flag is the ADIF bit in
the PIR1 register. The ADC Interrupt Enable is the
ADIE bit in the PIE1 register. The ADIF bit must be
cleared in software.
the interrupt will wake-up the device. Upon waking from
Sleep, the next instruction following the SLEEP
instruction is always executed. If the user is attempting
to wake-up from Sleep and resume in-line code
execution, the GIE and PEIE bits of the INTCON
register must be disabled. If the GIE and PEIE bits of
the INTCON register are enabled, execution will switch
to the Interrupt Service Routine.
Note 1: The ADIF bit is set at the completion of
every conversion, regardless of whether
or not the ADC interrupt is enabled.
22.1.5
RESULT FORMATTING
2: The ADC operates during Sleep-only
The 10-bit A/D conversion result is supplied in right
justified format only.
when the FRC oscillator is selected.
Figure 22-3 shows the output format.
FIGURE 22-3:
10-BIT A/D RESULT FORMAT
(ADFM = 1)
MSB
LSB
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
bit 0
Read as ‘0’
10-bit A/D Result
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 127
MCP19110/11
22.2.5
A/D CONVERSION PROCEDURE
22.2 ADC Operation
This is an example procedure for using the ADC to
perform an Analog-to-Digital conversion:
22.2.1
STARTING A CONVERSION
To enable the ADC module, the ADON bit of the
ADCON0 register must be set to a ‘1’. Setting the
GO/DONE bit of the ADCON0 register to a ‘1’ will start
the Analog-to-Digital conversion.
1. Configure Port:
• Disable pin output driver (Refer to the TRIS
register)
• Configure pin as analog (Refer to the ANSEL
register)
Note:
The GO/DONE bit should not be set in the
same instruction that turns on the ADC.
2. Configure the ADC module:
• Select ADC conversion clock
• Select ADC input channel
• Turn on ADC module
Refer
to
Section 22.2.5
“A/D
Conversion Procedure”.
22.2.2
COMPLETION OF A CONVERSION
3. Configure ADC interrupt (optional):
• Clear ADC interrupt flag
When the conversion is complete, the ADC module will:
• Clear the GO/DONE bit
• Enable ADC interrupt
• Set the ADIF Interrupt Flag bit
• Enable peripheral interrupt
• Enable global interrupt(1)
4. Wait the required acquisition time(2)
• Update the ADRESH:ADRESL registers with new
conversion result
.
5. Start conversion by setting the GO/DONE bit.
22.2.3
TERMINATING A CONVERSION
6. Wait for ADC conversion to complete by one of
the following:
If a conversion must be terminated before completion,
the GO/DONE bit can be cleared in software. The
ADRESH:ADRESL registers will not be updated with
the partially complete Analog-to-Digital conversion
sample. Instead, the ADRESH:ADRESL register pair
will retain the value of the previous conversion.
Additionally, a two TAD delay is required before another
acquisition can be initiated. Following the delay, an
input acquisition is automatically started on the
selected channel.
• Polling the GO/DONE bit
• Waiting for the ADC interrupt (interrupts
enabled)
7. Read ADC Result.
8. Clear the ADC interrupt flag (required if interrupt
is enabled).
Note 1: The global interrupt can be disabled if the
user is attempting to wake-up from Sleep
and resume in-line code execution.
Note:
A device Reset forces all registers to their
Reset state. Thus, the ADC module is
turned off and any pending conversion is
terminated.
2: Refer to Section 22.4 “A/D Acquisition
Requirements”.
EXAMPLE 22-1:
;This code block configures the ADC
A/D CONVERSION
22.2.4
ADC OPERATION DURING SLEEP
The ADC module can operate during Sleep. This
requires the ADC clock source to be set to the FRC
option. When the FRC clock source is selected, the
ADC waits one additional instruction before starting the
conversion. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be
executed, which can reduce system noise during the
conversion. If the ADC interrupt is enabled, the device
will wake-up from Sleep when the conversion
completes. If the ADC interrupt is disabled, the ADC
module is turned off after the conversion completes,
although the ADON bit remains set.
;for polling, Frc clock and AN0 input.
;
;Conversion start & polling for completion ;
are included.
;
BANKSEL
MOVLW
MOVWF
BANKSEL
BSF
BANKSEL
BSF
BANKSEL
MOVLW
MOVWF
CALL
BSF
BTFSC
GOTO
BANKSEL
MOVF
MOVWF
BANKSEL
MOVF
ADCON1
B’01110000’
ADCON1
TRISGPA
TRISGPA,0
ANSELA
ANSELA,0
ADCON0
B’01000001’
ADCON0
SampleTime
ADCON0,1
ADCON0,1
$-1
;
;Frc clock
;
;
;Set GPA0 to input
;
;Set GPA0 to analog
;
;Select channel AN0
;Turn ADC On
;Acquisiton delay
;Start conversion
;Is conversion done?
;No, test again
;
;Read upper 2 bits
;store in GPR space
;
When the ADC clock source is something other than
FRC, a SLEEP instruction causes the present
conversion to be aborted and the ADC module is
turned off, although the ADON bit remains set.
ADRESH
ADRESH,W
RESULTHI
ADRESL
ADRESL,W
RESULTLO
;Read lower 8 bits
;Store in GPR space
MOVWF
DS20002331D-page 128
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
22.3 ADC Register Definitions
The following registers are used to control the
operation of the ADC:
REGISTER 22-1: ADCON0: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 0
U-0
—
R/W-0
CHS4
R/W-0
CHS3
R/W-0
CHS2
R/W-0
CHS1
R/W-0
CHS0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ADON
GO/DONE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
CHS<4:0>: Analog Channel Select bits
bit 6-2
00000= VIN_ANA (analog voltage proportional to 1/13 of VIN)
00001= VREGREF (reference voltage for VREG output)
00010= OV_REF (reference for overvoltage comparator)
00011= UV_REF (reference for undervoltage comparator)
00100= VBGR (band gap reference)
00101= INT_VREG (internal version of the VREG load voltage)
00110= CRT (voltage proportional to the current in the inductor)
00111= VZC (an internal ground, Voltage for Zero Current)
01000= DEMAND (input to current loop, output of demand mux)
01001= RELEFF (analog voltage proportional to duty cycle)
01010= TMP_ANA (analog voltage proportional to temperature)
01011= ANA_IN (demanded current from the remote master)
01100= DCI (dc inductor valley current)
01101= Unimplemented
01110= Unimplemented
01111= Unimplemented
10000= GPA0 (i.e. ADDR1)
10001= GPA1 (i.e. ADDR0)
10010= GPA2 (i.e. Temperature Sensor Input)
10011= GPA3 (i.e. Tracking Voltage)
10100= GPB1
10101= GPB2
10110= GPB4(1)
10111= GPB5(1)
11000= Unimplemented
11001= Unimplemented
11011= Unimplemented
11100= Unimplemented
11101= Unimplemented
11110= Unimplemented
11111= Unimplemented
bit 1
bit 0
GO/DONE: A/D Conversion Status bit
1= A/D conversion cycle in progress. Setting this bit starts an A/D conversion cycle.
This bit is automatically cleared by hardware when the A/D conversion has completed.
0= A/D conversion completed/not in progress
ADON: ADC Enable bit
1= ADC is enabled
0= ADC is disabled and consumes no operating current
Note 1: Not implemented on MCP19110.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 129
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 22-2: ADCON1: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 1
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
P = Programmable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
ADCS<2:0>: A/D Conversion Clock Select bits
000= Reserved
001= FOSC/8
010= FOSC/32
x11= FRC (clock derived from internal oscillator with a divisor of 16)
100= Reserved
101= FOSC/16
110= FOSC/64
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
REGISTER 22-3: ADRESH: ADC RESULT REGISTER HIGH (ADRESH)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R-x
R-x
ADRES9
ADRES8
bit 0
bit 7
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-2
bit 1-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
ADRES<9:8>: Most Significant A/D Results
REGISTER 22-4: ADRESL: ADC RESULT REGISTER LOW (ADRESL)
R-x
R-x
R-x
R-x
R-x
R-x
R-x
R-x
ADRES7
ADRES6
ADRES5
ADRES4
ADRES3
ADRES2
ADRES1
ADRES0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7-0
ADRES<7:0>: Least Significant A/D results
DS20002331D-page 130
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
The maximum recommended impedance for
analog sources is 10 k. As the source impedance is
decreased, the acquisition time may be decreased.
After the analog input channel is selected (or changed),
an A/D acquisition must be done before the conversion
can be started. To calculate the minimum acquisition
time, Equation 22-1 may be used. This equation
assumes that 1/2 LSb error is used (1,024 steps for the
ADC). The 1/2 LSb error is the maximum error allowed
for the ADC to meet its specified resolution.
22.4 A/D Acquisition Requirements
For the ADC to meet its specified accuracy, the charge
holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed to fully
charge to the input channel voltage level. The Analog
Input model is shown in Figure 22-4. The source
impedance (RS) and the internal sampling switch (RSS
impedance directly affect the time required to charge
the capacitor CHOLD. The sampling switch (RSS
)
)
impedance varies over the device voltage (VDD), refer
to Figure 22-4.
EQUATION 22-1: ACQUISITION TIME EXAMPLE
Assumptions:
Temperature = +50°C and external impedance of 10 k 5.0V V
DD
T
= Amplifier Settling Time + Hold Capacitor Charging Time + Temperature Coefficient
ACQ
= T
+ T + T
AMP
C
COFF
= 2 µs + T + Temperature - 25°C0.05 µs/°C
C
The value for T can be approximated with the following equations:
C
1
-----------------------------
;[1] VCHOLD charged to within 1/2 lsb
V
V
V
1 –
= V
APPLIED
APPLIED
APPLIED
CHOLD
n + 1
2
– 1
–T
C
----------
RC
1 – e
1 – e
= V
= V
;[2] VCHOLD charge response to VAPPLIED
;combining [1] and [2]
CHOLD
–T
C
----------
RC
1
-----------------------------
1 –
APPLIED
n + 1
2
– 1
Note: Where n = number of bits of the ADC.
Solving for T :
C
T
= –C
R + R + R ln(1/2047)
HOLD IC SS
C
S
= –10 pF1 k + 7 k + 10 k ln(0.0004885)
= 1.37µs
Therefore:
T
= 2 µs + 1.37µs + 50°C- 25°C0.05µs/°C
ACQ
= 4.67 µs
Note 1: The charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) is not discharged after each conversion.
2: The maximum recommended impedance for analog sources is 10 k. This is required to meet the pin
leakage specification.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 131
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 22-4:
ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
VT 0.6V
Analog
Input
pin
Sampling
Switch
RIC 1k
SS
R
R
SS
S
(1)
CPIN
5 pF
ILEAKAGE
VA
CHOLD = 10 pF
SS/VREF
V
0.6V
T
V
-
6V
Legend:
5V
RSS
CHOLD = Sample/Hold Capacitance
CPIN = Input Capacitance
VDD4V
3V
2V
ILEAKAGE = Leakage current at the pin due to various junctions
RIC = Interconnect Resistance
5 6 7 8 91011
Sampling Switch
(k)
RSS = Resistance of Sampling Switch
SS = Sampling Switch
VT = Threshold Voltage
Note 1: Refer to Section 5.0 “Digital Electrical Characteristics”.
FIGURE 22-5:
ADC TRANSFER FUNCTION
Full-Scale Range
3FFh
3FEh
3FDh
3FCh
3FBh
03h
02h
01h
00h
Analog Input Voltage
1.5 LSB
0.5 LSB
Zero-Scale
Transition
VREF
-
Full-Scale
Transition
VREF+
DS20002331D-page 132
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 22-2: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH ADC
Register
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
ADCON0
ADCON1
ADRESH
ADRESL
ANSELA
ANSELB
INTCON
PIE1
—
—
—
CHS4
ADCS2
—
CHS3
ADCS1
—
CHS2
ADCS0
—
CHS1
—
CHS0
—
GO/DONE ADON
129
130
130
130
115
118
95
—
—
—
—
ADRES9 ADRES8
ADRES7 ADRES6 ADRES5 ADRES4 ADRES3 ADRES2 ADRES1 ADRES0
—
—
—
—
—
—
ANSA3
—
ANSA2
ANSB2
T0IF
ANSA1
ANSB1
INTF
ANSA0
—
ANSB5
T0IE
ANSB4
INTE
GIE
PEIE
ADIE
ADIF
TRISA6
TRISB6
IOCE
—
IOCF
—
BCLIE
BCLIF
TRISA5
TRISB5
SSPIE
SSPIF
TRISA4
TRISB4
—
TMR2IE
TMR2IF
TRISA1
TRISB1
TMR1IE
TMR1IF
TRISA0
TRISB0
96
PIR1
—
—
—
98
TRISGPA
TRISGPB
TRISA7
TRISB7
TRISA3
—
TRISA2
TRISB2
114
117
Legend: — = unimplemented read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for ADC module.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 133
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 134
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
23.0 TIMER0 MODULE
The Timer0 module is an 8-bit timer/counter with the
following features:
• 8-bit timer/counter register (TMR0)
• 8-bit prescaler (independent of Watchdog Timer)
• Programmable internal or external clock source
• Programmable external clock edge selection
• Interrupt on overflow
Figure 23-1 is a block diagram of the Timer0 module.
FIGURE 23-1:
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE TIMER0
FOSC/4
Data Bus
0
1
8
T0CKI
1
0
Sync
2 TCY
TMR0
Set Flag bit TMR0IF
on Overflow
TMR0SE
8-bit
Prescaler
TMR0CS
PSA
Overflow to Timer1
8
PS<2:0>
23.1.3
SOFTWARE PROGRAMMABLE
PRESCALER
23.1 Timer0 Operation
The Timer0 module can be used as either an 8-bit timer
or an 8-bit counter.
A single software programmable prescaler is available
for use with either Timer0 or the Watchdog Timer
(WDT), but not both simultaneously. The prescaler
assignment is controlled by the PSA bit of the
OPTION_REG register. To assign the prescaler to
Timer0, the PSA bit must be cleared to ‘0’.
23.1.1
8-BIT TIMER MODE
The Timer0 module will increment every instruction
cycle, if used without a prescaler. 8-Bit Timer mode is
selected by clearing the T0CS bit of the OPTION_REG
register.
There are eight prescaler options for the Timer0
module ranging from 1:2 to 1:256. The prescale values
are selectable via the PS<2:0> bits of the
OPTION_REG register. In order to have a 1:1 prescaler
value for the Timer0 module, the prescaler must be
disabled by setting the PSA bit of the OPTION_REG
register.
When TMR0 is written, the increment is inhibited for
two instruction cycles immediately following the write.
Note:
The value written to the TMR0 register
can be adjusted, in order to account for
the two-instruction cycle delay when
TMR0 is written.
The prescaler is not readable or writable. When
assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions writing to
the TMR0 register will clear the prescaler.
23.1.2
8-BIT COUNTER MODE
In 8-Bit Counter mode, the Timer0 module will increment
on every rising or falling edge of the T0CKI pin. The
incrementing edge is determined by the T0SE bit of the
OPTION_REG register.
8-Bit Counter mode using the T0CKI pin is selected by
setting the T0CS bit in the OPTION_REG register to ‘1’.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 135
MCP19110/11
23.1.4
SWITCHING PRESCALER
BETWEEN TIMER0 AND WDT
MODULES
23.1.5
TIMER0 INTERRUPT
Timer0 will generate an interrupt when the TMR0
register overflows from FFh to 00h. The T0IF interrupt
flag bit of the INTCON register is set every time the
TMR0 register overflows, regardless of whether or not
the Timer0 interrupt is enabled. The T0IF bit can only
be cleared in software. The Timer0 interrupt enable is
the T0IE bit of the INTCON register.
As a result of having the prescaler assigned to either
Timer0 or the WDT, it is possible to generate an
unintended device Reset when switching prescaler
values. When changing the prescaler assignment from
Timer0 to the WDT module, the instruction sequence
shown in Example 23-1 must be executed.
Note:
The Timer0 interrupt cannot wake the
processor from Sleep, since the timer is
frozen during Sleep.
EXAMPLE 23-1:
CHANGING PRESCALER
(TIMER0 WDT)
BANKSEL TMR0
CLRWDT
;
23.1.6
USING TIMER0 WITH AN
EXTERNAL CLOCK
;Clear WDT
;Clear TMR0 and
;prescaler
;
CLRF
TMR0
When Timer0 is in Counter mode, the synchronization
of the T0CKI input and the Timer0 register is
accomplished by sampling the prescaler output on the
Q2 and Q4 cycles of the internal phase clocks.
Therefore, the high and low periods of the external
clock source must meet the timing requirements as
BANKSEL OPTION_REG
BSF
CLRWDT
OPTION_REG,PSA ;Select WDT
;
;
MOVLW
ANDWF
IORLW
MOVWF
b’11111000’
;Mask prescaler
;bits
;Set WDT prescaler
;to 1:32
OPTION_REG,W
b’00000101’
OPTION_REG
shown
in
Section 5.0
“Digital
Electrical
Characteristics”.
23.1.7
OPERATION DURING SLEEP
When changing the prescaler assignment from the
WDT to the Timer0 module, the following instruction
sequence must be executed (see Example 23-2).
Timer0 cannot operate while the processor is in Sleep
mode. The contents of the TMR0 register will remain
unchanged while the processor is in Sleep mode.
EXAMPLE 23-2:
CHANGING PRESCALER
(WDT TIMER0)
CLRWDT
;Clear WDT and
;prescaler
;
BANKSEL OPTION_REG
MOVLW
ANDWF
IORLW
MOVWF
b’11110000’ ;Mask TMR0 select and
OPTION_REG,W ;prescaler bits
b’00000011’ ;Set prescale to 1:16
OPTION_REG
;
TABLE 23-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER0
Register
on Page
Name
INTCON
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
GIE
PEIE
T0IE
INTE
T0SE
IOCIE
PSA
T0IF
PS2
INTF
PS1
IOCIF
PS0
96
OPTION_REG
TMR0
RAPU
INTEDG
T0CS
77
Timer0 Module Register
TRISA7 TRISA6 TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3
135*
114
TRISGPA
TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0
Legend: — = Unimplemented locations, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer0 module.
Page provides register information.
*
DS20002331D-page 136
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
24.0 TIMER1 MODULE WITH GATE
CONTROL
The Timer1 module is a 16-bit timer with the following
features:
• 16-bit timer register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L)
• Readable and Writable (both registers)
• Selectable internal clock source
• 2-bit prescaler
• Interrupt on overflow
Figure 24-1 is a block diagram of the Timer1 module.
FIGURE 24-1:
TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM
TMR1ON
Set flag bit
TMR1IF on
Overflow
TMR1(1)
TMR1L
TMR1H
FOSC
1
0
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
2
FOSC/4
T1CKPS<1:0>
Note 1: TMR1 register increments on rising edge.
TMR1CS
24.2.1
INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE
24.1 Timer1 Operation
The TMR1H:TMR1L register pair will increment on
multiples of FOSC or FOSC/4 as determined by the
Timer1 prescaler.
The Timer1 module is a 16-bit incrementing timer which
is accessed through the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair.
Writes to TMR1H or TMR1L directly update the
counter. The timer is incremented on every instruction
cycle.
As an example, when the FOSC internal clock source is
selected, the Timer1 register value will increment by four
counts every instruction clock cycle.
Timer1 is enabled by configuring the TMR1ON bit in the
T1CON register. Table 24-1 displays the Timer1 enable
selections.
TABLE 24-1: CLOCK SOURCE
SELECTIONS
TMR1CS
Clock Source
24.2 Clock Source Selection
1
0
8 MHz system Clock (FOSC)
The TMR1CS bit of the T1CON register is used to select
the clock source for Timer1. Table 24-1 displays the
clock source selections.
2 MHz instruction clock (FOSC/4)
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 137
MCP19110/11
24.3 Timer1 Prescaler
24.5 Timer1 in Sleep
Timer1 has four prescaler options allowing 1, 2, 4 or 8
divisions of the clock input. The T1CKPS bits of the
T1CON register control the prescale counter. The
prescale counter is not directly readable or writable;
however, the prescaler counter is cleared upon a write to
TMR1H or TMR1L.
Unlike other standard mid-range Timer1 modules, the
MCP19110/11 Timer1 module only clocks from an
internal system clock, and thus does not run during
Sleep mode, nor can it be used to wake the device from
this mode.
24.6 Timer1 Control Register
24.4 Timer1 Interrupt
The Timer1 Control register (T1CON), shown in
Register 24-1, is used to control Timer1 and select the
various features of the Timer1 module.
The Timer1 register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) increments
to FFFFh and rolls over to 0000h. When Timer1 rolls
over, the Timer1 interrupt flag bit of the PIR1 register is
set. To enable the interrupt on rollover, you must set
these bits:
• TMR1ON bit of the T1CON register
• TMR1IE bit of the PIE1 register
• PEIE bit of the INTCON register
• GIE bit of the INTCON register
The interrupt is cleared by clearing the TMR1IF bit in
the Interrupt Service Routine.
Note:
The TMR1H:TMR1L register pair and the
TMR1IF bit should be cleared before
enabling interrupts.
REGISTER 24-1: T1CON: TIMER1 CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
bit 5-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
T1CKPS<1:0>: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits
11= 1:8 Prescale value
10= 1:4 Prescale value
01= 1:2 Prescale value
00= 1:1 Prescale value
bit 3-2
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
TMR1CS: Timer1 Clock Source Control bit
1= 8 MHz system clock (FOSC
)
0= 2 MHz instruction clock (FOSC
TMR1ON: Timer1 On bit
1= Enables Timer1
)
bit 0
0= Stops Timer1, Clears Timer1 gate flip-flop
DS20002331D-page 138
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
TABLE 24-2: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER1
Register
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIE1
GIE
—
PEIE
ADIE
ADIF
T0IE
BCLIE
BCLIF
INTE
SSPIE
SSPIF
IOCE
—
T0IF
—
INTF
IOCF
95
96
TMR2IE TMR1IE
TMR2IF TMR1IF
PIR1
—
—
—
98
TMR1H
TMR1L
T1CON
Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
137*
137*
138
—
—
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0
—
—
TMR1CS TMR1ON
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer1 module.
Page provides register information.
*
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 139
MCP19110/11
The match output of the Timer2/PR2 comparator is
used to set the TMR2IF interrupt flag bit in the PIR1
register.
25.0 TIMER2 MODULE
The Timer2 module is an 8-bit timer with the following
features:
The TMR2 and PR2 registers are both fully readable
and writable. On any Reset, the TMR2 register is set to
00h and the PR2 register is set to FFh.
• 8-bit timer register (TMR2)
• 8-bit period register (PR2)
• Interrupt on TMR2 match with PR2
• Software programmable prescaler (1:1, 1:4, 1:16)
Timer2 is turned on by setting the TMR2ON bit in the
T2CON register to a ‘1’. Timer2 is turned off by clearing
the TMR2ON bit to a ‘0’.
See Figure 25-1 for a block diagram of Timer2.
The Timer2 prescaler is controlled by the T2CKPS bits
in the T2CON register. The prescaler counter is cleared
when:
25.1 Timer2 Operation
The clock input to the Timer2 module is the system
clock (FOSC). The clock is fed into the Timer2 prescaler,
which has prescale options of 1:1, 1:4 or 1:16. The
output of the prescaler is then used to increment the
TMR2 register.
• A write to TMR2 occurs
• A write to T2CON occurs
• Any device Reset occurs (Power-on Reset, MCLR
Reset, Watchdog Timer Reset, or Brown-out
Reset)
The values of TMR2 and PR2 are constantly compared
to determine when they match. TMR2 will increment
from 00h until it matches the value in PR2. When a
match occurs, TMR2 is reset to 00h on the next
increment cycle.
Note:
TMR2 is not cleared when T2CON is
written.
FIGURE 25-1:
TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Sets Flag
TMR2
bit TMR2IF
Output
Reset
EQ
Prescaler
1:1, 1:4, 1:8, 1:16
TMR2
FOSC
2
Comparator
PR2
T2CKPS<1:0>
DS20002331D-page 140
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
25.2 Timer2 Control Register
REGISTER 25-1: T2CON: TIMER2 CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
TMR2ON
T2CKPS1
T2CKPS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-3
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
TMR2ON: Timer2 On bit
1= Timer2 is on
0= Timer2 is off
bit 1-0
T2CKPS<1:0>: Timer2 Clock Prescale Select bits
00=Prescaler is 1
01=Prescaler is 4
10=Prescaler is 8
11=Prescaler is 16
TABLE 25-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER2
Register
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIE1
GIE
—
PEIE
ADIE
ADIF
T0IE
BCLIE
BCLIF
INTE
SSPIE
SSPIF
IOCE
—
T0IF
—
INTF
IOCF
95
96
TMR2IE
TMR2IF
TMR1IE
TMR1IF
PIR1
—
—
—
98
PR2
Timer2 Module Period Register
TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
Holding Register for the 8-bit TMR2 Time Base
140*
141
140*
T2CON
TMR2
—
—
—
—
—
Legend: — = unimplemented read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for Timer2 module.
Page provides register information.
*
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 141
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 142
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
26.1.2
SWITCHING FREQUENCY
SYNCHRONIZATION MODE
26.0 PWM MODULE
The CCP module implemented on the MCP19110/11
is a modified version of the CCP module found in
The MCP19110/11 can be programmed to be a
switching frequency MASTER or SLAVE device. The
MASTER device functions as described in
Section 26.1.1
Synchronization) Mode” with the exception of the
standard
mid-range
microcontrollers.
In
the
MCP19110/11, the PWM module is used to generate
the system clock or system oscillator. This system
clock will control the MCP19110/11 switching
frequency, as well as set the maximum allowable duty
cycle. The PWM module does not continuously adjust
the duty cycle to control the output voltage. This is
accomplished by the analog control loop and
associated circuitry.
“Stand-Alone
(Non-Frequency
system clock also being applied to GPA1.
A SLAVE device will receive the MASTER system
clock on GPA1. This MASTER system clock will be
OR’ed with the output of the TIMER2 module. This
OR’ed signal will latch PWMRL into PWMRH and
PWMPHL into PWMPHH.
26.1 Standard Pulse-Width Modulation
(PWM) Mode
Figure 26-1 shows a simplified block diagram of the
CCP module in PWM mode.
The PWMPHL register allows for a phase shift to be
added to the SLAVE system clock.
The PWM module output signal is used to set the
operating switching frequency and maximum
allowable duty cycle of the MCP19110/11. The actual
duty cycle on the HDRV and LDRV is controlled by the
analog PWM control loop. However, this duty cycle
cannot be greater than the value in the PWMRL
register.
It is desired to have the MCP19110/11 SLAVE device’s
system clock start point shifted by a programmed
amount from the MASTER system clock. This SLAVE
phase shift is specified by writing to the PWMPHL reg-
ister. The SLAVE phase shift can be calculated by
using the following equation.
There are two modes of operation that concern the
system clock PWM signal. These modes are
stand-alone (non-frequency synchronization) and
frequency synchronization.
EQUATION 26-2:
SLAVE PHASE SHIFT=PWMPHL•TOSC•(T2 PRESCALE VALUE)
26.1.1
STAND-ALONE (NON-FREQUENCY
SYNCHRONIZATION) MODE
When the MCP19110/11 is running stand-alone, the
PWM signal functions as the system clock. It is
operating at the programmed switching frequency with
a programmed maximum duty cycle (DCLOCK). The
programmed maximum duty cycle is not adjusted on a
cycle-by-cycle basis to control the MCP19110/11
system output. The required duty cycle (DBUCK) to
control the output is adjusted by the MCP19110/11
analog control loop and associated circuitry. DCLOCK
does, however, set the maximum allowable DBUCK
.
EQUATION 26-1:
DBUCK 1 – DCLOCK
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 143
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 26-1:
SIMPLIFIED PWM BLOCK DIAGRAM
PWMRL
8
PWMPHL
8
PWMPHH
(SLAVE)
PWMRH
(SLAVE)
LATCH DATA
LATCH DATA
8
8
SYSTEM
CLOCK
OSC
Comparator
Comparator
R
S
Q
Q
8
8
RESET TIMER
TMR2
(Note 1)
8
Comparator
8
CLKPIN_IN
PR2
Note 1: TIMER 2 should be clocked by FOSC (8 MHz).
A PWM output (Figure 26-2) has a time base (period)
and a time that the output stays high (duty cycle). The
frequency of the PWM is the inverse of the period
(1/period).
26.1.3
PWM PERIOD
The PWM period is specified by writing to the PR2
register. The PWM period can be calculated using the
following equation:
FIGURE 26-2:
PWM OUTPUT
EQUATION 26-3:
Period
PWM PERIOD=[(PR2)+1] x TOSC x (T2 PRESCALE VALUE)
When TMR2 is equal to PR2, the following two events
occur on the next increment cycle:
Duty Cycle
TMR2 = PR2 + 1
• TMR2 is cleared
TMR2 = PWMRH
• The PWM duty cycle is latched from PWMRL into
PWMRH
TMR2 = PR2 + 1
DS20002331D-page 144
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
26.1.4
PWM DUTY CYCLE (D
)
CLOCK
26.2 Operation During Sleep
The PWM duty cycle (DCLOCK) is specified by writing
to the PWMRL register. Up to 8-bit resolution is
available. The following equation is used to calculate
the PWM duty cycle (DCLOCK):
When the device is placed in Sleep, the allocated
timer will not increment and the state of the module will
not change. If the CLKPIN pin is driving a value, it will
continue to drive that value. When the device wakes
up, it will continue from this state.
EQUATION 26-4:
PWM DUTY CYCLE=PWMRL x TOSC x (T2 PRESCALE VALUE)
The PWMRL bits can be written to at any time, but the
duty cycle value is not latched into PWMRH until after
a match between PR2 and TMR2 occurs.
TABLE 26-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PWM MODULE
Register
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
APFCON
T2CON
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CLKSEL
112
141
140*
143*
143*
58
TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
PR2
Timer2 Module Period Register
PWM Register Low Byte
SLAVE Phase Shift Byte
PWMRL
PWMPHL
BUFFCON
MLTPH2 MLTPH1 MLTPH0
ASEL4
ASEL3
ASEL2
ASEL1
ASEL0
Legend: — = Unimplemented locations, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by Capture mode.
Page provides register information.
*
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 145
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 146
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
The I2C interface supports the following modes and
features:
27.0 MASTER SYNCHRONOUS
SERIAL PORT (MSSP)
MODULE
• Master mode
• Slave mode
• Byte NACKing (Slave mode)
• Limited Multi-Master support
• 7-bit and 10-bit addressing
• Start and Stop interrupts
• Interrupt masking
27.1 Master SSP (MSSP) Module
Overview
The Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) module is
a serial interface useful for communicating with other
peripheral or microcontroller devices. These peripheral
devices may be Serial EEPROMs, shift registers,
display drivers, A/D converters, etc. The MSSP module
only operates in Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) mode.
• Clock stretching
• Bus collision detection
• General call address matching
• Dual Address masking
• Address Hold and Data Hold modes
• Selectable SDA hold times
Figure 27-1 is a block diagram of the I2C interface
module in Master mode. Figure 27-2 is a diagram of the
I2C interface module in Slave mode.
2
FIGURE 27-1:
MSSP BLOCK DIAGRAM (I C MASTER MODE)
Internal
data bus
[SSPM 3:0]
Read
Write
SSPBUF
SSPSR
Baud rate
generator
(SSPADD)
SDA
Shift
Clock
SDA in
MSb
LSb
Start bit, Stop bit,
Acknowledge
Generate (SSPCON2)
SCL
Start bit detect,
Stop bit detect,
SCL in
Bus Collision
Write collision detect,
Clock arbitration,
State counter for,
end of XMIT/RCV,
Address Match detect
Set/Reset: S, P, SSPSTAT, WCOL, SSPxOV
Reset SEN, PEN (SSPCON2)
Set SSPIF, BCLIF
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 147
MCP19110/11
2
FIGURE 27-2:
MSSP BLOCK DIAGRAM (I C SLAVE MODE)
Internal
Data Bus
Read
Write
SSPBUF Reg
SSPSR Reg
SCL
Shift
Clock
SDA
MSb
LSb
SSPMSK Reg
Match Detect
SSPADD Reg
Addr Match
Set, Reset
S, P bits
(SSPSTAT Reg)
Start and
Stop bit Detect
The SSPCON1 register is used to define the I2C mode.
Four selection bits (SSPCON1<3:0>) allow one of the
following I2C modes to be selected:
• I2C Slave mode (7-bit address)
• I2C Slave mode (10-bit address)
• I2C Master mode, clock = OSC/4 (SSPADD +1)
• I2C firmware controlled Master mode (Slave idle)
2
27.2 I C MODE OVERVIEW
The Inter-Integrated Circuit Bus (I2C) is a multi-master
serial data communication bus. Devices communicate
in a master/slave environment, where the master
devices initiate the communication. A Slave device is
controlled through addressing.
The MSSP module has eight registers for I2C
operation. They are the:
The SSPSTAT register gives the status of the data
transfer. This information includes detection of a
START or STOP bit, specifies if the data received byte
was data or address, if the next byte is completion of
the 10-bit address, and if this will be a read or write data
transfer.
• MSSP Status Register (SSPSTAT)
• MSSP Control Register1 (SSPCON1)
• MSSP Control Register2 (SSPCON2)
• MSSP Control Register3 (SSPCON3)
• Serial Receive/Transmit Buffer (SSPBUF)
The SSPBUF is the register in which transfer data is
written to or read from. The SSPSR register shifts the
data in or out of the device. In receive operation, the
SSPBUF and SSPSR create a double buffer receiver.
This allows reception of the next byte to begin before
reading the last byte of received data. When the
complete byte is received before the SSPBUF register
is read, a receiver overflow has occurred and the
SSPOV bit (SSPCON1<6>) is set and the byte in the
SSPSR is lost.
• MSSP Shift Register (SSPSR) - Not directly
accessible
• MSSP Address Register (SSPADD)
• MSSP Address Register2 (SSPADD2)
• MSSP Address Mask Register1 (SSPMSK)
• MSSP Address Mask Register2 (SSPMSK2)
DS20002331D-page 148
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
The I2C bus specifies two signal connections:
A Start bit is indicated by a high-to-low transition of the
SDA line while the SCL line is held high. Address and
data bytes are sent out, Most Significant bit (MSb) first.
The Read/Write bit is sent out as a logical one when the
master intends to read data from the slave, and is sent
out as a logical zero when it intends to write data to the
slave.
• Serial Clock (SCL)
• Serial Data (SDA)
Both the SCL and SDA connections are bidirectional
open-drain lines, each requiring pull-up resistors for the
supply voltage. Pulling the line to ground is considered
a logical zero; letting the line float is considered a
logical one.
Before selecting any I2C mode, the SCL and SDA pins
must be programmed to inputs by setting the
appropriate TRIS bits. Selecting I2C mode, by setting
the SSPEN bit, enables the SCL and SDA pins to be
used as clock and data lines in I2C mode.
The Acknowledge bit (ACK) is an active-low signal,
which holds the SDA line low to indicate to the
transmitter that the slave device has received the
transmitted data and is ready to receive more.
The transition of a data bit is always performed while
the SCL line is held low. Transitions that occur while the
SCL line is held high are used to indicate Start and Stop
bits.
Figure 27-3 shows a typical connection between two
devices configured as master and slave.
If the master intends to write to the slave, then it
repeatedly sends out a byte of data, with the slave
responding after each byte with an ACK bit. In this
example, the master device is in Master Transmit
mode, and the slave is in Slave Receive mode.
2
FIGURE 27-3:
I C MASTER/SLAVE
CONNECTION
VDD
If the master intends to read from the slave, then it
repeatedly receives a byte of data from the slave, and
responds after each byte with an ACK bit. In this
example, the master device is in Master Receive mode,
and the slave is Slave Transmit mode.
SCL
SCL
VDD
Master
Slave
On the last byte of data communicated, the master
device may end the transmission by sending a Stop bit.
If the master device is in Receive mode, it sends the
Stop bit in place of the last ACK bit. A Stop bit is
indicated by a low-to-high transition of the SDA line,
while the SCL line is held high.
SDA
SDA
The I2C bus can operate with one or more master
devices and one or more slave devices.
In some cases, the master may want to maintain
control of the bus and reinitiate another transmission. If
so, the master device may send another Start bit in
place of the Stop bit or last ACK bit when it is in receive
mode.
There are four potential modes of operation for a given
device:
• Master Transmit mode
(master is transmitting data to a slave)
• Master Receive mode
(master is receiving data from a slave)
The I2C bus specifies three message protocols:
• Single message where a master writes data to a
slave
• Slave Transmit mode
(slave is transmitting data to a master)
• Single message where a master reads data from
a slave
• Slave Receive mode
(slave is receiving data from the master)
• Combined message where a master initiates a
minimum of two writes, or two reads, or a
combination of writes and reads, to one or more
slaves
To begin communication, a master device starts out in
Master Transmit mode. The master device sends out a
Start bit followed by the address byte of the slave it
intends to communicate with. This is followed by a
single Read/Write bit, which determines whether the
master intends to transmit to or receive data from the
slave device.
When one device is transmitting a logical one, or letting
the line float, and a second device is transmitting a
logical zero, or holding the line low, the first device can
detect that the line is not a logical one. This detection,
when used on the SCL line, is called clock stretching.
Clock stretching gives slave devices a mechanism to
control the flow of data. When this detection is used on
the SDA line, it is called arbitration. Arbitration ensures
that there is only one master device communicating at
any single time.
If the requested slave exists on the bus, it will respond
with an Acknowledge bit, otherwise known as an ACK.
The master then continues in either Transmit mode or
Receive mode and the slave continues in the
complement, either in Receive mode or Transmit
mode, respectively.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 149
MCP19110/11
If two master devices are sending a message to two
different slave devices at the address stage, the master
sending the lower slave address always wins
arbitration. When two master devices send messages
to the same slave address, and addresses can
sometimes refer to multiple slaves, the arbitration
process must continue into the data stage.
27.2.1
CLOCK STRETCHING
When a slave device has not completed processing
data, it can delay the transfer of more data through the
process of Clock Stretching. An addressed slave
device may hold the SCL clock line low after receiving
or sending a bit, indicating that it is not yet ready to
continue. The master that is communicating with the
slave will attempt to raise the SCL line in order to
transfer the next bit, but will detect that the clock line
has not yet been released. Because the SCL
connection is open-drain, the slave has the ability to
hold that line low until it is ready to continue
communicating.
Arbitration usually occurs very rarely, but it is a
necessary process for proper multi-master support.
2
27.3 I C MODE OPERATION
All MSSP I2C communication is byte oriented and
shifted out MSb first. Six SFR registers and two
interrupt flags interface the module with the PIC
microcontroller and user software. Two pins, SDA and
SCL, are exercised by the module to communicate
with other external I2C devices.
Clock stretching allows receivers that cannot keep up
with a transmitter to control the flow of incoming data.
27.2.2
ARBITRATION
Each master device must monitor the bus for Start and
Stop bits. If the device detects that the bus is busy, it
cannot begin a new message until the bus returns to an
Idle state.
27.3.1 BYTE FORMAT
All communication in I2C is done in 9-bit segments. A
byte is sent from a Master to a Slave or vice-versa, fol-
lowed by an Acknowledge bit sent back. After the 8th
falling edge of the SCL line, the device outputting data
on the SDA changes that pin to an input and reads in
an acknowledge value on the next clock pulse.
However, two master devices may try to initiate a
transmission on or about the same time. When this
occurs, the process of arbitration begins. Each
transmitter checks the level of the SDA data line and
compares it to the level that it expects to find. The first
transmitter to observe that the two levels don't match,
loses arbitration, and must stop transmitting on the
SDA line.
The clock signal, SCL, is provided by the master. Data
is valid to change while the SCL signal is low, and
sampled on the rising edge of the clock. Changes on
the SDA line while the SCL line is high define special
conditions on the bus, explained below.
For example, if one transmitter holds the SDA line to a
logical one (lets it float) and a second transmitter holds
it to a logical zero (pulls it low), the result is that the
SDA line will be low. The first transmitter then observes
that the level of the line is different than expected and
concludes that another transmitter is communicating.
27.3.2 DEFINITION OF I2C TERMINOLOGY
There is language and terminology in the description
of I2C communication that have definitions specific to
I2C. That word usage is defined below and may be
used in the rest of this document without explanation.
This table was adapted from the Philips I2C
specification.
The first transmitter to notice this difference is the one
that loses arbitration and must stop driving the SDA
line. If this transmitter is also a master device, it also
must stop driving the SCL line. It then can monitor the
lines for a Stop condition before trying to reissue its
transmission. In the meantime, the other device that
has not noticed any difference between the expected
and actual levels on the SDA line continues with its
original transmission. It can do so without any
complications, because so far, the transmission
appears exactly as expected with no other transmitter
disturbing the message.
27.3.3 SDA AND SCL PINS
On the MCP19110/11, the SCL and SDA pins are
always open-drain. These pins should be set by the
user to inputs by setting the appropriate TRIS bits.
Note: Data is tied to output zero when an I2C
mode is enabled.
Slave Transmit mode can also be arbitrated, when a
master addresses multiple slaves, but this is less
common.
DS20002331D-page 150
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
27.3.4 SDA HOLD TIME
The hold time of the SDA pin is selected by the SDAHT
bit of the SSPCON3 register. Hold time is the time SDA
is held valid after the falling edge of SCL. Setting the
SDAHT bit selects a longer 300 ns minimum hold time
and may help on buses with large capacitance.
2
TABLE 27-1: I C BUS TERMS
TERM
Description
The device which shifts data out onto the bus.
The device which shifts data in from the bus.
Transmitter
Receiver
Master
The device that initiates a transfer, generates clock signals and terminates a transfer.
The device addressed by the master.
Slave
Multi-Master
Arbitration
A bus with more than one device that can initiate data transfers.
Procedure to ensure that only one master at a time controls the bus. Winning arbitration
ensures that the message is not corrupted.
Synchronization
Idle
Procedure to synchronize the clocks of two or more devices on the bus.
No master is controlling the bus, and both SDA and SCL lines are high.
Any time one or more master devices are controlling the bus.
Active
Addressed Slave
Matching Address
Write Request
Read Request
Slave device that has received a matching address and is actively being clocked by a master.
Address byte that is clocked into a slave that matches the value stored in SSPADDx.
Slave receives a matching address with R/W bit clear, and is ready to clock in data.
Master sends an address byte with the R/W bit set, indicating that it wishes to clock data out of
the Slave. This data is the next and all following bytes until a Restart or Stop.
Clock Stretching
Bus Collision
When a device on the bus holds SCL low to stall communication.
Any time the SDA line is sampled low by the module while it is outputting and expected high
state.
27.3.5 START CONDITION
27.3.7 RESTART CONDITION
The I2C specification defines a Start condition as a
transition of SDA from a high to a low state, while SCL
line is high. A Start condition is always generated by
the master and signifies the transition of the bus from
an Idle to an Active state. Figure 27-4 shows the wave
forms for Start and Stop conditions.
A Restart is valid any time that a Stop would be valid.
A master can issue a Restart if it wishes to hold the
bus after terminating the current transfer. A Restart
has the same effect on the slave that a Start would,
resetting all slave logic and preparing it to clock in an
address. The master may want to address the same or
another slave.
A bus collision can occur on a Start condition if the
module samples the SDA line low before asserting it
low. This does not conform to the I2C Specification,
that states no bus collision can occur on a Start.
In 10-bit Addressing Slave mode, a Restart is required
for the master to clock data out of the addressed
slave. Once a slave has been fully addressed, match-
ing both high and low address bytes, the master can
issue a Restart and the high address byte with the
R/W bit set. The slave logic will then hold the clock
and prepare to clock out data.
27.3.6 STOP CONDITION
A Stop condition is a transition of the SDA line from
low-to-high state while the SCL line is high.
After a full match with R/W clear in 10-bit mode, a prior
match flag is set and maintained. Until a Stop
condition, a high address with R/W clear or a high
address match fails.
Note: At least one SCL low time must appear
before a Stop is valid, therefore, if the SDA
line goes low then high again while the SCL
line stays high, only the Start condition is
detected.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 151
MCP19110/11
27.3.8 START/STOP CONDITION INTERRUPT
MASKING
The SCIE and PCIE bits of the SSPCON3 register can
enable the generation of an interrupt in Slave modes
that do not typically support this function. These bits
will have no effect on slave modes where interrupt on
Start and Stop detect are already enabled.
2
FIGURE 27-4:
I C START AND STOP CONDITIONS
SDA
SCL
S
P
Change of
Change of
Data Allowed
Data Allowed
Start
Stop
Condition
Condition
2
FIGURE 27-5:
I C RESTART CONDITION
Sr
Change of
Data Allowed
Change of
Data Allowed
Restart
Condition
27.3.9 ACKNOWLEDGE SEQUENCE
Slave hardware will generate an ACK response if the
AHEN and DHEN bits of the SSPCON3 register are
clear.
The 9th SCL pulse for any transferred byte in I2C is
dedicated as an Acknowledge. It allows receiving
devices to respond back to the transmitter by pulling
the SDA line low. The transmitter must release control
of the line during this time to shift in the response. The
Acknowledge (ACK) is an active-low signal, pulling the
SDA line low indicates to the transmitter that the
device has received the transmitted data and is ready
to receive more.
There are certain conditions where an ACK will not be
sent by the slave. If the BF bit of the SSPSTAT register
or the SSPOV bit of the SSPCON1 register are set
when a byte is received, an ACK will not be sent.
When the module is addressed, after the 8th falling
edge of SCL on the bus, the ACKTIM bit of the
SSPCON3 register is set. The ACKTIM bit indicates
the acknowledge time of the active bus. The ACKTIM
Status bit is only active when the AHEN bit or DHEN
bit is enabled.
The result of an ACK is placed in the ACKSTAT bit of
the SSPCON2 register.
Slave software, when the AHEN and DHEN bits are
set, allow the user to set the ACK value sent back to
the transmitter. The ACKDT bit of the SSPCON2 regis-
ter is set/cleared to determine the response.
DS20002331D-page 152
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
2
2
27.4.2.2
I C Slave 10-bit Addressing Mode
27.4 I C SLAVE MODE OPERATION
In 10-bit Addressing mode, the first received byte is
compared to the binary value of ‘1 1 1 1 0 A9 A8 0’. A9
and A8 are the two MSb of the 10-bit address and
stored in bits 2 and 1 of the SSPADDx register.
The MSSP Slave mode operates in one of the four
modes selected in the SSPM bits of SSPCON1
register. The modes can be divided into 7-bit and
10-bit Addressing mode. 10-bit Addressing mode
operates the same as 7-bit, with some additional
overhead for handling the larger addresses.
After the acknowledge of the high byte, the UA bit is
set, and SCL is held low until the user updates
SSPADDx with the low address. The low address byte
is clocked in and all eight bits are compared to the low
address value in SSPADDx. Even if there is no
address match, SSPIF and UA are set, and SCL is
held low until SSPADDx is updated to receive a high
byte again. When SSPADDx is updated, the UA bit is
cleared. This ensures the module is ready to receive
the high address byte on the next communication.
Modes with Start and Stop bit interrupts operate the
same as the other modes. The exception is the SSPIF
bit getting set upon detection of a Start, Restart or Stop
condition.
27.4.1
SLAVE MODE ADDRESSES,
SSPADD
The SSPADD register (Register 27-7) contains the
Slave mode address. The first byte received after a
Start or Restart condition is compared against the
value stored in this register. If the byte matches, the
value is loaded into the SSPBUF register and an
interrupt is generated. If the value does not match, the
module goes idle and no indication is given to the
software that anything happened.
A high and low address match as a write request is
required at the start of all 10-bit addressing
communication. A transmission can be initiated by
issuing a Restart once the slave is addressed, and
clocking in the high address with the R/W bit set. The
slave hardware will then acknowledge the read
request and prepare to clock out data. This is only
valid for a slave after it has received a complete high
and low address byte match.
The SSPMSK register (Register 27-6) affects the
address matching process. See Section 27.4.10
“SSPMSKx Register” for more information.
27.4.3
SLAVE RECEPTION
When the R/W bit of a matching received address byte
is clear, the R/W bit of the SSPSTAT register is cleared.
The received address is loaded into the SSPBUF
register and acknowledged.
27.4.2
SECOND SLAVE MODE ADDRESS,
SSPADD2
The SSPADD2 register (Register 27-9) contains a
second Slave mode address. To enable the use of this
second Slave mode address, bit 0 must be set. The
first byte received after a Start or Restart condition is
compared against the value stored in this register. If
the byte matches, the value is loaded into the
SSPBUF register and an interrupt is generated. If the
value does not match, the module goes Idle and no
indication is given to the software that anything
happened.
When an overflow condition exists for a received
address, then not Acknowledge is given. An overflow
condition is defined as either bit BF of the SSPSTAT
register is set, or bit SSPOV of the SSPCON1 register
is set. The BOEN bit of the SSPCON3 register modifies
this operation. For more information, see
Register 27-5.
An MSSP interrupt is generated for each transferred
data byte. Flag bit, SSPIF, must be cleared by software.
The SSPMSK2 register, Register 27-8, affects the
address matching process. See Section 27.4.10
“SSPMSKx Register” for more information.
When the SEN bit of the SSPCON2 register is set, SCL
will be held low (clock stretch) following each received
byte. The clock must be released by setting the CKP
bit of the SSPCON1 register, except sometimes in
10-bit mode.
2
27.4.2.1
I C Slave 7-bit Addressing Mode
In 7-bit Addressing mode, the LSb of the received data
byte is ignored when determining if there is an address
match.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 153
MCP19110/11
27.4.3.1
7-bit Addressing Reception
27.4.3.2
7-bit Reception with AHEN and
DHEN
This section describes a standard sequence of events
for the MSSP module configured as an I2C Slave in
7-bit Addressing mode, all decisions made by
hardware or software and their effect on reception.
Figure 27-6 and Figure 27-7 are used as a visual
reference for this description.
Slave device reception with AHEN and DHEN set
operates the same as without these options, with extra
interrupts and clock stretching added after the 8th
falling edge of SCL. These additional interrupts allow
the slave software to decide whether it wants to ACK
the receive address or data byte, rather than the
hardware. This functionality adds support for PMBus
that was not present on previous versions of this
module.
This is a step-by-step process of what typically must
be done to accomplish I2C communication.
1. Start bit detected.
2. S bit of SSPSTAT is set; SSPIF is set if interrupt
on Start detect is enabled.
This list describes the steps that need to be taken by
slave software to use these options for I2C
communication. Figure 27-8 displays a module using
both address and data holding. Figure 27-9 includes
the operation with the SEN bit of the SSPCON2
register set.
3. Matching address with R/W bit clear is received.
4. The slave pulls SDA low sending an ACK to the
master, and sets SSPIF bit.
5. Software clears the SSPIF bit.
6. Software reads received address from SSPBUF
clearing the BF flag.
1. S bit of SSPSTAT is set; SSPIF is set if interrupt
on Start detect is enabled.
7. If SEN = 1, Slave software sets CKP bit to
2. Matching address with R/W bit clear is clocked
in. SSPIF is set and CKP cleared after the 8th
falling edge of SCL.
release the SCL line.
8. The master clocks out a data byte.
9. Slave drives SDA low, sending an ACK to the
master, and sets SSPIF bit.
3. Slave clears the SSPIF.
4. Slave can look at the ACKTIM bit of the SSP-
CON3 register to determine if the SSPIF was
after or before the ACK.
10. Software clears SSPIF.
11. Software reads the received byte from SSPBUF
clearing BF.
5. Slave reads the address value from SSPBUF,
clearing the BF flag.
12. Steps 8–12 are repeated for all received bytes
from the Master.
6. Slave sets ACK value clocked out to the master
by setting ACKDT.
13. Master sends Stop condition, setting P bit of
SSPSTAT, and the bus goes Idle.
7. Slave releases the clock by setting CKP.
8. SSPxIF is set after an ACK, not after a NACK.
9. If SEN = 1 the slave hardware will stretch the
clock after the ACK.
10. Slave clears SSPIF.
Note: SSPIF is still set after the 9th falling edge of
SCL even if there is no clock stretching and
BF has been cleared. Only if NACK is sent
to Master is SSPIF not set.
11. SSPIF set and CKP cleared after 8th falling
edge of SCL for a received data byte.
12. Slave looks at ACKTIM bit of SSPCON3 to
determine the source of the interrupt.
13. Slave reads the received data from SSPBUF
clearing BF.
14. Steps 7–14 are the same for each received data
byte.
15. Communication is ended by either the slave
sending an ACK = 1, or the master sending a
Stop condition. If a Stop is sent and Interrupt on
Stop Detect is disabled, the slave will only know
by polling the P bit of the SSTSTAT register.
DS20002331D-page 154
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
2
FIGURE 27-6:
I C SLAVE, 7-BIT ADDRESS, RECEPTION (SEN = 0, AHEN = 0, DHEN = 0)
Bus Master sends
Stop condition
From Slave to Master
Receiving Data
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 ACK D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Receiving Address
Receiving Data
ACK = 1
SDA
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1
ACK
9
SCL
S
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
SSPIF
BF
SSPIF set on 9th
falling edge of
SCL
Cleared by software
Cleared by software
First byte
of data is
available
SSPBUF is read
in SSPBUF
SSPOV
SSPOV set because
SSPBUF is still full.
ACK is not sent.
2
FIGURE 27-7:
I C SLAVE, 7-BIT ADDRESS, RECEPTION (SEN = 1, AHEN = 0, DHEN = 0)
Bus Master sends
Stop condition
Receive Address
Receive Data
Receive Data
ACK
R/W=0
ACK
9
SDA
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
ACK
SEN
SEN
SCL
S
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Clock is held low until CKP is set to ‘1’
SSPIF
SSPIF set on 9th
falling edge of SCL
Cleared by software
First byte
Cleared by software
SSPBUF is read
BF
of data is
available
in SSPBUF
SSPOV
SSPOV set because
SSPBUF is still full.
ACK is not sent.
CKP
SCL is not held
low because
CKP is written to 1 in software,
releasing SCL
CKP is written to ‘1’ in software,
releasing SCL
ACK= 1
2
FIGURE 27-8:
I C SLAVE, 7-BIT ADDRESS, RECEPTION (SEN = 0, AHEN = 1, DHEN = 1)
Master Releases SDAx
to slave for ACK sequence
Master sends
Stop condition
Receiving Address
Receiving Data
Received Data
ACK
ACK=1
SDA
ACK
9
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SCL
S
P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
SSPIF
If AHEN = 1:
SSPIF is set
SSPIF is set on
9th falling edge of
No interrupt
after not ACK
from Slave
Cleared by software
SCL, after ACK
BF
Address is
read from
SSBUF
Data is read from SSPBUF
ACKDT
Slave software
Slave software
sets ACKDT to
not ACK
clears ACKDT to
ACK the received
byte
CKP
When AHEN=1:
CKP is cleared by hardware
and SCL is stretched
When DHEN=1:
CKP is cleared by
hardware on 8th falling
edge of SCL
CKP set by software,
SCL is released
ACKTIM
ACKTIM cleared by
hardware in 9th
rising edge of SCL
ACKTIM set by hardware
on 8th falling edge of SCL
ACKTIM set by hardware
on 8th falling edge of SCL
S
P
2
FIGURE 27-9:
I C SLAVE, 7-BIT ADDRESS, RECEPTION (SEN = 1, AHEN = 1, DHEN = 1)
Master sends
Stop condition
Master releases
R/W = 0
SDA to slave for ACK sequence
ACK
Receiving Address
Receive Data
Receive Data
SDA
ACK
ACK
9
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SCL
S
P
1
2
3
4
1
2
9
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
4
5
6
7
8
5
6
7
8
9
3
SSPIF
No interrupt after
if not ACK
Cleared by software
from Slave
BF
Received
Received data is
available on SSPBUF
SSPBUF can be
read any time before
next byte is loaded
address is loaded into
SSPBUF
ACKDT
Slave software clears
ACKDT to ACK
the received byte
Slave sends
not ACK
CKP
CKP is not cleared
if not ACK
When AHEN = 1;
When DHEN = 1;
Set by software,
release SCL
on the 8th falling edge
of SCL of an address
byte, CKP is cleared
on the 8th falling edge
of SCL of a received
data byte, CKP is cleared
ACKTIM
ACKTIM is cleared by hardware
on 9th rising edge of SCL
ACKTIM is set by hardware
on 8th falling edge of SCL
S
P
MCP19110/11
27.4.4
SLAVE TRANSMISSION
27.4.4.2
7-bit Transmission
When the R/W bit of the incoming address byte is set
and an address match occurs, the R/W bit of the
SSPSTAT register is set. The received address is
loaded into the SSPBUF register, and an ACK pulse is
sent by the slave on the ninth bit.
A master device can transmit a read request to a
slave, and then clock data out of the slave. The list
below outlines what software for a slave will need to
do to accomplish
a
standard transmission.
Figure 27-10 can be used as a reference to this list.
Following the ACK, slave hardware clears the CKP bit
and the SCL pin is held low (see Section 27.4.7
“Clock Stretching” for more detail). By stretching the
clock, the master will be unable to assert another clock
pulse until the slave is done preparing the transmit
data.
1. Master sends a Start condition on SDA and
SCL.
2. S bit of SSPSTAT is set; SSPIF is set if interrupt
on Start detect is enabled.
3. Matching address with R/W bit set is received by
the Slave setting SSPIF bit.
The transmit data must be loaded into the SSPBUF
register which also loads the SSPSR register. Then the
SCL pin should be released by setting the CKP bit of
the SSPCON1 register. The eight data bits are shifted
out on the falling edge of the SCL input. This ensures
that the SDA signal is valid during the SCL high time.
4. Slave hardware generates an ACK and sets
SSPIF.
5. SSPIF bit is cleared by user.
6. Software reads the received address from SSP-
BUF, clearing BF.
7. R/W is set so CKP was automatically cleared
after the ACK.
The ACK pulse from the master-receiver is latched on
the rising edge of the ninth SCL input pulse. This ACK
value is copied to the ACKSTAT bit of the SSPCON2
register. If ACKSTAT is set (not ACK), then the data
transfer is complete. In this case, when the not ACK is
latched by the slave, the slave goes Idle and waits for
another occurrence of the Start bit. If the SDA line was
low (ACK), the next transmit data must be loaded into
the SSPBUF register. Again, the SCL pin must be
released by setting bit CKP.
8. The slave software loads the transmit data into
SSPBUF.
9. CKP bit is set releasing SCL, allowing the
master to clock the data out of the slave.
10. SSPIF is set after the ACK response from the
master is loaded into the ACKSTAT register.
11. SSPIF bit is cleared.
12. The slave software checks the ACKSTAT bit to
see if the master wants to clock out more data.
An MSSP interrupt is generated for each data transfer
byte. The SSPIF bit must be cleared by software and
the SSPSTAT register is used to determine the status
of the byte. The SSPIF bit is set on the falling edge of
the ninth clock pulse.
Note 1:If the master ACKs the clock will be
stretched.
2: ACKSTAT is the only bit updated on the
rising edge of SCL (9th) rather than the
falling.
27.4.4.1
Slave Mode Bus Collision
13. Steps 9-13 are repeated for each transmitted
byte.
A slave receives a Read request and begins shifting
data out on the SDA line. If a bus collision is detected
and the SBCDE bit of the SSPCON3 register is set, the
BCLIF bit of the PIR register is set. Once a bus collision
is detected, the slave goes Idle and waits to be
addressed again. User software can use the BCLIF bit
to handle a slave bus collision.
14. If the master sends a not ACK; the clock is not
held, but SSPIF is still set.
15. The master sends a Restart condition or a Stop.
16. The slave is no longer addressed.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 159
2
FIGURE 27-10:
I C SLAVE, 7-BIT ADDRESS, TRANSMISSION (AHEN = 0)
Master sends
Stop condition
Receiving Address
Automatic
Transmitting Data
Automatic
Transmitting Data
ACK
9
R/W = 1
ACK
SDA
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1
ACK
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SCL
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
S
SSPIF
BF
Cleared by software
BF is automatically
cleared after 8th falling
edge of SCL
Data to transmit is
loaded into SSPBUF
Received address
is read from SSPBUF
CKP
When R/W is set
SCL is always
CKP is not
held for not
held low after 9th SCL
falling edge
Set by software
ACK
ACKSTAT
Masters not ACK
is copied to
ACKSTAT
R/W
D/A
R/W is copied from the
matching address byte
Indicates an address
has been received
S
P
MCP19110/11
27.4.4.3
7-bit Transmission with Address
Hold Enabled
Setting the AHEN bit of the SSPCON3 register
enables additional clock stretching and interrupt
generation after the 8th falling edge of a received
matching address. Once a matching address has
been clocked in, CKP is cleared and the SSPIF
interrupt is set.
Figure 27-11 displays a standard waveform of a 7-bit
Address Slave Transmission with AHEN enabled.
1. Bus starts Idle.
2. Master sends Start condition; the S bit of
SSPSTAT is set; SSPIF is set if interrupt on Start
detect is enabled.
3. Master sends matching address with R/W bit
set. After the 8th falling edge of the SCL line, the
CKP bit is cleared and SSPIF interrupt is
generated.
4. Slave software clears SSPIF.
5. Slave software reads ACKTIM bit of SSPCON3
register, and R/W and D/A of the SSPSTAT
register to determine the source of the interrupt.
6. Slave reads the address value from the
SSPBUF register clearing the BF bit.
7. Slave software decides from this information if it
wishes to ACK or not ACK and sets ACKDT bit
of the SSPCON2 register accordingly.
8. Slave sets the CKP bit releasing SCL.
9. Master clocks in the ACK value from the slave.
10. Slave hardware automatically clears the CKP bit
and sets SSPIF after the ACK if the R/W bit is
set.
11. Slave software clears SSPIF.
12. Slave loads value to transmit to the master into
SSPBUF setting the BF bit.
Note: SSPBUF cannot be loaded until after the
ACK.
13. Slave sets CKP bit releasing the clock.
14. Master clocks out the data from the slave and
sends an ACK value on the 9th SCL pulse.
15. Slave hardware copies the ACK value into the
ACKSTAT bit of the SSPCON2 register.
16. Steps 10–15 are repeated for each byte
transmitted to the master from the slave.
17. If the master sends a not ACK, the slave
releases the bus, allowing the master to send a
Stop and end the communication.
Note: Master must send a not ACK on the last byte
to ensure that the slave releases the SCL
line to receive a Stop.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 161
2
FIGURE 27-11:
I C SLAVE, 7-BIT ADDRESS, TRANSMISSION (AHEN = 1)
Master sends
Stop condition
Master releases SDAx
to slave for ACK sequence
Receiving Address
Automatic
Transmitting Data
Automatic
ACK
Transmitting Data
R/W = 1
ACK
SDA
SCL
ACK
9
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
S
P
SSPIF
BF
Cleared by software
BF is automatically
cleared after 8th falling
edge of SCL
Received address
Data to transmit is
is read from SSPBUF
loaded into SSPBUF
ACKDT
Slave clears
ACKDT to ACK
address
ACKSTAT
CKP
Master’s ACK
response is copied
to SSPSTAT
When AHEN = 1;
CKP not cleared
after not ACK
When R/W = 1;
CKP is always
Set by software,
releases SCL
CKP is cleared by hardware
after receiving matching
address.
cleared after ACK
ACKTIM
ACKTIM is cleared
on 9th rising edge of SCL
ACKTIM is set on 8th falling
edge of SCL
R/W
D/A
MCP19110/11
27.4.5
SLAVE MODE 10-BIT ADDRESS
RECEPTION
27.4.6
10-BIT ADDRESSING WITH
ADDRESS OR DATA HOLD
This section describes a standard sequence of events
for the MSSP module configured as an I2C Slave in
10-bit Addressing mode.
Reception using 10-bit addressing with AHEN or DHEN
set is the same as with 7-bit modes. The only difference
is the need to update the SSPADDx register using the
UA bit. All functionality, specifically when the CKP bit is
cleared and SCL line is held low, are the same.
Figure 27-13 can be used as a reference of a slave in
10-bit addressing with AHEN set.
Figure 27-12 is used as a visual reference for this
description.
This is a step-by-step process of what must be done
by slave software to accomplish I2C communication.
Figure 27-14 shows a standard waveform for a slave
transmitter in 10-bit Addressing mode.
1. Bus starts Idle.
2. Master sends Start condition; S bit of SSPSTAT
is set; SSPIF is set, if interrupt on Start detect is
enabled.
3. Master sends matching high address with R/W
bit clear; UA bit of the SSPSTAT register is set.
4. Slave sends ACK and SSPIF is set.
5. Software clears the SSPIF bit.
6. Software reads received address from SSPBUF
clearing the BF flag.
7. Slave loads low address into SSPADDx,
releasing SCL.
8. Master sends matching low-address byte to the
Slave; UA bit is set.
Note:
Updates to the SSPADDx register are not
allowed until after the ACK sequence.
9. Slave sends ACK and SSPIF is set.
Note: If the low address does not match, SSPIF
and UA are still set so that the slave soft-
ware can set SSPADDx back to the high
address. BF is not set because there is no
match. CKP is unaffected.
10. Slave clears SSPIF.
11. Slave reads the received matching address
from SSPBUF clearing BF.
12. Slave loads high address into SSPADD.
13. Master clocks a data byte to the slave and
clocks out the slave’s ACK on the 9th SCL
pulse; SSPIF is set.
14. If SEN bit of SSPCON2 is set, CKP is cleared by
hardware and the clock is stretched.
15. Slave clears SSPIF.
16. Slave reads the received byte from SSPBUF
clearing BF.
17. If SEN is set, the slave sets CKP to release the
SCL.
18. Steps 13-17 repeat for each received byte.
19. Master sends Stop to end the transmission.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 163
2
FIGURE 27-12:
I C SLAVE, 10-BIT ADDRESS, RECEPTION (SEN = 1, AHEN = 0, DHEN = 0)
Master sends
Stop condition
Receive First Address Byte
Receive Second Address Byte
Receive Data
Receive Data
SDA
0
ACK
9
A9 A8
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
ACK
9
ACK
9
ACK
9
1
1
1
1
SCL
S
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SCL is held low
while CKP = 0
SSPIF
BF
Set by hardware
on 9th falling edge
Cleared by software
Data is read
from SSPBUF
Receive address is
read from SSPBUF
If address matches
SSPADD it is loaded into
SSPBUF
UA
Software updates SSPADD
and releases SCL
When UA = 1;
SCL is held low
CKP
When SEN = 1;
CKP is cleared after
9th falling edge of received byte
Set by software,
releasing SCL
2
FIGURE 27-13:
I C SLAVE, 10-BIT ADDRESS, RECEPTION (SEN = 0, AHEN = 1, DHEN = 0)
Receive First Address Byte
Receive Second Address Byte
Receive Data
Receive Data
R/W = 0
SDA
1
1
1
1
0
A9 A8
ACK
9
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 ACK D7 D6 D5
ACK
9
SCL
S
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
UA
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
UA
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
SSPIF
Set by hardware
on 9th falling edge
Cleared by software
Cleared by software
BF
SSPBUF can be
read anytime before
the next received byte
Received data
is read from
SSPBUF
ACKDT
Slave software clears
ACKDT to ACK
the received byte
UA
Update to SSPADD is
not allowed until 9th
falling edge of SCL
Update of SSPADD,
clears UA and releases
SCL
CKP
If when AHEN = 1;
on the 8th falling edge
of SCL of an address
byte, CKP is cleared
Set CKP with software
releases SCL
ACKTIM
ACKTIM is set by hardware
on 8th falling edge of SCL
2
FIGURE 27-14:
I C SLAVE, 10-BIT ADDRESS, TRANSMISSION (SEN = 0, AHEN = 0, DHEN = 0)
Master sends
Stop condition
Master sends
Restart event
Master sends
not ACK
Receiving Address
Receiving Second Address Byte
Transmitting Data Byte
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Receive First Address Byte
ACK = 1
R/W = 0
SDA
ACK
9
1
1
1
1
0
A9 A8
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0
1
1
1
1
0
A9 A8
ACK
ACK
SCL
S
1
6
7
8
9
2
3
4
5
1
1
1
6
7
8
7
8
9
2
3
4
5
2
3
4
5
6
6
7 8
9
2
3
4
5
P
Sr
SSPIF
BF
Set by hardware
Set by hardware
Cleared by software
SSPBUF loaded
with received address
Received address is
read from SSPBUF
Data to transmit is
loaded into SSPBUF
UA
High address is loaded
back into SSPADD
After SSPADD is
updated, UA is cleared
and SCL is released
UA indicates SSPADD
must be updated
CKP
When R/W = 1;
CKP is cleared on
Set by software
releases SCL
9th falling edge of SCLx
ACKSTAT
Masters not ACK
is copied
R/W
D/A
R/W is copied from the
matching address byte
Indicates an address
has been received
MCP19110/11
27.4.7
CLOCK STRETCHING
27.4.7.2
10-bit Addressing Mode
Clock stretching occurs when a device on the bus holds
the SCL line low, effectively pausing communication.
The slave may stretch the clock to allow more time to
handle data or prepare a response for the master
device. A master device is not concerned with
stretching, as anytime it is active on the bus and not
transferring data, it is stretching. Any stretching done
by a slave is invisible to the master software and
handled by the hardware that generates SCL.
In 10-bit Addressing mode, when the UA bit is set, the
clock is always stretched. This is the only time the SCL
is stretched without CKP being cleared. SCL is
released immediately after a write to SSPADDx.
Note: Previous versions of the module did not
stretch the clock if the second address byte
did not match.
27.4.7.3
Byte NACKing
The CKP bit of the SSPCON1 register is used to control
stretching in software. Any time the CKP bit is cleared,
the module will wait for the SCL line to go low and then
hold it. Setting CKP will release SCL and allow more
communication.
When AHEN bit of SSPCON3 is set; CKP is cleared by
the hardware after the 8th falling edge of SCL for a
received matching address byte. When DHEN bit of
SSPCON3 is set; CKP is cleared after the 8th falling
edge of SCL for received data.
Stretching after the 8th falling edge of SCL allows the
slave to look at the received address or data and
decide if it wants to ACK the received data.
27.4.7.1
Normal Clock Stretching
Following an ACK, if the R/W bit of the SSPSTAT is
set, causing a read request, the slave hardware will
clear CKP. This allows the slave time to update
SSPBUF with data to transfer to the master. If the SEN
bit of SSPCON2 is set, the slave hardware will always
stretch the clock after the ACK sequence. Once the
slave is ready; CKP is set by software and
communication resumes.
27.4.8
CLOCK SYNCHRONIZATION AND
THE CKP BIT
Any time the CKP bit is cleared, the module will wait for
the SCL line to go low and then hold it. However,
clearing the CKP bit will not assert the SCL output low
until the SCL output is already sampled low. Therefore,
the CKP bit will not assert the SCL line until an external
I2C master device has already asserted the SCL line.
The SCL output will remain low until the CKP bit is set
and all other devices on the I2C bus have released
SCL. This ensures that a write to the CKP bit will not
violate the minimum high time requirement for SCL
(see Figure 27-15).
Note 1: The BF bit has no effect on if the clock will
be stretched or not. This is different than
previous versions of the module that
would not stretch the clock or clear CKP,
if SSPBUF was read before the 9th falling
edge of SCL.
2: Previous versions of the module did not
stretch the clock for a transmission if
SSPBUF was loaded before the 9th falling
edge of SCL. It is now always cleared for
read requests.
FIGURE 27-15:
CLOCK SYNCHRONIZATION TIMING
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
SDA
SCL
DX
DX ‚ – 1
Master device
asserts clock
CKP
Master device
releases clock
WR
SSPCON1
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 167
MCP19110/11
In 10-bit Address mode, the UA bit will not be set on the
reception of the general call address. The slave will
prepare to receive the second byte as data, just as it
would in the 7-bit mode.
27.4.9
GENERAL CALL ADDRESS
SUPPORT
The addressing procedure for the I2C bus is such that
the first byte after the Start condition usually
determines which device will be the slave addressed by
the master device. The exception is the general call
address, which can address all devices. When this
address is used, all devices should, in theory, respond
with an acknowledge.
If the AHEN bit of the SSPCON3 register is set, just as
with any other address reception, the slave hardware
will stretch the clock after the 8th falling edge of SCL.
The slave must then set its ACKDT value and release
the clock with communication progressing as it would
normally.
The general call address is a reserved address in the
I2C protocol, defined as address 0x00. When the
GCEN bit of the SSPCON2 register is set, the slave
module will automatically ACK the reception of this
address, regardless of the value stored in SSPADDx.
After the slave clocks in an address of all zeros with the
R/W bit clear, an interrupt is generated and slave
software can read SSPBUF and respond. Figure 27-16
shows a general call reception sequence.
FIGURE 27-16:
SLAVE MODE GENERAL CALL ADDRESS SEQUENCE
Address is compared to General Call Address
after ACK, set interrupt
Receiving Data
ACK
R/W = 0
ACK
General Call Address
SDA
SCL
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
S
SSPIF
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
Cleared by software
SSPBUF is read
GCEN (SSPCON2<7>)
’1’
27.4.10 SSPMSKX REGISTER
An SSP Mask (SSPMSKx) register (Register 27-6 and
Register 27-8) is available in I2C Slave mode as a
mask for the value held in the SSPSRx register during
an address comparison operation. A zero (‘0’) bit in the
SSPMSKx register has the effect of making the
corresponding bit of the received address a “don’t
care”.
This register is reset to all ‘1’s upon any Reset
condition and, therefore, has no effect on standard
SSP operation until written with a mask value.
The SSP Mask register is active during:
• 7-bit Address mode: address compare of A<7:1>.
• 10-bit Address mode: address compare of A<7:0>
only. The SSP mask has no effect during the
reception of the first (high) byte of the address.
DS20002331D-page 168
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
2
27.5 I2C Master Mode
27.5.1
I C MASTER MODE OPERATION
The master device generates all of the serial clock
pulses and the Start and Stop conditions. A transfer is
ended with a Stop condition or with a Repeated Start
condition. Since the Repeated Start condition is also
the beginning of the next serial transfer, the I2C bus will
not be released.
Master mode is enabled by setting and clearing the
appropriate SSPM bits in the SSPCON1 register and
by setting the SSPEN bit. In Master mode, the SDA and
SCK pins must be configured as inputs. The MSSP
peripheral hardware will override the output driver TRIS
controls when necessary, to drive the pins low.
In Master Transmitter mode, serial data is output
through SDA, while SCL outputs the serial clock. The
first byte transmitted contains the slave address of the
receiving device (7 bits) and the Read/Write (R/W) bit.
In this case, the R/W bit will be logic ‘0’. Serial data is
transmitted eight bits at a time. After each byte is trans-
mitted, an Acknowledge bit is received. Start and Stop
conditions are output to indicate the beginning and the
end of a serial transfer.
Master mode of operation is supported by interrupt
generation on the detection of the Start and Stop
conditions. The Stop (P) and Start (S) bits are cleared
from a Reset or when the MSSP module is disabled.
Control of the I2C bus may be taken when the P bit is
set, or the bus is Idle.
In Firmware Controlled Master mode, user code
conducts all I2C bus operations based on Start and
Stop bit condition detection. Start and Stop condition
detection is the only active circuitry in this mode. All
other communication is done by the user software
directly manipulating the SDA and SCL lines.
In Master Receive mode, the first byte transmitted
contains the slave address of the transmitting device
(7 bits) and the R/W bit. In this case, the R/W bit will be
logic ‘1’. Thus, the first byte transmitted is a 7-bit slave
address followed by a ‘1’ to indicate the receive bit.
Serial data is received via SDA, while SCL outputs the
serial clock. Serial data is received eight bits at a time.
After each byte is received, an Acknowledge bit is
transmitted. Start and Stop conditions indicate the
beginning and the end of transmission.
The following events will cause the SSP Interrupt Flag
bit, SSPIF, to be set (SSP interrupt, if enabled):
• Start condition detected
• Stop condition detected
• Data transfer byte transmitted/received
• Acknowledge transmitted/received
• Repeated Start generated
A Baud Rate Generator is used to set the clock
frequency output on SCL. See Section 27.6 “Baud
Rate Generator” for more detail.
Note 1: The MSSP module, when configured in
I2C Master mode, does not allow queuing
of events. For instance, the user is not
allowed to initiate a Start condition and
immediately write the SSPBUF register to
initiate transmission before the Start
condition is complete. In this case, the
SSPBUF will not be written to and the
WCOL bit will be set, indicating that a
write to the SSPBUF did not occur.
27.5.2
CLOCK ARBITRATION
Clock arbitration occurs when the master, during any
receive, transmit or Repeated Start/Stop condition,
releases the SCL pin (SCL allowed to float high). When
the SCL pin is allowed to float high, the Baud Rate
Generator (BRG) is suspended from counting until the
SCL pin is actually sampled high. When the SCL pin is
sampled high, the Baud Rate Generator is reloaded
with the contents of SSPADD<7:0> and begins
counting. This ensures that the SCL high time will
always be at least one BRG rollover count in the event
that the clock is held low by an external device
(Figure 27-17).
2: When in Master mode, Start/Stop
detection is masked and an interrupt is
generated when the SEN/PEN bit is
cleared and the generation is complete.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 169
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 27-17:
BAUD RATE GENERATOR TIMING WITH CLOCK ARBITRATION
DX DX ‚ – 1
SDA
SCL deasserted but slave holds
SCL low (clock arbitration)
SCL allowed to transition high
SCL
BRG decrements on
Q2 and Q4 cycles
BRG
Value
03h
02h
01h
00h (hold off)
03h
02h
SCL is sampled high, reload takes
place and BRG starts its count
BRG
Reload
of the SDA being driven low while SCL is high is the
Start condition and causes the S bit of the SSPSTAT
register to be set. Following this, the Baud Rate
Generator is reloaded with the contents of
SSPADD<7:0> and resumes its count. When the Baud
Rate Generator times out (TBRG), the SEN bit of the
SSPCON2 register will be automatically cleared by
hardware; the Baud Rate Generator is suspended,
leaving the SDA line held low and the Start condition is
complete.
27.5.3
WCOL STATUS FLAG
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a Start, Restart,
Stop, Receive or Transmit sequence is in progress, the
WCOL is set and the contents of the buffer are
unchanged (the write does not occur). Any time the
WCOL bit is set, it indicates that an action on SSPBUF
was attempted while the module was not Idle.
Note:
Because queuing of events is not allowed,
writing to the lower five bits of SSPCON2
is disabled until the Start condition is
complete.
Note 1: If at the beginning of the Start condition,
the SDA and SCL pins are already sam-
pled low, or if during the Start condition,
the SCL line is sampled low before the
SDA line is driven low, a bus collision
occurs, the Bus Collision Interrupt Flag,
BCLIF, is set, the Start condition is
aborted and the I2C module is reset into
its Idle state.
2
27.5.4
I C MASTER MODE START
CONDITION TIMING
To initiate a Start condition, the user sets the Start
Enable bit, SEN bit of the SSPCON2 register. If the
SDA and SCL pins are sampled high, the Baud Rate
Generator is reloaded with the contents of
SSPADD<7:0> and starts its count. If SCL and SDA
are both sampled high when the Baud Rate Generator
times out (TBRG), the SDA pin is driven low. The action
2: The Philips I2C Specification states that a
bus collision cannot occur on a Start.
FIGURE 27-18:
FIRST START BIT TIMING
Set S bit (SSPSTAT<3>)
Write to SEN bit occurs here
At completion of Start bit,
hardware clears SEN bit
and sets SSPIF bit
SDA = 1,
SCL = 1
TBRG
TBRG
Write to SSPBUF occurs here
2nd bit
1st bit
TBRG
SDA
SCL
S
TBRG
DS20002331D-page 170
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
2
27.5.5
I C MASTER MODE REPEATED
START CONDITION TIMING
Note 1: If RSEN is programmed while any other
event is in progress, it will not take effect.
A Repeated Start condition occurs when the RSEN bit
of the SSPCON2 register is programmed high and the
Master state machine is no longer active. When the
RSEN bit is set, the SCL pin is asserted low. When the
SCL pin is sampled low, the Baud Rate Generator is
loaded and begins counting. The SDA pin is released
(brought high) for one Baud Rate Generator count
(TBRG). When the Baud Rate Generator times out, if
SDA is sampled high, the SCL pin will be deasserted
(brought high). When SCL is sampled high, the Baud
Rate Generator is reloaded and begins counting. SDA
and SCL must be sampled high for one TBRG. This
action is then followed by the assertion of the SDA pin
(SDA = 0) for one TBRG while SCL is high. SCL is
asserted low. Following this, the RSEN bit of the SSP-
CON2 register will be automatically cleared and the
Baud Rate Generator will not be reloaded, leaving the
SDA pin held low. As soon as a Start condition is
detected on the SDA and SCL pins, the S bit of the
SSPSTAT register will be set. The SSPIF bit will not be
set until the Baud Rate Generator has timed out.
2: A bus collision during the Repeated Start
condition occurs if:
•SDA is sampled low when SCL goes
from low-to-high.
•SCL goes low before SDA is
asserted low. This may indicate
that another master is attempting to
transmit a data ‘1’.
FIGURE 27-19:
REPEAT START CONDITION WAVEFORM
S bit set by hardware
Write to SSPCON2
occurs here
SDA = 1,
At completion of Start bit,
hardware clears RSEN bit
and sets SSPIF
SDA = 1,
SCL = 1
SCL (no change)
TBRG
TBRG
TBRG
1st bit
SDA
SCL
Write to SSPBUF occurs here
TBRG
Sr
Repeated Start
TBRG
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 171
MCP19110/11
2
27.5.6
I C MASTER MODE
TRANSMISSION
27.5.6.2
WCOL Status Flag
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a transmit is
already in progress (i.e., SSPSR is still shifting out a
data byte), the WCOL is set and the contents of the
buffer are unchanged (the write does not occur).
Transmission of a data byte, a 7-bit address or the
other half of a 10-bit address is accomplished by simply
writing a value to the SSPBUF register. This action will
set the Buffer Full flag bit, BF, and will allow the Baud
Rate Generator to begin counting and start the next
transmission. Each bit of address/data will be shifted
out onto the SDA pin after the falling edge of SCL is
asserted. SCL is held low for one Baud Rate Generator
rollover count (TBRG). Data should be valid before SCL
is released high. When the SCL pin is released high, it
is held that way for TBRG. The data on the SDA pin must
remain stable for that duration and some hold time after
the next falling edge of SCL. After the 8th bit is shifted
out (the falling edge of the 8th clock), the BF flag is
cleared and the master releases the SDA. This allows
the slave device being addressed to respond with an
ACK bit during the 9th bit time if an address match
occurred, or if data was received properly. The status of
ACK is written into the ACKSTAT bit on the rising edge
of the 9th clock. If the master receives an Acknowledge,
the Acknowledge Status bit, ACKSTAT, is cleared. If
not, the bit is set. After the 9th clock, the SSPIF bit is set
and the master clock (Baud Rate Generator) is
suspended until the next data byte is loaded into the
SSPBUF, leaving SCL low and SDA unchanged
(Figure 27-20).
WCOL must be cleared by software before the next
transmission.
27.5.6.3
ACKSTAT Status Flag
In Transmit mode, the ACKSTAT bit of the SSPCON2
register is cleared when the slave has sent an
Acknowledge (ACK = 0) and is set when the slave
does not Acknowledge (ACK = 1). A slave sends an
Acknowledge when it has recognized its address
(including a general call), or when the slave has
properly received its data.
27.5.6.4
Typical transmit sequence
1. The user generates a Start condition by setting
the SEN bit of the SSPCON2 register.
2. SSPIF is set by hardware on completion of the
Start.
3. SSPIF is cleared by software.
4. The MSSP module will wait the required start
time before any other operation takes place.
5. The user loads the SSPBUF with the slave
address to transmit.
After the write to the SSPBUF, each bit of the address
will be shifted out on the falling edge of SCL until all
seven address bits and the R/W bit are completed. On
the falling edge of the 8th clock, the master will release
the SDA pin, allowing the slave to respond with an
Acknowledge. On the falling edge of the 9th clock, the
master will sample the SDA pin to see if the address
was recognized by a slave. The status of the ACK bit is
loaded into the ACKSTAT Status bit of the SSPCON2
register. Following the falling edge of the 9th clock
transmission of the address, the SSPIF is set, the BF
flag is cleared and the Baud Rate Generator is turned
off until another write to the SSPBUF takes place,
holding SCL low and allowing SDA to float.
6. Address is shifted out the SDA pin until all eight
bits are transmitted. Transmission begins as
soon as SSPBUF is written to.
7. The MSSP module shifts in the ACK bit from the
slave device and writes its value into the
ACKSTAT bit of the SSPCON2 register.
8. The MSSP module generates an interrupt at the
end of the 9th clock cycle by setting the SSPIF
bit.
9. The user loads the SSPBUF with eight bits of
data.
10. Data is shifted out the SDA pin until all eight bits
are transmitted.
11. The MSSP module shifts in the ACK bit from the
slave device and writes its value into the
ACKSTAT bit of the SSPCON2 register.
27.5.6.1
BF Status Flag
In Transmit mode, the BF bit of the SSPSTAT register
is set when the CPU writes to SSPBUF, and is cleared
when all eight bits are shifted out.
12. Steps 8–11 are repeated for all transmitted data
bytes.
13. The user generates a Stop or Restart condition
by setting the PEN or RSEN bits of the SSP-
CON2 register. Interrupt is generated once the
Stop/Restart condition is complete.
DS20002331D-page 172
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
2
FIGURE 27-20:
I C MASTER MODE WAVEFORM (TRANSMISSION, 7 OR 10-BIT ADDRESS)
ACKSTAT in
SSPCON2 = 1
Write SSPCON2<0> SEN = 1
Start condition begins
From slave, clear ACKSTAT bit SSPCON2<6>
SEN = 0
Transmit Address to Slave
Transmitting Data or Second Half
of 10-bit Address
R/W = 0
ACK
SDA
SCL
A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1
ACK = 0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SSPBUF written with 7-bit address and R/W
start transmit
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
P
S
SCL held low
while CPU
responds to SSPIF
SSPIF
Cleared by software service routine
from SSP interrupt
Cleared by software
Cleared by software
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
SEN
SSPBUF is written by software
SSPBUF written
After Start condition, SEN cleared by hardware
PEN
R/W
MCP19110/11
2
27.5.7
I C MASTER MODE RECEPTION
27.5.7.4
Typical Receive Sequence:
Master mode reception is enabled by programming the
Receive Enable bit, RCEN bit, of the SSPCON2
register.
1. The user generates a Start condition by setting
the SEN bit of the SSPCON2 register.
2. SSPIF is set by hardware on completion of the
Start.
Note:
The MSSP module must be in an Idle
state before the RCEN bit is set, or the
RCEN bit will be disregarded.
3. SSPIF is cleared by software.
4. The user writes SSPBUF with the slave address
to transmit and the R/W bit set.
The Baud Rate Generator begins counting and on each
rollover, the state of the SCL pin changes (high-to-
low/low-to-high) and data is shifted into the SSPSR.
After the falling edge of the eighth clock, the receive
enable flag is automatically cleared, the contents of the
SSPSR are loaded into the SSPBUF, the BF flag bit is
set, the SSPIF flag bit is set and the Baud Rate Gener-
ator is suspended from counting, holding SCL low. The
MSSP is now in Idle state awaiting the next command.
When the buffer is read by the CPU, the BF flag bit is
automatically cleared. The user can then send an
Acknowledge bit at the end of reception by setting the
Acknowledge Sequence Enable, ACKEN bit, of the
SSPCON2 register.
5. Address is shifted out the SDA pin until all eight
bits are transmitted. Transmission begins as
soon as SSPBUF is written to.
6. The MSSP module shifts in the ACK bit from the
slave device and writes its value into the
ACKSTAT bit of the SSPCON2 register.
7. The MSSP module generates an interrupt at the
end of the 9th clock cycle by setting the SSPIF
bit.
8. User sets the RCEN bit of the SSPCON2 register
and the Master clocks in a byte from the slave.
9. After the 8th falling edge of SCL, SSPIF and BF
are set.
10. Master clears SSPIF and reads the received
byte from SSPBUF, clears BF.
27.5.7.1
BF Status Flag
In receive operation, the BF bit is set when an address
or data byte is loaded into SSPBUF from SSPSR. It is
cleared when the SSPBUF register is read.
11. Master sets ACK value sent to slave in ACKDT
bit of the SSPCON2 register and initiates the
ACK by setting the ACKEN bit.
12. Masters ACK is clocked out to the Slave and
SSPIF is set.
27.5.7.2
SSPOV Status Flag
In receive operation, the SSPOV bit is set when eight
bits are received into the SSPSR and the BF flag bit is
already set from a previous reception.
13. The user clears SSPIF.
14. Steps 8–13 are repeated for each received byte
from the slave.
27.5.7.3
WCOL Status Flag
15. Master sends a not ACK or Stop to end
communication.
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a receive is
already in progress (i.e., SSPSR is still shifting in a data
byte), the WCOL bit is set and the contents of the buffer
are unchanged (the write does not occur).
DS20002331D-page 174
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
2
FIGURE 27-21:
I C MASTER MODE WAVEFORM (RECEPTION, 7-BIT ADDRESS)
Write to SSPCON2<4>
to start Acknowledge sequence
SDA = ACKDT (SSPCON2<5>) = 0
Write to SSPCON2<0> (SEN = 1),
begin Start condition
Set ACKEN, start Acknowledge sequence
ACK from Master
SDA = ACKDT = 0
Master configured as a receiver
by programming SSPCON2<3> (RCEN = 1)
SDA = ACKDT = 1
SEN = 0
PEN bit = 1
Write to SSPBUF occurs here,
start XMIT
RCEN cleared
automatically
RCEN = 1, start
next receive
RCEN cleared
written here
ACK from Slave
automatically
Receiving Data from Slave
Transmit Address to Slave
Receiving Data from Slave
SDA
SCL
ACK
A7 A6 A5 A4
A3 A2 A1
ACK
D5
3
D2
D5
D2
D0
D7 D6
D4 D3
D7 D6
D4 D3
D1
D1
7
D0
R/W
ACK
Bus master
terminates
transfer
ACK is not sent
9
7
3
6
9
6
8
9
1
2
4
8
5
5
7
8
5
4
1
2
3
4
6
1
2
S
P
Set SSPIF at end
of receive
Data shifted in on falling edge of CLK
Set SSPIF interrupt
at end of Acknow-
ledge sequence
Set SSPIF interrupt
at end of receive
Set SSPIF interrupt
at end of Acknowledge
sequence
SSPIF
Set P bit
(SSPSTAT<4>)
and SSPIF
Cleared by software
Cleared by software
SDA = 0, SCLx = 1
while CPU
responds to SSPxIF
Cleared by software
Cleared by software
Cleared in
software
BF
Last bit is shifted into SSPSR and
contents are unloaded into SSPBUF
(SSPSTAT<0>)
SSPOV
SSPOV is set because
SSPBUF is still full
ACKEN
RCEN
Master configured as a receiver
RCEN cleared
automatically
ACK from Master
SDA = ACKDT = 0
RCEN cleared
automatically
by programming SSPCON2<3> (RCEN = 1)
MCP19110/11
27.5.8
ACKNOWLEDGE SEQUENCE
TIMING
27.5.9
STOP CONDITION TIMING
A Stop bit is asserted on the SDA pin at the end of a
receive/transmit by setting the Stop Sequence Enable
bit, PEN bit of the SSPCON2 register. At the end of a
receive/transmit, the SCL line is held low after the
falling edge of the 9th clock. When the PEN bit is set,
the master will assert the SDA line low. When the SDA
line is sampled low, the Baud Rate Generator is
reloaded and counts down to ‘0’. When the Baud Rate
Generator times out, the SCL pin will be brought high
and one TBRG (Baud Rate Generator rollover count)
later, the SDA pin will be deasserted. When the SDA
pin is sampled high while SCL is high, the P bit of the
SSPSTAT register is set. A TBRG later, the PEN bit is
cleared and the SSPIF bit is set (Figure 27-23).
An Acknowledge sequence is enabled by setting the
Acknowledge Sequence Enable bit, ACKEN bit, of the
SSPCON2 register. When this bit is set, the SCL pin is
pulled low and the contents of the Acknowledge data bit
are presented on the SDA pin. If the user wishes to gen-
erate an Acknowledge, then the ACKDT bit should be
cleared. If not, the user should set the ACKDT bit before
starting an Acknowledge sequence. The Baud Rate
Generator then counts for one rollover period (TBRG
)
and the SCL pin is deasserted (pulled high). When the
SCL pin is sampled high (clock arbitration), the Baud
Rate Generator counts for TBRG. The SCL pin is then
pulled low. Following this, the ACKEN bit is automatically
cleared, the Baud Rate Generator is turned off and the
MSSP module then goes into Idle mode (Figure 27-22).
27.5.9.1
WCOL Status Flag
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a Stop sequence
is in progress, then the WCOL bit is set and the
contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write does
not occur).
27.5.8.1
WCOL Status Flag
If the user writes the SSPBUF when an Acknowledge
sequence is in progress, then WCOL is set and the
contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write does
not occur).
FIGURE 27-22:
ACKNOWLEDGE SEQUENCE WAVEFORM
Acknowledge sequence starts here,
ACKEN automatically cleared
write to SSPCON2
ACKEN = 1, ACKDT = 0
TBRG
ACK
TBRG
SDA
SCL
D0
8
9
SSPIF
Cleared in
SSPIF set at
software
Cleared in
software
the end of receive
SSPIF set at the end
of Acknowledge sequence
Note:
TBRG = one Baud Rate Generator period.
FIGURE 27-23:
STOP CONDITION RECEIVE OR TRANSMIT MODE
SCL = 1for TBRG, followed by SDA = 1for TBRG
Write to SSPCON2,
set PEN
after SDA sampled high. P bit (SSPSTAT<4>) is set.
Falling edge of
9th clock
PEN bit (SSPCON2<2>) is cleared by
hardware and the SSPIF bit is set
TBRG
SCL
ACK
SDA
P
TBRG
TBRG
TBRG
SCL brought high after TBRG
SDA asserted low before rising edge of clock
to setup Stop condition
Note:
TBRG = one Baud Rate Generator period.
DS20002331D-page 176
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
27.5.10 SLEEP OPERATION
27.5.13 MULTI-MASTER COMMUNICATION,
BUS COLLISION AND BUS
ARBITRATION
While in Sleep mode, the I2C slave module can receive
addresses or data, and when an address match or
complete byte transfer occurs, wakes the processor
from Sleep (if the MSSP interrupt is enabled).
Multi-Master mode support is achieved by bus
arbitration. When the master outputs address/data bits
onto the SDA pin, arbitration takes place when the
master outputs a ‘1’ on SDA, by letting SDA float high
and another master asserts a ‘0’. When the SCL pin
floats high, data should be stable. If the expected data
on SDA is a ‘1’ and the data sampled on the SDA pin is
‘0’, then a bus collision has taken place. The master will
set the Bus Collision Interrupt Flag, BCLIF and reset
the I2C port to its Idle state (Figure 27-24).
27.5.11 EFFECTS OF A RESET
A Reset disables the MSSP module and terminates the
current transfer.
27.5.12 MULTI-MASTER MODE
In Multi-Master mode, the interrupt generation on the
detection of the Start and Stop conditions allows the
determination of when the bus is free. The Stop (P) and
Start (S) bits are cleared from a Reset or when the
MSSPx module is disabled. Control of the I2C bus may
be taken when the P bit of the SSPSTAT register is set,
or the bus is Idle, with both the S and P bits clear. When
the bus is busy, enabling the SSP interrupt will
generate the interrupt when the Stop condition occurs.
If a transmit was in progress when the bus collision
occurred, the transmission is halted, the BF flag is
cleared, the SDA and SCL lines are deasserted and the
SSPBUF can be written to. When the user services the
bus collision Interrupt Service Routine and if the I2C
bus is free, the user can resume communication by
asserting a Start condition.
In multi-master operation, the SDA line must be
monitored for arbitration to see if the signal level is the
expected output level. This check is performed by
hardware with the result placed in the BCLIF bit.
If a Start, Repeated Start, Stop or Acknowledge
condition was in progress when the bus collision
occurred, the condition is aborted, the SDA and SCL
lines are deasserted and the respective control bits in
the SSPCON2 register are cleared. When the user
services the bus collision Interrupt Service Routine and
if the I2C bus is free, the user can resume
communication by asserting a Start condition.
The states where arbitration can be lost are:
• Address Transfer
• Data Transfer
• A Start Condition
The master will continue to monitor the SDA and SCL
pins. If a Stop condition occurs, the SSPIF bit will be set.
• A Repeated Start Condition
• An Acknowledge Condition
A write to the SSPBUF will start the transmission of
data at the first data bit, regardless of where the
transmitter left off when the bus collision occurred.
In Multi-Master mode, the interrupt generation on the
detection of Start and Stop conditions allows the deter-
mination of when the bus is free. Control of the I2C bus
can be taken when the P bit is set in the SSPSTAT
register, or the bus is Idle and the S and P bits are
cleared.
FIGURE 27-24:
BUS COLLISION TIMING FOR TRANSMIT AND ACKNOWLEDGE
Sample SDA. While SCL is high,
data does not match what is driven
by the master.
SDA line pulled low
by another source
Data changes
while SCL = 0
Bus collision has occurred.
SDA released
by master
SDA
Set bus collision
interrupt (BCLIF)
SCL
BCLIF
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 177
MCP19110/11
If the SDA pin is sampled low during this count, the
BRG is reset and the SDA line is asserted early
(Figure 27-27). If, however, a ‘1’ is sampled on the SDA
pin, the SDA pin is asserted low at the end of the BRG
count. The Baud Rate Generator is then reloaded and
counts down to zero; if the SCL pin is sampled as ‘0’
during this time, a bus collision does not occur. At the
end of the BRG count, the SCL pin is asserted low.
27.5.13.1 Bus Collision During a Start
Condition
During a Start condition, a bus collision occurs if:
a) SDA or SCL are sampled low at the beginning of
the Start condition (Figure 27-25).
b) SCL is sampled low before SDA is asserted low
(Figure 27-26).
During a Start condition, both the SDA and the SCL
pins are monitored.
Note:
The reason that bus collision is not a
factor during a Start condition is that no
two bus masters can assert a Start
condition at the exact same time.
Therefore, one master will always assert
SDA before the other. This condition does
not cause a bus collision because the two
masters must be allowed to arbitrate the
first address following the Start condition.
If the address is the same, arbitration
must be allowed to continue into the data
portion, Repeated Start or Stop
conditions.
If the SDA pin is already low, or the SCL pin is already
low, then all of the following occur:
• the Start condition is aborted
• the BCLIF flag is set
•
the MSSP module is reset to its Idle state
(Figure 27-25).
The Start condition begins with the SDA and SCL pins
deasserted. When the SDA pin is sampled high, the
Baud Rate Generator is loaded and counts down. If the
SCL pin is sampled low while SDA is high, a bus
collision occurs because it is assumed that another
master is attempting to drive a data ‘1’ during the Start
condition.
FIGURE 27-25:
BUS COLLISION DURING START CONDITION (SDA ONLY)
SDA goes low before the SEN bit is set.
Set BCLIF,
S bit and SSPIF set because
SDA = 0, SCL = 1.
SDA
SCL
Set SEN, enable Start
condition if SDA = 1, SCL = 1
SEN cleared automatically because of bus collision.
SSP module reset into Idle state.
SEN
SDA sampled low before
Start condition. Set BCLIF.
S bit and SSPIF set because
SDA = 0, SCL = 1.
BCLIF
SSPIF and BCLIF are
cleared by software
S
SSPIF
SSPIF and BCLIF are
cleared by software
DS20002331D-page 178
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
FIGURE 27-26:
BUS COLLISION DURING START CONDITION (SCL = 0)
SDA = 0, SCL = 1
TBRG
TBRG
SDA
SCL
SEN
Set SEN, enable Start
sequence if SDA = 1, SCL = 1
SCL = 0before SDA = 0,
bus collision occurs. Set BCLIF.
SCL = 0before BRG time-out,
bus collision occurs. Set BCLIF.
BCLIF
Interrupt cleared
by software
S
’0’
’0’
’0’
’0’
SSPIF
FIGURE 27-27:
BRG RESET DUE TO SDA ARBITRATION DURING START CONDITION
SDA = 0, SCL = 1
Set S
Set SSPIF
Less than TBRG
TBRG
SDA
SCL
SDA pulled low by other master.
Reset BRG and assert SDAx.
S
SCLx pulled low after BRG
time-out
SEN
Set SEN, enable Start
sequence if SDA = 1, SCL = 1
’0’
BCLIF
S
SSPIF
Interrupts cleared
by software
SDAx = 0, SCL = 1,
set SSPIF
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 179
MCP19110/11
If SDA is low, a bus collision has occurred (i.e., another
master is attempting to transmit a data ‘0’, Figure 27-28).
If SDA is sampled high, the BRG is reloaded and begins
counting. If SDA goes from high-to-low before the BRG
times out, no bus collision occurs because no two
masters can assert SDA at exactly the same time.
27.5.13.2 Bus Collision During a Repeated
Start Condition
During a Repeated Start condition, a bus collision
occurs if:
a) A low level is sampled on SDA when SCL goes
from low level to high level.
If SCL goes from high-to-low before the BRG times out
and SDA has not already been asserted, a bus collision
occurs. In this case, another master is attempting to
transmit a data ‘1’ during the Repeated Start condition
(see Figure 27-29.)
b) SCL goes low before SDA is asserted low,
indicating that another master is attempting to
transmit a data ‘1’.
When the user releases SDA and the pin is allowed to
float high, the BRG is loaded with SSPADD and counts
down to zero. The SCL pin is then deasserted and
when sampled high, the SDA pin is sampled.
If, at the end of the BRG time-out, both SCL and SDA
are still high, the SDA pin is driven low and the BRG is
reloaded and begins counting. At the end of the count,
regardless of the status of the SCL pin, the SCL pin is
driven low and the Repeated Start condition is
complete.
FIGURE 27-28:
BUS COLLISION DURING A REPEATED START CONDITION (CASE 1)
SDA
SCL
Sample SDA when SCL goes high.
If SDA = 0, set BCLIF and release SDA and SCL.
RSEN
BCLIF
Cleared by software
’0’
S
’0’
SSPIF
FIGURE 27-29:
BUS COLLISION DURING REPEATED START CONDITION (CASE 2)
TBRG
TBRG
SDA
SCL
SCL goes low before SDA,
set BCLIF. Release SDA and SCL.
BCLIF
RSEN
Interrupt cleared
by software
’0’
S
SSPIF
DS20002331D-page 180
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
The Stop condition begins with SDA asserted low.
When SDA is sampled low, the SCL pin is allowed to
float. When the pin is sampled high (clock arbitration),
the Baud Rate Generator is loaded with SSPADD and
counts down to 0. After the BRG times out, SDA is
sampled. If SDA is sampled low, a bus collision has
occurred. This is due to another master attempting to
drive a data ‘0’ (Figure 27-30). If the SCL pin is sampled
low before SDA is allowed to float high, a bus collision
occurs. This is another case of another master
attempting to drive a data ‘0’ (Figure 27-31).
27.5.13.3 Bus Collision During a Stop
Condition
Bus collision occurs during a Stop condition if:
a) After the SDA pin has been deasserted and
allowed to float high, SDA is sampled low after
the BRG has timed out.
b) After the SCL pin is deasserted, SCL is sampled
low before SDA goes high.
FIGURE 27-30:
BUS COLLISION DURING A STOP CONDITION (CASE 1)
SDA sampled
TBRG
TBRG
TBRG
low after TBRG
,
set BCLIF
SDA
SDA asserted low
SCL
PEN
BCLIF
P
’0’
’0’
SSPIF
FIGURE 27-31:
BUS COLLISION DURING A STOP CONDITION (CASE 2)
TBRG
TBRG
TBRG
SDA
SCL goes low before SDA goes high,
set BCLIF
Assert SDA
SCL
PEN
BCLIF
P
’0’
’0’
SSPIF
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 181
MCP19110/11
2
TABLE 27-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH I C OPERATION
Reset
Values on
Page:
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIE1
GIE
—
PEIE
ADIE
T0IE
BCLIE
BCLIF
TRISA5
TRISB5
ADD5
INTE
SSPIE
SSPIF
IOCE
—
T0IF
—
INTF
IOCF
95
96
TMR2IE TMR1IE
TMR2IF TMR1IF
PIR1
—
ADIF
—
—
98
TRISGPA
TRISGPB
SSPADD
SSPBUF
SSPCON1
SSPCON2
TRISA7
TRISB7
ADD7
TRISA6
TRISB6
ADD6
TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2
TRISB4 TRISB3 TRISB2
TRISA1
TRISB1
ADD1
TRISA0
TRISB0
ADD0
114
117
188
148*
185
186
187
188
184
189
189
ADD4
ADD3
ADD2
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
WCOL
GCEN
SSPOV
SSPEN
CKP
ACKEN
BOEN
MSK4
P
SSPM3 SSPM2
RCEN PEN
SDAHT SBCDE
SSPM1
RSEN
AHEN
MSK1
UA
SSPM0
SEN
ACKSTAT ACKDT
SSPCON3 ACKTIM
PCIE
MSK6
CKE
SCIE
MSK5
D/A
DHEN
MSK0
BF
SSPMSK
SSPSTAT
SSPMSK2
SSPADD2
MSK7
SMP
MSK3
S
MSK2
R/W
MSK27
ADD27
MSK26
ADD26
MSK25
ADD25
MSK24
MSK23
MSK22
MSK21
MSK20
ADD24
ADD23
ADD22
ADD21
ADD20
Legend: —= unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the MSSP module in I2C mode.
*
Page provides register information.
DS20002331D-page 182
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
An internal signal “Reload” in Figure 27-32 triggers the
value from SSPADD to be loaded into the BRG counter.
This occurs twice for each oscillation of the module
clock line. The logic dictating when the reload signal is
asserted depends on the mode the MSSP is being
operated in.
27.6 BAUD RATE GENERATOR
The MSSP module has a Baud Rate Generator
available for clock generation in I2C Master mode. The
Baud Rate Generator (BRG) reload value is placed in
the SSPADD register (Register 27-7). When a write
occurs to SSPBUF, the Baud Rate Generator will
automatically begin counting down.
Table 27-2 demonstrates clock rates based on
instruction cycles and the BRG value loaded into
SSPADD.
Once the given operation is complete, the internal clock
will automatically stop counting and the clock pin will
remain in its last state.
EQUATION 27-1:
F
OSC
----------------------------------------------
F
=
CLOCK
SSPADD + 14
FIGURE 27-32:
BAUD RATE GENERATOR BLOCK DIAGRAM
SSPM<3:0>
SSPADD<7:0>
SSPM<3:0>
SCL
Reload
Control
Reload
BRG Down Counter
FOSC/2
SSPCLK
Note: Values of 0x00, 0x01 and 0x02 are not valid
for SSPADD when used as a Baud Rate
Generator for I2C. This is an implementation
limitation.
TABLE 27-2: MSSP CLOCK RATE W/BRG
FCLOCK
(2 Rollovers of BRG)
FOSC
FCY
BRG Value
8 MHz
8 MHz
8 MHz
2 MHz
2 MHz
2 MHz
04h
0Bh
13h
400 kHz(1)
166 kHz
100 kHz
Note 1: The I2C interface does not conform to the 400 kHz I2C specification (which applies to rates greater than
100 kHz) in all details, but may be used with care where higher rates are required by the application.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 183
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 27-2: SSPSTAT: SSP STATUS REGISTER
R/W-0
SMP
R/W-0
CKE
R-0
D/A
R-0
P
R-0
S
R-0
R-0
UA
R-0
BF
R/W
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
SMP: Data Input Sample bit
1 = Slew rate control disabled for standard speed mode (100 kHz and 1 MHz)
0 = Slew rate control enabled for high speed mode (400 kHz)
CKE: Clock Edge Select bit
1= Enable input logic so that thresholds are compliant with SMBus specification
0= Disable SMBus specific inputs
D/A: Data/Address bit
1= Indicates that the last byte received or transmitted was data
0= Indicates that the last byte received or transmitted was address
P: Stop bit
(This bit is cleared when the MSSP module is disabled, SSPEN is cleared.)
1= Indicates that a Stop bit has been detected last (this bit is ‘0’ on Reset)
0= Stop bit was not detected last
bit 3
bit 2
S: Start bit
(This bit is cleared when the MSSP module is disabled, SSPEN is cleared.)
1= Indicates that a Start bit has been detected last (this bit is ‘0’ on Reset)
0= Start bit was not detected last
R/W: Read/Write bit information
This bit holds the R/W bit information following the last address match. This bit is only valid from the
address match to the next Start bit, Stop bit, or not ACK bit.
In I2C Slave mode:
1= Read
0= Write
In I2C Master mode:
1= Transmit is in progress
0= Transmit is not in progress
OR-ing this bit with SEN, RSEN, PEN, RCEN or ACKEN will indicate if the MSSP is in Idle mode.
bit 1
bit 0
UA: Update Address bit (10-bit I2C mode only)
1= Indicates that the user needs to update the address in the SSPADD register
0= Address does not need to be updated
BF: Buffer Full Status bit
Receive:
1= Receive complete, SSPBUF is full
0= Receive not complete, SSPBUF is empty
Transmit:
1= Data transmit in progress (does not include the ACK and Stop bits), SSPBUF is full
0= Data transmit complete (does not include the ACK and Stop bits), SSPBUF is empty
DS20002331D-page 184
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 27-3: SSPCON1: SSP CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/C/HS-0
WCOL
R/C/HS-0
SSPOV
R/W-0
R/W-0
CKP
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
bit 0
SSPEN
SSPM<3:0>
bit 7
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
HS = Bit is set by hardware
C = User cleared
bit 7
WCOL: Write Collision Detect bit
Master mode:
1= A write to the SSPBUF register was attempted while the I2C conditions were not valid for a
transmission to be started
0= No collision
Slave mode:
1= The SSPBUF register is written while it is still transmitting the previous word (must be cleared in software)
0= No collision
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
SSPOV: Receive Overflow Indicator bit (1)
1= A byte is received while the SSPBUF register is still holding the previous byte. SSPOV is a “don’t
care” in Transmit mode (must be cleared in software).
0= No overflow
SSPEN: Synchronous Serial Port Enable bit
In both modes, when enabled, these pins must be properly configured as input or output
1= Enables the serial port and configures the SDA and SCL pins as the source of the serial port pins (2)
0= Disables serial port and configures these pins as I/O port pins
CKP: Clock Polarity Select bit
In I2C Slave mode:
SCL release control
1= Enable clock
0= Holds clock low (clock stretch). (Used to ensure data setup time.)
In I2C Master mode:
Unused in this mode
bit 3-0
SSPM<3:0>: Synchronous Serial Port Mode Select bits
0000= Reserved
0001= Reserved
0010= Reserved
0011= Reserved
0100= Reserved
0101= Reserved
0110= I2C Slave mode, 7-bit address
0111= I2C Slave mode, 10-bit address
1000= I2C Master mode, clock = FOSC/(4 x (SSPADD+1))(3)
1001= Reserved
1010= Reserved
1011= I2C firmware controlled Master mode (Slave idle)
1100= Reserved
1101= Reserved
1110= I2C Slave mode, 7-bit address with Start and Stop bit interrupts enabled
1111= I2C Slave mode, 10-bit address with Start and Stop bit interrupts enabled
Note 1: In Master mode, the overflow bit is not set since each new reception (and transmission) is initiated by
writing to the SSPBUF register.
2: When enabled, the SDA and SCL pins must be configured as inputs.
3: SSPADD values of 0, 1 or 2 are not supported for I2C Mode.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 185
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 27-4: SSPCON2: SSP CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-0/0
GCEN
R-0/0
R/W-0/0
ACKDT
R/S/HS-0/0 R/S/HS-0/0
ACKEN RCEN
R/S/HS-0/0
PEN
R/S/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0
RSEN SEN
bit 0
ACKSTAT
bit 7
Legend:
R = Readable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
x = Bit is unknown
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
S = User set
H = Bit is set by hardware
-n/n = Value at POR/Value at all other resets
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
GCEN: General Call Enable bit (in I2C Slave mode only)
1= Enable interrupt when a general call address (0x00 or 00h) is received in the SSPSR
0= General call address disabled
ACKSTAT: Acknowledge Status bit
1= Acknowledge was not received
0= Acknowledge was received
ACKDT: Acknowledge Data bit
In Receive mode:
Value transmitted when the user initiates an Acknowledge sequence at the end of a receive
1= Not Acknowledge
0= Acknowledge
bit 4
ACKEN: Acknowledge Sequence Enable bit (in I2C Master mode only)
In Master Receive mode:
1= Initiate Acknowledge sequence on SDA and SCL pins, and transmit ACKDT data bit.
Automatically cleared by hardware.
0= Acknowledge sequence Idle
bit 3
bit 2
RCEN: Receive Enable bit (in I2C Master mode only)
1= Enables Receive mode for I2C
0= Receive Idle
PEN: Stop Condition Enable bit (in I2C Master mode only)
SCK Release Control:
1= Initiate Stop condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware.
0= Stop condition Idle
bit 1
bit 0
RSEN: Repeated Start Condition Enabled bit (in I2C Master mode only)
1= Initiate Repeated Start condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware.
0= Repeated Start condition Idle
SEN: Start Condition Enabled bit (in I2C Master mode only)
In Master mode:
1= Initiate Start condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware.
0= Start condition Idle
In Slave mode:
1= Clock stretching is enabled for both slave transmit and slave receive (stretch enabled)
0= Clock stretching is disabled
Note 1: For bits ACKEN, RCEN, PEN, RSEN, SEN: If the I2C module is not in the Idle mode, this bit may not be
set (no spooling) and the SSPBUF may not be written (or writes to the SSPBUF are disabled).
DS20002331D-page 186
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 27-5: SSPCON3: SSP CONTROL REGISTER 3
R-0/0
R/W-0/0
PCIE
R/W-0/0
SCIE
R/W-0/0
BOEN
R/W-0/0
SDAHT
R/W-0/0
SBCDE
R/W-0/0
AHEN
R/W-0/0
DHEN
ACKTIM
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n/n = Value at POR/Value at ‘1’ = Bit is set
all other resets
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
ACKTIM: Acknowledge Time Status bit(2)
1= Indicates the I2C bus is in an Acknowledge sequence, set on the 8th falling edge of SCL clock
0= Not an Acknowledge sequence, cleared on the 9th rising edge of SCL clock
PCIE: Stop Condition Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enable interrupt on detection of Stop condition
0= Stop detection interrupts are disabled(1)
SCIE: Start Condition Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enable interrupt on detection of Start or Restart conditions
0= Start detection interrupts are disabled(1)
BOEN: Buffer Overwrite Enable bit
In I2C Master mode:
This bit is ignored.
In I2C Slave mode:
1= SSPBUF is updated and ACK is generated for a received address/data byte, ignoring the state
of the SSPOV bit only if the BF bit = 0.
0= SSPBUF is only updated when SSPOV is clear
bit 3
bit 2
SDAHT: SDA Hold Time Selection bit
1= Minimum of 300 ns hold time on SDA after the falling edge of SCL
0= Minimum of 100 ns hold time on SDA after the falling edge of SCL
SBCDE: Slave Mode Bus Collision Detect Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only)
If on the rising edge of SCL, SDA is sampled low when the module is outputting a high state, the BCLIF
bit of the PIR2 register is set, and bus goes Idle
1= Enable slave bus collision interrupts
0= Slave bus collision interrupts are disabled
bit 1
bit 0
AHEN: Address Hold Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only)
1= Following the 8th falling edge of SCL for a matching received address byte; CKP bit of the SSP-
CON1 register will be cleared and the SCL will be held low.
0= Address holding is disabled
DHEN: Data Hold Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only)
1= Following the 8th falling edge of SCL for a received data byte; slave hardware clears the CKP bit
of the SSPCON1 register and SCL is held low.
0= Data holding is disabled
Note 1: This bit has no effect in Slave modes that Start and Stop condition detection is explicitly listed as enabled.
2: The ACKTIM Status bit is only active when the AHEN bit or DHEN bit is set.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 187
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 27-6: SSPMSK: SSP MASK REGISTER 1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
MSK<7:0>
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-1
bit 0
MSK<7:1>: Mask bits
1= The received address bit n is compared to SSPADD<n> to detect I2C address match
0= The received address bit n is not used to detect I2C address match
MSK<0>: Mask bit for I2C Slave mode, 10-bit Address
I2C Slave mode, 10-bit address (SSPM<3:0> = 0111or 1111):
1= The received address bit 0 is compared to SSPADD<0> to detect I2C address match
0= The received address bit 0 is not used to detect I2C address match
I2C Slave mode, 7-bit address, the bit is ignored
REGISTER 27-7: SSPADD: MSSP ADDRESS AND BAUD RATE REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ADD<7:0>
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
Master mode:
bit 7-0
ADD<7:0>: Baud Rate Clock Divider bits
SCL pin clock period = ((ADD<7:0> + 1) x 4)/FOSC
10-Bit Slave mode — Most Significant Address byte:
bit 7-3
Not used: Unused for Most Significant Address byte. Bit state of this register is a “don’t care”. Bit
pattern sent by master is fixed by I2C specification and must be equal to ‘11110’. However, those bits
are compared by hardware and are not affected by the value in this register.
bit 2-1
bit 0
ADD<2:1>: Two Most Significant bits of 10-bit address
Not used: Unused in this mode. Bit state is a “don’t care”.
10-Bit Slave mode — Least Significant Address byte:
bit 7-0
ADD<7:0>: Eight Least Significant bits of 10-bit address
7-Bit Slave mode:
bit 7-1
bit 0
ADD<7:1>: 7-bit address
Not used: Unused in this mode. Bit state is a “don’t care”.
DS20002331D-page 188
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
REGISTER 27-8: SSPMSK2: SSP MASK REGISTER 2
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
MSK2<7:0>
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-1
bit 0
MSK2<7:1>: Mask bits
1= The received address bit n is compared to SSPADD2<n> to detect I2C address match
0= The received address bit n is not used to detect I2C address match
MSK2<0>: Mask bit for I2C Slave mode, 10-bit Address
I2C Slave mode, 10-bit address (SSPM<3:0> = 0111or 1111):
1= The received address bit 0 is compared to SSPADD2<0> to detect I2C address match
0= The received address bit 0 is not used to detect I2C address match
I2C Slave mode, 7-bit address, the bit is ignored
REGISTER 27-9: SSPADD2: MSSP ADDRESS 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ADD2<7:0>
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
Master mode:
bit 7-0
ADD2<7:0>: Baud Rate Clock Divider bits
SCL pin clock period = ((ADD<7:0> + 1) *4)/FOSC
10-Bit Slave mode — Most Significant Address byte:
bit 7-3
Not used: Unused for Most Significant Address byte. Bit state of this register is a “don’t care”. Bit
pattern sent by master is fixed by I2C specification and must be equal to ‘11110’. However, those bits
are compared by hardware and are not affected by the value in this register.
bit 2-1
bit 0
ADD2<2:1>: Two Most Significant bits of 10-bit address
ADD2<0>: SSPADD2 Enable bit.
1= Enable address matching with SSPADD2
0= Disable address matching with SSPADD2
10-Bit Slave mode — Least Significant Address byte:
bit 7-0
ADD2<7:0>: Eight Least Significant bits of 10-bit address
7-Bit Slave mode:
bit 7-1
bit 0
ADD2<7:1>: 7-bit address
ADD2<0>: SSPADD2 Enable bit.
1= Enable address matching with SSPADD2
0= Disable address matching with SSPADD2
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 189
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 190
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
28.1 Common Programming Interfaces
28.0 IN-CIRCUIT SERIAL
PROGRAMMING™ (ICSP™)
Connection to a target device is typically done through
an ICSP header. A commonly found connector on
development tools is the RJ-11 in the 6P6C (6 pin,
6 connector) configuration. See Figure 28-1.
ICSP programming allows customers to manufacture
circuit boards with unprogrammed devices. Programming
can be done after the assembly process, allowing the
device to be programmed with the most recent firmware
or a custom firmware. Five pins are needed for ICSP
programming:
FIGURE 28-1:
ICD RJ-11 STYLE
CONNECTOR INTERFACE
• ICSPCLK
• ICSPDAT
• MCLR
• VDD
ICSPDAT
• VSS
NC
2 4 6
VDD
ICSPCLK
In Program/Verify mode, the Program Memory, User IDs
and the Configuration Words are programmed through
1 3
5
Target
PC Board
Bottom Side
MCLR
serial communications. The ICSPDAT pin is
a
VSS
bidirectional I/O used for transferring the serial data and
the ICSPCLK pin is the clock input. The device is placed
into a Program/Verify mode by holding the ICSPDAT and
ICSPCLK pins low, while raising the MCLR pin from VIL to
Pin Description
1
2
3
4
5
6
=
=
=
=
=
=
1 = MCLR
VIHH
.
2 = VDDTarget
3 = VSS (ground)
4 = ICSPDAT
5 = ICSPCLK
6 = No Connect
Another connector often found in use with the PICkit™
programmers is a standard 6-pin header with 0.1 inch
spacing. Refer to Figure 28-2.
FIGURE 28-2:
PICkit™ PROGRAMMER-STYLE CONNECTOR INTERFACE
Pin 1 Indicator
Pin Description*
1
2
3
4
5
6
=
=
=
=
=
=
1 = MCLR
2 = VDDTarget
3 = VSS (ground)
4 = ICSPDAT
5 = ICSPCLK
6 = No Connect
1
2
3
4
5
6
*
The 6-pin header (0.100" spacing) accepts 0.025" square pins.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 191
MCP19110/11
For additional interface recommendations, refer to your
specific device programmer manual prior to PCB
design.
It is recommended that isolation devices be used to
separate the programming pins from other circuitry.
The type of isolation is highly dependent on the specific
application and may include devices, such as resistors,
diodes, or even jumpers. See Figure 28-3 for more
information.
FIGURE 28-3:
External
TYPICAL CONNECTION FOR ICSP PROGRAMMING
VDD
Programming
Signals
Device to be
Programmed
VDD
VDD
VPP
VSS
MCLR
VSS
Data
ICSPDAT
ICSPCLK
Clock
*
*
*
Isolation devices (as required)
*
To Normal Connections
28.2 In-Circuit Debugger
In-circuit debugging requires access to the ICDCLK,
ICDDATA, and MCLR pins. These pins are only
available on the MCP19111 device.
DS20002331D-page 192
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
29.0 INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
TABLE 29-1: OPCODE FIELD
DESCRIPTIONS
The MCP19110/11 instruction set is highly orthogonal
and is comprised of three basic categories:
Field
Description
• Byte-oriented operations
• Bit-oriented operations
f
W
b
Register file address (0x00 to 0x7F)
Working register (accumulator)
• Literal and control operations
Bit address within an 8-bit file register
Literal field, constant data or label
Each instruction is a 14-bit word divided into an
opcode, which specifies the instruction type, and one
or more operands, which further specify the operation
of the instruction. The formats for each of the
categories are presented in Figure 29-1, while the
various opcode fields are summarized in Table 29-1.
k
x
Don’t care location (= 0or 1).
The assembler will generate code with x = 0.
It is the recommended form of use for
compatibility with all Microchip software tools.
d
Destination select; d = 0: store result in W,
d = 1: store result in file register f.
Default is d = 1.
Table 29-2 lists the instructions recognized by the
MPASMTM assembler.
For byte-oriented instructions, ‘f’ represents a file
register designator and ‘d’ represents a destination
designator. The file register designator specifies which
file register is to be used by the instruction.
PC Program Counter
TO Time-Out bit
C
Carry bit
DC Digit carry bit
Zero bit
The destination designator specifies where the result of
the operation is to be placed. If ‘d’ is zero, the result is
placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is one, the result is placed
in the file register specified in the instruction.
Z
PD Power-Down bit
FIGURE 29-1:
GENERAL FORMAT FOR
INSTRUCTIONS
For bit-oriented instructions, ‘b’ represents a bit field
designator, which selects the bit affected by the
operation, while ‘f’ represents the address of the file in
which the bit is located.
Byte-Oriented file register operations
13
8
7
6
0
For literal and control operations, ‘k’ represents an
8-bit or 11-bit constant, or literal value.
OPCODE
d
f (FILE #)
d = 0for destination W
d = 1for destination f
f = 7-bit file register address
One instruction cycle consists of four oscillator periods;
for an oscillator frequency of 4 MHz, this gives a normal
instruction execution time of 1 µs. All instructions are
executed within a single instruction cycle, unless a
conditional test is true, or the program counter is
changed as a result of an instruction. When this occurs,
the execution takes two instruction cycles, with the
second cycle executed as an NOP.
Bit-Oriented file register operations
13 10 9 7 6
b (BIT #)
0
OPCODE
f (FILE #)
b = 3-bit bit address
f = 7-bit file register address
All instruction examples use the format ‘0xhh’ to
represent a hexadecimal number, where ‘h’ signifies a
hexadecimal digit.
Literal and control operations
29.1 Read-Modify-Write Operations
General
13
8
7
0
0
Any instruction that specifies a file register as part of
the instruction performs a Read-Modify-Write (RMW)
operation. The register is read, the data is modified,
and the result is stored according to either the
instruction or the destination designator ‘d’. A read
operation is performed on a register even if the
instruction writes to that register.
OPCODE
k (literal)
k = 8-bit immediate value
CALLand GOTOinstructions only
13 11 10
OPCODE
k = 11-bit immediate value
For example, a CLRF PORTA instruction will read
PORTGPA, clear all the data bits, then write the result
back to PORTGPA. This example would have the
unintended consequence of clearing the condition that
set the IOCF flag.
k (literal)
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 193
MCP19110/11
TABLE 29-2: MCP19110/11 INSTRUCTION SET
14-Bit Opcode
Status
Affecte Notes
d
Mnemonic,
Description
Operands
Cycles
MSb
LSb
BYTE-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS
ADDWF
ANDWF
CLRF
CLRW
COMF
DECF
f, d
f, d
f
Add W and f
AND W with f
Clear f
Clear W
Complement f
Decrement f
Decrement f, Skip if 0
Increment f
Increment f, Skip if 0
Inclusive OR W with f
Move f
1
1
1
1
1
1
1(2)
1
1(2)
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
00 0111 dfff ffff C, DC, Z
1, 2
1, 2
2
00 0101 dfff ffff
00 0001 lfff ffff
00 0001 0xxx xxxx
00 1001 dfff ffff
00 0011 dfff ffff
00 1011 dfff ffff
00 1010 dfff ffff
00 1111 dfff ffff
00 0100 dfff ffff
00 1000 dfff ffff
00 0000 lfff ffff
00 0000 0xx0 0000
00 1101 dfff ffff
00 1100 dfff ffff
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
–
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2, 3
1, 2
1, 2, 3
1, 2
1, 2
DECFSZ
INCF
Z
INCFSZ
IORWF
MOVF
MOVWF
NOP
RLF
RRF
SUBWF
SWAPF
XORWF
Z
Z
Move W to f
No Operation
–
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
f, d
Rotate Left f through Carry
Rotate Right f through Carry
Subtract W from f
Swap nibbles in f
Exclusive OR W with f
C
C
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2
1, 2
00 0010 dfff ffff C, DC, Z
00 1110 dfff ffff
00 0110 dfff ffff
Z
BIT-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS
BCF
BSF
BTFSC
BTFSS
f, b
f, b
f, b
f, b
Bit Clear f
Bit Set f
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
1
1
1 (2)
1 (2)
01 00bb bfff ffff
1, 2
1, 2
3
01 01bb bfff ffff
01 10bb bfff ffff
01 11bb bfff ffff
3
LITERAL AND CONTROL OPERATIONS
ADDLW
ANDLW
CALL
CLRWDT
GOTO
IORLW
MOVLW
RETFIE
RETLW
RETURN
SLEEP
SUBLW
XORLW
k
k
k
–
k
k
k
–
k
–
–
k
k
Add literal and W
AND literal with W
Call Subroutine
Clear Watchdog Timer
Go to address
1
1
2
1
2
1
1
2
2
2
1
1
1
11 111x kkkk kkkk C, DC, Z
11 1001 kkkk kkkk
10 0kkk kkkk kkkk
Z
00 0000 0110 0100 TO, PD
10 1kkk kkkk kkkk
Inclusive OR literal with W
Move literal to W
11 1000 kkkk kkkk
11 00xx kkkk kkkk
00 0000 0000 1001
11 01xx kkkk kkkk
00 0000 0000 1000
Z
Return from interrupt
Return with literal in W
Return from Subroutine
Go into Standby mode
Subtract W from literal
Exclusive OR literal with W
00 0000 0110 0011 TO, PD
11 110x kkkk kkkk C, DC, Z
11 1010 kkkk kkkk
Z
Note 1: When an I/O register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF PORTA, 1), the value used will be that
value present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and
is driven low by an external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’.
2: If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be
cleared if assigned to the Timer0 module.
3: If the Program Counter (PC) is modified, or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles.
The second cycle is executed as an NOP.
DS20002331D-page 194
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
29.2 Instruction Descriptions
ADDLW
Add literal and W
BCF
Bit Clear f
Syntax:
[ label ] ADDLW
0 k 255
k
Syntax:
[ label ] BCF f,b
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Description:
Operands:
0 f 127
0 b 7
(W) + k (W)
C, DC, Z
Operation:
0 (f<b>)
Status Affected:
Description:
None
The contents of the W register
are added to the eight-bit literal ‘k’
and the result is placed in the
W register.
Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is cleared.
ADDWF
Add W and f
BSF
Bit Set f
Syntax:
[ label ] ADDWF f,d
Syntax:
[ label ] BSF f,b
Operands:
0 f 127
d 0,1
Operands:
0 f 127
0 b 7
Operation:
(W) + (f) (destination)
Operation:
1 (f<b>)
Status Affected: C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
Description:
None
Description:
Add the contents of the W register
Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is set.
with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in the W register. If
‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’.
BTFSC
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
ANDLW
AND literal with W
Syntax:
[ label ] BTFSC f,b
Syntax:
[ label ] ANDLW
0 k 255
k
Operands:
0 f 127
0 b 7
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Description:
(W) .AND. (k) (W)
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 0
Z
Status Affected: None
The contents of W register are
AND’ed with the eight-bit literal
‘k’. The result is placed in the W
register.
Description: If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘1’, the next
instruction is executed.
If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘0’, the next
instruction is discarded, and an
NOPis executed instead, making
this a two-cycle instruction.
ANDWF
AND W with f
Syntax:
[ label ] ANDWF f,d
Operands:
0 f 127
d 0,1
Operation:
(W) .AND. (f) (destination)
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
AND the W register with register
‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in
the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 195
MCP19110/11
BTFSS
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
CLRWDT
Clear Watchdog Timer
Syntax:
[ label ] BTFSS f,b
Syntax:
[ label ] CLRWDT
Operands:
0 f 127
0 b < 7
Operands:
Operation:
None
00h WDT
0 WDT prescaler,
1 TO
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 1
Status Affected: None
1 PD
Description
If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘0’, the next
instruction is executed.
Status Affected: TO, PD
If bit ‘b’ is ‘1’, then the next
instruction is discarded and an
NOPis executed instead, making
this a two-cycle instruction.
Description:
CLRWDTinstruction resets the
Watchdog Timer. It also resets the
prescaler of the WDT.
Status bits TO and PD are set.
CALL
Call Subroutine
COMF
Complement f
Syntax:
[ label ] CALL k
0 k 2047
Syntax:
[ label ] COMF f,d
Operands:
Operation:
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
(PC)+ 1 TOS,
k PC<10:0>,
Operation:
(f) (destination)
(PCLATH<4:3>) PC<12:11>
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
Status Affected: None
The contents of register ‘f’ are
complemented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’,
the result is stored back in
register ‘f’.
Description:
Call Subroutine. First, return
address (PC + 1) is pushed onto
the stack. The eleven-bit
immediate address is loaded into
PC bits <10:0>. The upper bits of
the PC are loaded from PCLATH.
CALLis a two-cycle instruction.
CLRF
Clear f
DECF
Decrement f
Syntax:
[ label ] CLRF
0 f 127
f
Syntax:
[ label ] DECF f,d
Operands:
Operation:
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
00h (f)
1 Z
Operation:
(f) - 1 (destination)
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
The contents of register ‘f’ are
cleared and the Z bit is set.
Decrement register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’,
the result is stored in the W
register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’.
CLRW
Clear W
Syntax:
[ label ] CLRW
Operands:
Operation:
None
00h (W)
1 Z
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
W register is cleared. Zero bit (Z)
is set.
DS20002331D-page 196
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
DECFSZ
Decrement f, Skip if 0
INCFSZ
Increment f, Skip if 0
Syntax:
[ label ] DECFSZ f,d
Syntax:
[ label ] INCFSZ f,d
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operation:
(f) - 1 (destination);
skip if result = 0
Operation:
(f) + 1 (destination),
skip if result = 0
Status Affected: None
Status Affected: None
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is
‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is
‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
If the result is ‘1’, the next
instruction is executed. If the
result is ‘0’, then an NOPis
executed instead, making it a
two-cycle instruction.
If the result is ‘1’, the next
instruction is executed. If the
result is ‘0’, an NOPis executed
instead, making it a two-cycle
instruction.
GOTO
Unconditional Branch
IORLW
Inclusive OR literal with W
Syntax:
[ label ] GOTO k
0 k 2047
Syntax:
[ label ] IORLW k
0 k 255
Operands:
Operation:
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Description:
k PC<10:0>
PCLATH<4:3> PC<12:11>
(W) .OR. k (W)
Z
Status Affected: None
The contents of the W register are
OR’ed with the eight-bit literal ‘k’.
The result is placed in the
W register.
Description:
GOTOis an unconditional branch.
The eleven-bit immediate value is
loaded into PC bits <10:0>. The
upper bits of PC are loaded from
PCLATH<4:3>. GOTOis a
two-cycle instruction.
INCF
Increment f
IORWF
Inclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
[ label ] INCF f,d
Syntax:
[ label ] IORWF f,d
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operation:
(f) + 1 (destination)
Operation:
(W) .OR. (f) (destination)
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is
‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
Inclusive OR the W register with
register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is
‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 197
MCP19110/11
MOVF
Move f
MOVWF
Move W to f
[ label ] MOVWF
0 f 127
(W) (f)
Syntax:
Operands:
[ label ] MOVF f,d
Syntax:
f
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Description:
Operation:
(f) (dest)
None
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
Move data from W register to
register ‘f’.
The contents of register ‘f’ is
moved to a destination dependent
upon the status of ‘d’. If d = 0,
destination is W register. If d = 1,
the destination is file register ‘f’
itself. d = 1is useful to test a file
register since Status flag Z is
affected.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Example:
MOVW
F
OPTION
Before Instruction
OPTION = 0xFF
Words:
1
1
W
=
0x4F
After Instruction
Cycles:
Example:
OPTION = 0x4F
W
MOVF
FSR, 0
=
0x4F
After Instruction
W
=
value in
FSR register
Z
=
1
NOP
No Operation
MOVLW
Syntax:
Move literal to W
Syntax:
[ label ] NOP
[ label ] MOVLW k
0 k 255
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Description:
Words:
None
Operands:
Operation:
No operation
k (W)
None
Status Affected: None
No operation.
Description:
The eight-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into
1
W register. The “don’t cares” will
assemble as ‘0’s.
Cycles:
1
NOP
Example:
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Example:
MOVLW
0x5A
After Instruction
W
=
0x5A
DS20002331D-page 198
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
RETFIE
Return from Interrupt
[ label ] RETFIE
None
RETLW
Return with literal in W
[ label ] RETLW k
0 k 255
Syntax:
Syntax:
Operands:
Operation:
Operands:
Operation:
TOS PC,
1 GIE
k (W);
TOS PC
Status Affected:
Description:
None
Status Affected:
Description:
None
Return from Interrupt. Stack is
POPed and Top-of-Stack (TOS) is
loaded in the PC. Interrupts are
enabled by setting Global
Interrupt Enable bit, GIE (INT-
CON<7>). This is a two-cycle
instruction.
The W register is loaded with the
eight-bit literal ‘k’. The program
counter is loaded from the top of
the stack (the return address).
This is a two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
2
Cycles:
Example:
Words:
1
CALL TABLE;W contains
Cycles:
Example:
2
;table offset
;value
RETFIE
GOTO DONE
•
•
ADDWF PC ;W = offset
RETLW k1 ;Begin table
After Interrupt
TABLE
PC = TOS
GIE=
1
RETLW k2
;
•
•
•
RETLW kn ;End of table
DONE
Before Instruction
W
=
0x07
After Instruction
W
=
value of k8
RETURN
Return from Subroutine
Syntax:
[ label ] RETURN
None
Operands:
Operation:
TOS PC
Status Affected: None
Description: Return from subroutine. The stack
is POPed and the top of the stack
(TOS) is loaded into the program
counter. This is a two-cycle
instruction.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 199
MCP19110/11
RLF
Rotate Left f through Carry
SLEEP
Enter Sleep mode
[ label ] SLEEP
None
Syntax:
Operands:
[ label ]
RLF f,d
Syntax:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
00h WDT,
0 WDT prescaler,
1 TO,
Operation:
See description below
C
Status Affected:
Description:
0 PD
The contents of register ‘f’ are
rotated one bit to the left through
the Carry flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is placed in the W register.
If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored
back in register ‘f’.
Status Affected:
Description:
TO, PD
The power-down Status bit, PD is
cleared. Time-out Status bit, TO
is set. Watchdog Timer and its
prescaler are cleared.
The processor is put into Sleep
mode with the oscillator stopped.
C
Register f
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Example:
RLF
REG1,0
Before Instruction
REG1
0110
C
=
=
=
=
=
1110
0
After Instruction
REG1
0110
W
1100
C
1110
1100
1
RRF
Rotate Right f through Carry
SUBLW
Subtract W from literal
Syntax:
[ label ] RRF f,d
Syntax:
[ label ] SUBLW k
0 k 255
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
k - (W) W)
Operation:
See description below
C
Status Affected: C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
Description:
Description: The W register is subtracted (two’s
The contents of register ‘f’ are
rotated one bit to the right through
the Carry flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is placed in the W register.
If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed
back in register ‘f’.
complement method) from the
eight-bit literal ‘k’. The result is
placed in the W register.
Result
Condition
C = 0
W k
C
Register f
C = 1
W k
DC = 0
DC = 1
W<3:0> k<3:0>
W<3:0> k<3:0>
DS20002331D-page 200
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
SUBWF
Subtract W from f
XORWF
Exclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
[ label ] SUBWF f,d
Syntax:
[ label ] XORWF f,d
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operation:
(f) - (W) destination)
Operation:
(W) .XOR. (f) destination)
Status Affected: C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
Description:
Z
Description:
Subtract (two’s complement
Exclusive OR the contents of the
W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is
‘0’, the result is stored in the W
register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’.
method) W register from register ‘f’.
If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the
W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’.
C = 0
W f
C = 1
W f
DC = 0
DC = 1
W<3:0> f<3:0>
W<3:0> f<3:0>
SWAPF
Swap Nibbles in f
Syntax:
[ label ] SWAPF f,d
Operands:
0 f 127
d [0,1]
Operation:
(f<3:0>) (destination<7:4>),
(f<7:4>) (destination<3:0>)
Status Affected: None
Description:
The upper and lower nibbles of
register ‘f’ are exchanged. If ‘d’ is
‘0’, the result is placed in the W
register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed in register ‘f’.
XORLW
Exclusive OR literal with W
Syntax:
[ label ] XORLW k
0 k 255
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Description:
(W) .XOR. k W)
Z
The contents of the W register
are XOR’ed with the eight-bit
literal ‘k’. The result is placed in
the W register.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 201
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 202
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
30.1 MPLAB X Integrated Development
Environment Software
30.0 DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
The PIC® microcontrollers (MCU) and dsPIC® digital
signal controllers (DSC) are supported with a full range
of software and hardware development tools:
The MPLAB X IDE is a single, unified graphical user
interface for Microchip and third-party software, and
hardware development tool that runs on Windows®,
Linux and Mac OS® X. Based on the NetBeans IDE,
MPLAB X IDE is an entirely new IDE with a host of free
software components and plug-ins for high-
performance application development and debugging.
Moving between tools and upgrading from software
simulators to hardware debugging and programming
tools is simple with the seamless user interface.
• Integrated Development Environment
- MPLAB® X IDE Software
• Compilers/Assemblers/Linkers
- MPLAB XC Compiler
- MPASMTM Assembler
- MPLINKTM Object Linker/
MPLIBTM Object Librarian
- MPLAB Assembler/Linker/Librarian for
Various Device Families
With complete project management, visual call graphs,
a configurable watch window and a feature-rich editor
that includes code completion and context menus,
MPLAB X IDE is flexible and friendly enough for new
users. With the ability to support multiple tools on
multiple projects with simultaneous debugging, MPLAB
X IDE is also suitable for the needs of experienced
users.
• Simulators
- MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator
• Emulators
- MPLAB REAL ICE™ In-Circuit Emulator
• In-Circuit Debuggers/Programmers
- MPLAB ICD 3
Feature-Rich Editor:
- PICkit™ 3
• Color syntax highlighting
• Device Programmers
- MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
• Smart code completion makes suggestions and
provides hints as you type
• Low-Cost Demonstration/Development Boards,
Evaluation Kits and Starter Kits
• Automatic code formatting based on user-defined
rules
• Third-party Development Tools
• Live parsing
User-Friendly, Customizable Interface:
• Fully customizable interface: toolbars, toolbar
buttons, windows, window placement, etc.
• Call graph window
Project-Based Workspaces:
• Multiple projects
• Multiple tools
• Multiple configurations
• Simultaneous debugging sessions
File History and Bug Tracking:
• Local file history feature
• Built-in support for Bugzilla issue tracker
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 203
MCP19110/11
30.2 MPLAB XC Compilers
30.4 MPLINK Object Linker/
MPLIB Object Librarian
The MPLAB XC Compilers are complete ANSI C
compilers for all of Microchip’s 8, 16, and 32-bit MCU
and DSC devices. These compilers provide powerful
integration capabilities, superior code optimization and
ease of use. MPLAB XC Compilers run on Windows,
Linux or MAC OS X.
The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable
objects created by the MPASM Assembler. It can link
relocatable objects from precompiled libraries, using
directives from a linker script.
The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and
modification of library files of precompiled code. When
a routine from a library is called from a source file, only
the modules that contain that routine will be linked in
with the application. This allows large libraries to be
used efficiently in many different applications.
For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide
debug information that is optimized to the MPLAB X
IDE.
The free MPLAB XC Compiler editions support all
devices and commands, with no time or memory
restrictions, and offer sufficient code optimization for
most applications.
The object linker/library features include:
• Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many
smaller files
MPLAB XC Compilers include an assembler, linker and
utilities. The assembler generates relocatable object
files that can then be archived or linked with other
relocatable object files and archives to create an
executable file. MPLAB XC Compiler uses the
assembler to produce its object file. Notable features of
the assembler include:
• Enhanced code maintainability by grouping
related modules together
• Flexible creation of libraries with easy module
listing, replacement, deletion and extraction
30.5 MPLAB Assembler, Linker and
Librarian for Various Device
Families
• Support for the entire device instruction set
• Support for fixed-point and floating-point data
• Command-line interface
MPLAB Assembler produces relocatable machine
code from symbolic assembly language for PIC24,
PIC32 and dsPIC DSC devices. MPLAB XC Compiler
uses the assembler to produce its object file. The
assembler generates relocatable object files that can
then be archived or linked with other relocatable object
files and archives to create an executable file. Notable
features of the assembler include:
• Rich directive set
• Flexible macro language
• MPLAB X IDE compatibility
30.3 MPASM Assembler
The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal
macro assembler for PIC10/12/16/18 MCUs.
• Support for the entire device instruction set
• Support for fixed-point and floating-point data
• Command-line interface
The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object
files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX
files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol
reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines
and generated machine code, and COFF files for
debugging.
• Rich directive set
• Flexible macro language
• MPLAB X IDE compatibility
The MPASM Assembler features include:
• Integration into MPLAB X IDE projects
• User-defined macros to streamline
assembly code
• Conditional assembly for multipurpose
source files
• Directives that allow complete control over the
assembly process
DS20002331D-page 204
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
30.6 MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator
30.8 MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger
System
The MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator allows code
development in a PC-hosted environment by simulat-
ing the PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs on an instruction
level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be
examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from
a comprehensive stimulus controller. Registers can be
logged to files for further run-time analysis. The trace
buffer and logic analyzer display extend the power of
the simulator to record and track program execution,
actions on I/O, most peripherals and internal registers.
The MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger System is
Microchip’s most cost-effective, high-speed hardware
debugger/programmer for Microchip Flash DSC and
MCU devices. It debugs and programs PIC Flash
microcontrollers and dsPIC DSCs with the powerful,
yet easy-to-use graphical user interface of the MPLAB
IDE.
The MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger probe is
connected to the design engineer’s PC using a high-
speed USB 2.0 interface and is connected to the target
with a connector compatible with the MPLAB ICD 2 or
MPLAB REAL ICE systems (RJ-11). MPLAB ICD 3
supports all MPLAB ICD 2 headers.
The MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator fully supports
symbolic debugging using the MPLAB XC Compilers,
and the MPASM and MPLAB Assemblers. The soft-
ware simulator offers the flexibility to develop and
debug code outside of the hardware laboratory envi-
ronment, making it an excellent, economical software
development tool.
30.9 PICkit 3 In-Circuit Debugger/
Programmer
The MPLAB PICkit
3
allows debugging and
30.7 MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit
Emulator System
programming of PIC and dsPIC Flash microcontrollers
at a most affordable price point using the powerful
graphical user interface of the MPLAB IDE. The
MPLAB PICkit 3 is connected to the design engineer’s
PC using a full-speed USB interface and can be
connected to the target via a Microchip debug (RJ-11)
connector (compatible with MPLAB ICD 3 and MPLAB
REAL ICE). The connector uses two device I/O pins
and the Reset line to implement in-circuit debugging
and In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™).
The MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System is
Microchip’s next generation high-speed emulator for
Microchip Flash DSC and MCU devices. It debugs and
programs all 8, 16 and 32-bit MCU, and DSC devices
with the easy-to-use, powerful graphical user interface of
the MPLAB X IDE.
The emulator is connected to the design engineer’s
PC using a high-speed USB 2.0 interface and is
connected to the target with either a connector
compatible with in-circuit debugger systems (RJ-11)
or with the new high-speed, noise tolerant, Low-
Voltage Differential Signal (LVDS) interconnection
(CAT5).
30.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal,
CE compliant device programmer with programmable
voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for
maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display
(128 x 64) for menus and error messages, and a mod-
ular, detachable socket assembly to support various
package types. The ICSP cable assembly is included
as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB
PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program
PIC devices without a PC connection. It can also set
code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3
connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable.
The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and
optimized algorithms for quick programming of large
memory devices, and incorporates an MMC card for file
storage and data applications.
The emulator is field upgradeable through future firm-
ware downloads in MPLAB X IDE. MPLAB REAL ICE
offers significant advantages over competitive emulators
including full-speed emulation, run-time variable
watches, trace analysis, complex breakpoints, logic
probes, a ruggedized probe interface and long (up to
three meters) interconnection cables.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 205
MCP19110/11
30.11 Demonstration/Development
Boards, Evaluation Kits, and
Starter Kits
30.12 Third-Party Development Tools
Microchip also offers a great collection of tools from
third-party vendors. These tools are carefully selected
to offer good value and unique functionality.
A wide variety of demonstration, development and
evaluation boards for various PIC MCUs and dsPIC
DSCs allows quick application development on fully
functional systems. Most boards include prototyping
areas for adding custom circuitry and provide applica-
tion firmware and source code for examination and
modification.
• Device Programmers and Gang Programmers
from companies, such as SoftLog and CCS
• Software Tools from companies, such as Gimpel
and Trace Systems
• Protocol Analyzers from companies, such as
Saleae and Total Phase
The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs,
temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232
interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional
EEPROM memory.
• Demonstration Boards from companies, such as
MikroElektronika, Digilent® and Olimex
• Embedded Ethernet Solutions from companies,
such as EZ Web Lynx, WIZnet and IPLogika®
The demonstration and development boards can be
used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom
circuits and for learning about various microcontroller
applications.
In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™
demonstration/development board series of circuits,
Microchip has a line of evaluation kits and demonstra-
®
tion software for analog filter design, KEELOQ security
ICs, CAN, IrDA®, PowerSmart battery management,
SEEVAL® evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow
rate sensing, plus many more.
Also available are starter kits that contain everything
needed to experience the specified device. This usually
includes a single application and debug capability, all
on one board.
Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com)
for the complete list of demonstration, development
and evaluation kits.
DS20002331D-page 206
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
31.0 PACKAGING INFORMATION
31.1 Package Marking Information
24-Lead QFN (4x4x0.9 mm) (MCP19110 only)
Example
28-Lead QFN (5x5x0.9 mm)(MCP19111 only)
Example
19111
PIN 1
PIN 1
e
3
E/MQ
1246256
Legend: XX...X Customer-specific information
Y
Year code (last digit of calendar year)
YY
WW
NNN
Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year)
Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’)
Alphanumeric traceability code
RoHS Compliant JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn)
e
3
*
This package is RoHS Compliant. The RoHS Compliant
JEDEC designator ( ) can be found on the outer packaging
e
3
for this package.
Note: In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will
be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available
characters for customer-specific information.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 207
MCP19110/11
24-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (MJ) – 4x4x0.9 mm Body [QFN]
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
DS20002331D-page 208
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 209
MCP19110/11
28-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (MQ) – 5x5x0.9 mm Body [QFN or VQFN]
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
A
B
E
N
NOTE 1
1
2
(DATUM B)
(DATUM A)
2X
0.10 C
2X
TOP VIEW
0.10 C
0.10 C
A1
C
A
SEATING
PLANE
28X
A3
0.08 C
0.10
SIDE VIEW
C A B
0.10
D2
C A B
E2
28X K
2
1
NOTE 1
28X L
N
28X b
0.10
0.05
C A B
C
e
BOTTOM VIEW
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-140C Sheet 1 of 2
DS20002331D-page 210
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
28-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (MQ) – 5x5x0.9 mm Body [QFN or VQFN]
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
Units
Dimension Limits
MILLIMETERS
NOM
MIN
MAX
Number of Pins
Pitch
Overall Height
Standoff
Contact Thickness
Overall Width
Exposed Pad Width
Overall Length
Exposed Pad Length
Contact Width
Contact Length
Contact-to-Exposed Pad
N
28
0.50 BSC
0.90
e
A
A1
A3
E
E2
D
D2
b
L
0.80
0.00
1.00
0.05
0.02
0.20 REF
5.00 BSC
3.25
5.00 BSC
3.25
0.25
0.40
-
3.15
3.35
3.15
0.18
0.35
0.20
3.35
0.30
0.45
-
K
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. Package is saw singulated.
3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-140C Sheet 2 of 2
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 211
MCP19110/11
28-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (MQ) – 5x5 mm Body [QFN] Land Pattern
With 0.55 mm Contact Length
Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-2140A
DS20002331D-page 212
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
APPENDIX A: REVISION HISTORY
Revision D (July 2016)
The following is the list of modifications:
1. Updated Register 6-15.
2. Updated information in Section 3.8.5, Overtem-
perature and Section 21.1, Circuit Operation.
Revision C (March 2015)
The following is the list of modifications:
1. Updated Figure 1-2.
2. Updated
Register 6-10,
Register 6-11,
Register 6-12 and Register 6-13.
3. Updated Section 9.2 “Calibration Word 2”.
4. Updated Section 9.3 “Calibration Word 3”.
5. Updated Equation 10-1.
6. Updated information in the first sentence of
Section 11.4 “PCL and PCLATH”.
7. Removed Section 11.1.1.2 “Indirect Read with
Files Select Register (FSR)”.
8. Updated the first sentence in Section 12.0
“Device Configuration”.
9. Removed Section “12.5 Device ID and Revision
ID”.
10. Updated information in Section 18.3.2 “Writing
to the Flash Program Memory”.
11. Updated information in Section 22.1.2 “Chan-
nel Selection”.
12. Updated information for bit 6-2 in Register 22-1.
Revision B (June 2013)
The following is the list of modifications:
1. Added new device MCP19110 to the family and
the related information across the document.
2. Updated information in Features section.
3. Added pinout diagram and pin summary table
for the MCP19110 device.
4. Updated Figure 1-1.
5. Updated Section 2.0 “Pin Description”.
6. Updated Section 4.3 “Thermal
Specifications”.
7. Added new Section 28.2 “In-Circuit
Debugger”.
8. Updated Section 31.1 “Package Marking
Information”.
9. Updated Product Identification System.
10. Fixed minor typographical errors.
Revision A (January 2013)
• Original Release of this Document.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 213
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 214
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
INDEX
Watchdog Timer ....................................................... 103
A
A/D
C
Specifications...................................................... 3, 5, 33
C Compilers
MPLAB C18.............................................................. 204
Calibration Word
Associated Registers.................................................. 84
Capture/Compare/PWM ........................................... 143, 145
Clock Switching .................................................................. 84
Code Examples
A/D Conversion ........................................................ 128
Assigning Prescaler to Timer0.................................. 136
Assigning Prescaler to WDT..................................... 136
Initializing PORTA .................................................... 111
Saving Status and W Registers in RAM................... 100
Compensation .................................................................... 18
Compensation Setting ........................................................ 43
Computed Function Calls ................................................... 78
Computed GOTO................................................................ 78
Current
A/D Conversion................................................................. 127
Requirements.............................................................. 34
Timing ................................................................... 34, 35
Absolute Maximum Ratings ................................................ 23
AC Characteristics .............................................................. 30
ACKSTAT ......................................................................... 172
ACKSTAT Status Flag ...................................................... 172
ADC .................................................................................. 125
Acquisition Requirements ......................................... 131
Associated Registers ................................................ 133
Block Diagram........................................................... 125
Calculating Acquisition Time..................................... 131
Channel Selection..................................................... 126
Configuration............................................................. 126
Configuring Interrupt ................................................. 128
Conversion Clock...................................................... 126
Conversion Procedure .............................................. 128
Internal Sampling Switch (RSS) IMPEDANCE .............. 131
Interrupts................................................................... 127
Operation .................................................................. 128
Operation During Sleep ............................................ 128
Port Configuration..................................................... 126
Register Definitions................................................... 129
Source Impedance.................................................... 131
Special Event Trigger................................................ 128
ADCON0 Register............................................................. 129
ADCON1 Register............................................................. 130
ADRESH Register (ADFM = 0)......................................... 130
ADRESL Register (ADFM = 0).......................................... 130
Alternate Pin Function....................................................... 112
Analog Blocks Enable Control ............................................ 51
Analog Peripheral Control................................................... 49
Analog-to-Digital Converter. See ADC
Measurement Control................................................. 51
Current Sense ........................................................ 18, 40, 41
Customer Change Notification Service............................. 221
Customer Support............................................................. 221
D
Data Memory ...................................................................... 70
Data Memory Map.............................................................. 72
DC and AC Characteristics................................................. 53
Graphs and Tables..................................................... 53
DC Characteristics.............................................................. 30
Development Support....................................................... 203
Device
Configuration ........................................................ 37, 81
Code Protection.................................................. 82
Configuration Word............................................. 81
ID Locations ....................................................... 82
Write Protection.................................................. 82
Device Calibration............................................................... 59
Calibration Word 1...................................................... 59
Calibration Word 2...................................................... 60
Calibration Word 3...................................................... 61
Calibration Word 4...................................................... 62
Calibration Word 5...................................................... 63
Calibration Word 6...................................................... 64
Calibration Word 7...................................................... 65
Device Overview................................................................... 9
Digital Electrical Characteristics ......................................... 29
Diode Emulation Mode ....................................................... 49
ANSELA Register ............................................................. 115
ANSELB Register ............................................................. 118
APFCON Register............................................................. 112
Assembler
MPASM Assembler................................................... 204
B
Bench Testing
Analog Bench Test Control......................................... 57
System........................................................................ 57
BF ............................................................................. 172, 174
BF Status Flag .......................................................... 172, 174
Block Diagrams
ADC .......................................................................... 125
ADC Transfer Function ............................................. 132
Analog Input Model................................................... 132
Generic I/O Port........................................................ 111
Interrupt Logic............................................................. 94
MCLR Circuit............................................................... 86
MCP19110/11 Synchronous Buck Block Diagram...... 10
MSSP (I2C Master Mode) ......................................... 147
MSSP (I2C Slave Mode) ........................................... 148
On-Chip Reset Circuit................................................. 85
Simplified PWM......................................................... 144
Timer0....................................................................... 135
Timer1....................................................................... 137
Timer2....................................................................... 140
E
ECCP/CCP. See Enhanced Capture/Compare/PWM
Electrical Characteristics .............................................. 23, 24
Errata.................................................................................... 7
External Clock..................................................................... 30
F
Features
Miscellaneous............................................................. 21
Protection ................................................................... 20
Synchronous Buck........................................................ 1
Firmware Instructions ....................................................... 193
Flash Program Memory Control........................................ 105
Operation During Code Protect ................................ 109
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 215
MCP19110/11
Operation during write Protect ..................................109
Protecting..................................................................109
Reading.....................................................................108
Writing to...................................................................109
Flash Program Memory Control Registers........................106
DECF........................................................................ 196
DECFSZ ................................................................... 197
GOTO....................................................................... 197
INCF ......................................................................... 197
INCFSZ..................................................................... 197
IORLW...................................................................... 197
IORWF...................................................................... 197
MOVF ....................................................................... 198
MOVLW .................................................................... 198
MOVWF.................................................................... 198
NOP.......................................................................... 198
RETFIE..................................................................... 199
RETLW ..................................................................... 199
RETURN................................................................... 199
RLF........................................................................... 200
RRF .......................................................................... 200
SLEEP ...................................................................... 200
SUBLW..................................................................... 200
SUBWF..................................................................... 201
SWAPF..................................................................... 201
XORLW .................................................................... 201
XORWF .................................................................... 201
Summary Table ........................................................ 194
Internal Sampling Switch (RSS) IMPEDANCE ...................... 131
Internal Synchronous Driver ............................................... 17
Internal Temperature Indicator Module............................. 123
Circuit Operation....................................................... 123
Temperature Output ................................................. 123
Internal Temperature Measurement Control....................... 51
Internet Address ............................................................... 221
Interrupt-on-Change ......................................................... 121
Associated Registers................................................ 122
Clearing Interrupt Flags ............................................ 121
Enabling the Module................................................. 121
Operation in Sleep.................................................... 121
Pin Configuration...................................................... 121
Registers .................................................................. 122
Interrupts
H
High-Side Drive Strength ....................................................49
I
I/O
Ports..........................................................................111
I2C Mode (MSSPx)
Acknowledge Sequence ...........................................152
Acknowledge Sequence Timing................................176
Associated Registers ................................................182
Bus Collision
During a Repeated Start Condition...................180
During a Start Condition....................................178
During a Stop Condition....................................181
Effects of a Reset......................................................177
I2C Clock Rate w/BRG..............................................183
Master Mode.............................................................169
Clock Arbitration................................................169
Operation ..........................................................169
Reception..........................................................174
Start Condition Timing ..............................170, 171
Transmission.....................................................172
Multi-Master Communication, Bus Collision and Arbitra-
tion ....................................................................177
Multi-Master Mode ....................................................177
Operation ..................................................................150
Overview...................................................................148
Read/Write Bit Information (R/W Bit) ........................153
Slave Mode
10-bit Address Reception..................................163
Bus Collision .....................................................159
Clock Synchronization ......................................167
General Call Address Support ..........................168
Operation ..........................................................153
SSPMSKx Register...........................................168
Transmission.....................................................159
Sleep Operation........................................................177
Stop Condition Timing...............................................176
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP) ...............................191
Common Programming Interfaces............................191
In-Circuit Debugger...................................................192
Indirect Addressing .............................................................78
Input ....................................................................................24
Type............................................................................12
Under Voltage Lockout .........................................20, 37
Instruction Format .............................................................193
Instruction Set ...................................................................193
ADDLW.....................................................................195
ADDWF.....................................................................195
ANDLW.....................................................................195
ANDWF.....................................................................195
BCF...........................................................................195
BSF...........................................................................195
BTFSC ......................................................................195
BTFSS ......................................................................196
CALL.........................................................................196
CLRF.........................................................................196
CLRW .......................................................................196
CLRWDT...................................................................196
COMF .......................................................................196
ADC.......................................................................... 128
Associated Registers.................................................. 99
Context Saving ......................................................... 100
Control Registers........................................................ 95
RA2/INT...................................................................... 93
TMR1........................................................................ 138
L
Linear Regulators ............................................................... 17
M
MASTER Error Signal Gain ................................................ 45
Master Synchronous Serial Port. See MSSPx
MCLR.................................................................................. 86
Internal........................................................................ 86
Memory Organization ......................................................... 69
Data............................................................................ 70
Program...................................................................... 69
Microchip Internet Web Site.............................................. 221
MOSFET................................... 15, 16, 17, 38, 46, 49, 57, 67
Driver Dead Time........................................................ 17
MOSFET Driver
Dead Time.................................................................. 49
Programmable Dead Time.......................................... 46
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian................... 204
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software.. 203
MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer .................................... 205
MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System ................ 205
DS20002331D-page 216
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ................ 204
MSSPx.............................................................................. 147
Arbitration.................................................................. 150
Baud Rate Generator................................................ 183
Clock Stretching........................................................ 150
I2C Bus Terms .......................................................... 151
I2C Master Mode....................................................... 169
I2C Mode................................................................... 148
I2C Mode Operation.................................................. 150
I2C Slave Mode Operation........................................ 153
Module Overview ...................................................... 147
Multi-Phase System............................................................ 22
Pin Descriptions and Diagrams ................................ 119
PORTGPA ................................................................ 112, 121
ANSELA Register..................................................... 113
Associated Registers................................................ 115
Functions and Output Priorities ................................ 113
Interrupt-on-Change ................................................. 112
Weak Pull-Ups.......................................................... 112
PORTGPA Register.......................................................... 112
PORTGPB ................................................................ 116, 121
ANSELB Register..................................................... 116
Associated Registers................................................ 119
Functions and Output Priorities ................................ 116
Interrupt-on-Change ................................................. 116
P1B/P1C/P1D.Capture/Compare/PWM ................... 116
Weak Pull-Ups.......................................................... 116
PORTGPB Register.................................................. 116, 117
Power-Down Mode (Sleep)............................................... 101
Associated Registers................................................ 102
Power-on Reset (POR)....................................................... 86
Power-up Timer (PWRT) .................................................... 87
Prescaler, Timer1
Select (T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0 Bits) .............................. 46
Product Identification System........................................... 223
Program Memory................................................................ 69
Map and Stack (MCP19111) ...................................... 69
Program Memory Protection............................................... 82
Programming, Device Instructions.................................... 193
Pulse-Width Modulation...................................................... 33
Associated Registers................................................ 145
Duty Cycle ................................................................ 145
Module...................................................................... 143
Operating during Sleep............................................. 145
Period ....................................................................... 144
Stand-alone Mode .................................................... 143
Standard Mode......................................................... 143
Switching Frequency Synchronization Mode............ 143
O
OPCODE Field Descriptions............................................. 193
Oscillator............................................................................. 83
Associated Registers .................................................. 84
Calibration................................................................... 83
Delay Upon Power-up................................................. 84
Frequency Tuning....................................................... 83
Internal Oscillator........................................................ 83
Oscillator Module ................................................................ 84
Output ................................................................................. 49
Multiple System........................................................... 22
Overcurrent..................................................... 20, 38, 39
Overvoltage..................................................... 20, 25, 48
Overvoltage Enable .................................................... 51
Power Good................................................................ 22
Type............................................................................ 12
Under Voltage................................................. 20, 25, 48
Under Voltage Accelerator.......................................... 49
Under Voltage Enable................................................. 51
Voltage........................................................................ 18
Soft-Start............................................................. 22
Tracking.............................................................. 22
Voltage Configuration ................................................. 47
Voltage Sense Pull-up/Pull-down................................ 49
Overcurrent......................................................................... 39
Overvoltage Accelerator ..................................................... 49
R
Reader Response............................................................. 222
Read-Modify-Write Operations ......................................... 193
Register
P
Packaging ......................................................................... 207
Marking ..................................................................... 207
Specifications............................................................ 208
PCL..................................................................................... 78
Modifying..................................................................... 78
PCLATH.............................................................................. 78
PCON Register ............................................................. 87, 92
Pin Diagram
OVFCON (Output Voltage Set Point Fine Control)..... 47
Registers
ABECON (Analog Block Enable Control) ................... 52
ADCON0 (ADC Control 0)........................................ 129
ADCON1 (ADC Control 1)........................................ 130
ADRESH (ADC Result High) with ADFM = 0) .......... 130
ADRESL (ADC Result Low) with ADFM = 0)............ 130
ANSELA (Analog Select GPA) ................................. 115
ANSELB (Analog Select GPB) ................................. 118
APFCON (Alternate Pin Function Control) ............... 112
ATSTCON (Analog Bench Test Control).................... 57
BUFFCON (Unity Gain Buffer Control)....................... 58
CALWD1 (Calibration Word 1) ................................... 59
CALWD2 (Calibration Word 2) ................................... 60
CALWD3 (Calibration Word 3) ................................... 61
CALWD4 (Calibration Word 4) ................................... 62
CALWD5 (Calibration Word 5) ................................... 63
CALWD6 (Calibration Word 6) ................................... 64
CALWD7 (Calibration Word 7) ................................... 65
CMPZCON (Compensation Setting Control).............. 43
CONFIG (Configuration Word) ................................... 81
CSDGCON (Voltage For Zero Current Control) ......... 41
CSGSCON (Current Sense AC Gain Control)............ 40
DEADCON (Driver Dead Time Control) ..................... 46
INTCON (Interrupt Control) ........................................ 95
24-Pin QFN................................................................... 2
28-Pin QFN................................................................... 4
Pinout Description
Summary................................................................... 3, 5
Pinout Description Table..................................................... 12
PIR1 Register...................................................................... 98
PIR2 Register...................................................................... 99
PMADRH Register............................................................ 105
PMADRL Register..................................................... 105, 106
PMCON1 Register .................................................... 105, 107
PMCON2 Register ............................................................ 105
PMDATH Register ............................................................ 106
PMDATL Register............................................................. 106
PMDRH Register .............................................................. 107
PORTB
Additional Pin Functions
Weak Pull-up .................................................... 117
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 217
MCP19110/11
IOCA (Interrupt-on-Change PORTGPA)...................122
IOCB (Interrupt-on-Change PORTGPB)...................122
LPCRCON (Slope Compensation Ramp Control).......44
OCCON (Output Overcurrent Control)........................39
OOVCON (Output Overvoltage Detect Level Control) 48
OPTION_REG (Option) ..............................................77
OSCTUNE (Oscillator Tuning)....................................83
OUVCON (Output Under Voltage Detect Level Control)
48
OVCCON (Output Voltage Set Point Coarse Control) 47
PCON (Power Control) .........................................87, 92
PE1(Analog Peripheral Enable 1 Control) ..................50
PIE1 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable)..............................96
PIR1 (Peripheral Interrupt Flag)..................................98
PIR2 (Peripheral Interrupt Flag)..................................99
PMADRL (Program Memory Address)......................106
PMCON1 (Program Memory Control).......................107
PMDATH (Program Memory Data)...........................106
PMDATL (Program Memory Data)............................106
PMDRH (Program Memory Address)........................107
PORTGPA ................................................................113
PORTGPB ................................................................117
RELEFF (Relative Efficiency Measurement) ..............67
Reset Values...............................................................89
SLVGNCON (MASTER Error Signal Input Gain Control)
45
Special Function Registers................................................. 71
Special Registers Summary
Bank 0 ........................................................................ 73
Bank 1 ........................................................................ 74
Bank 2 ........................................................................ 75
Bank 3 ........................................................................ 76
SSPxADD Register................................................... 188, 189
SSPxCON1 Register ........................................................ 185
SSPxCON2 Register ........................................................ 186
SSPxCON3 Register ........................................................ 187
SSPxMSK Register................................................... 188, 189
SSPxOV............................................................................ 174
SSPxOV Status Flag ........................................................ 174
SSPxSTAT Register ......................................................... 184
R/W Bit ..................................................................... 153
Stack................................................................................... 78
Start-up Sequence.............................................................. 87
STATUS Register ............................................................... 71
Switching Frequency .......................................................... 18
System Bench Testing.................................................. 22, 57
T
T1CON Register ............................................................... 138
T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0 Bits............................................ 46
Temperature Indicator Module.......................................... 123
Thermal Specifications ....................................................... 28
Timer Requirements
Special Registers Summary......................73, 74, 75, 76
SSPCON1(SSP Control)...........................................185
SSPSTAT (SSP Status)............................................184
SSPxADD (MSSPx Address and Baud Rate, I2C Mode)
188, 189
RESET, Watchdog Timer, Oscillator Start-up Timer and
Power-up ............................................................ 32
Timer0....................................................................... 135, 141
8-Bit Counter Mode................................................... 135
8-bit Timer Mode....................................................... 135
Associated Registers................................................ 136
External Clock........................................................... 136
Operation.................................................................. 135
Operation During Sleep ............................................ 136
T0CKI ....................................................................... 136
Timer0 Module.................................................................. 135
Timer1............................................................................... 137
Associated Registers................................................ 139
Associated registers ................................................. 139
Clock Source Selection............................................. 137
Control Register........................................................ 138
Interrupt .................................................................... 138
Operation.................................................................. 137
Operation During Sleep ............................................ 138
Prescaler .................................................................. 138
Sleep ........................................................................ 138
TMR1H Register....................................................... 137
TMR1L Register........................................................ 137
Timer1 Module.................................................................. 137
Timer2
SSPxCON1 (MSSPx Control 1)................................185
SSPxCON2 (SSPx Control 2)...................................186
SSPxCON3 (SSPx Control 3)...................................187
SSPxMSK (SSPx Mask) ...................................188, 189
SSPxSTAT (SSPx Status) ........................................184
STATUS......................................................................71
T1CON (Timer1 Control)...........................................138
TRISA (Tri-State PORTA).........................................114
TRISGPB (PORTGPB Tri-State) ..............................117
TXCON .....................................................................141
VINLVL (Input Under Voltage Lockout Control)..........37
VZCCON (Voltage for Zero Current Control) ..............42
WPUB (Weak Pull-up PORTB).................................114
WPUGPA
Weak Pull-up PORTGPA..................................114
WPUGPB (Weak Pull-up PORTGPB).......................118
Relative Efficiency Circuity Control .....................................51
Relative Efficiency Measurement........................................67
Procedure ...................................................................67
Relative Efficiency Measurement Control ...........................51
Reset...................................................................................85
Determining Causes ...................................................91
Resets.................................................................................85
Associated Registers ..................................................92
Revision History ................................................................213
Associated registers ................................................. 141
Control Register........................................................ 141
Operation.................................................................. 140
Timer2 Module.................................................................. 140
Timer2/4/6
S
Associated Registers................................................ 141
Timers
Signal Chain Control ...........................................................51
Sleep
Timer1
Wake-up from ...........................................................101
Wake-up Using Interrupts .........................................102
Slope Compensation.....................................................18, 44
Slope Compensation Control ..............................................51
Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM).....................................205
Special Event Trigger........................................................128
T1CON ............................................................. 138
Timer2/4/6
TXCON............................................................. 141
Timing Diagrams
Acknowledge Sequence........................................... 176
Baud Rate Generator with Clock Arbitration............. 170
DS20002331D-page 218
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
BRG Reset Due to SDA Arbitration During Start Condi-
tion.................................................................... 179
Bus Collision During a Repeated Start Condition (Case
1)....................................................................... 180
Bus Collision During a Repeated Start Condition (Case
2)....................................................................... 180
Bus Collision During a Start Condition (SCL = 0) ..... 179
Bus Collision During a Stop Condition (Case 1) ....... 181
Bus Collision During a Stop Condition (Case 2) ....... 181
Bus Collision During Start Condition (SDA only) ...... 178
Bus Collision for Transmit and Acknowledge............ 177
Capture/Compare/PWM.............................................. 33
Clock Synchronization .............................................. 167
First Start Bit Timing ................................................. 170
I2C Master Mode (7 or 10-Bit Transmission) ............ 173
I2C Master Mode (7-Bit Reception)........................... 175
I2C Stop Condition Receive or Transmit Mode......... 176
INT Pin Interrupt.......................................................... 94
Power-up Timer .......................................................... 31
Repeat Start Condition.............................................. 171
Reset........................................................................... 31
Start-up Timer............................................................. 31
Time-out Sequence
Case 1 ................................................................ 87
Case 2 ................................................................ 88
Case 3 ................................................................ 88
Timer0......................................................................... 32
Timer1......................................................................... 32
Wake-up from Interrupt............................................. 102
Watchdog Timer.......................................................... 31
Timing Parameter Symbology............................................. 29
Timing Requirements
CLKOUT and I/O......................................................... 31
External Clock............................................................. 30
TRISA Register................................................................. 114
TRISGPA .......................................................................... 112
TRISGPA Register............................................................ 112
TRISGPB Register.................................................... 116, 117
TXCON (Timer2/4/6) Register .......................................... 141
Typical Application Circuit..................................................... 9
Typical Performance Curves............................................... 53
U
Under Voltage Lockout
Input............................................................................ 37
Unity Gain Buffer................................................................. 58
V
Voltage For Zero Current.................................................... 42
W
Watchdog Timer (WDT).............................................. 87, 103
Associated Registers ................................................ 104
Configuration Word w/ Watchdog Timer................... 104
Operation .................................................................. 103
Period........................................................................ 103
Programming Considerations ................................... 103
WCOL ....................................................... 170, 172, 174, 176
WCOL Status Flag.................................... 170, 172, 174, 176
WPUB Register................................................................. 114
WPUGPB Register............................................................ 118
WWW Address.................................................................. 221
WWW, On-Line Support ....................................................... 7
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 219
MCP19110/11
DS20002331D-page 220
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE
CUSTOMER SUPPORT
Microchip provides online support via our website at
www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means
to make files and information easily available to
customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet
browser, the web site contains the following
information:
Users of Microchip products can receive assistance
through several channels:
• Distributor or Representative
• Local Sales Office
• Field Application Engineer (FAE)
• Technical Support
• Product Support – Data sheets and errata,
application notes and sample programs, design
resources, user’s guides and hardware support
documents, latest software releases and archived
software
• Development Systems Information Line
Customers
should
contact
their
distributor,
representative or field application engineer (FAE) for
support. Local sales offices are also available to help
customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is
included in the back of this document.
• General Technical Support – Frequently Asked
Questions (FAQ), technical support requests,
online discussion groups, Microchip consultant
program member listing
Technical support is available through the web site
at: http://microchip.com/support
• Business of Microchip – Product selector and
ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases,
listing of seminars and events, listings of
Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory
representatives
CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION
SERVICE
Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep
customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers
will receive e-mail notification whenever there are
changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a
specified product family or development tool of interest.
To register, access the Microchip web site at
www.microchip.com. Under “Support”, click on “Cus-
tomer Change Notification” and follow the registration
instructions.
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 221
MCP19110/11
NOTES:
DS20002331D-page 222
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCP19110/11
PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office.
[X](1)
Examples:
PART NO.
X
/XX
-
a)
MCP19110-E/MJ: Extended temperature,
24LD QFN 4x4 package
MCP19110T-E/MJ: Tape and Reel,
Extended temperature,
Device Tape and Reel
Option
Temperature
Range
Package
b)
24LD QFN 4x4 package
Device:
MCP19110: Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Controller with
Integrated Synchronous Driver
a)
b)
MCP19111-E/MQ: Extended temperature,
28LD QFN 5x5 package
MCP19111T-E/MQ: Tape and Reel,
Extended temperature,
MCP19111: Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Controller with
Integrated Synchronous Driver
28LD QFN 5x5 package
Tape and Reel
Option:
Blank = Standard packaging (tube)
T
= Tape and Reel
Note 1: Tape and Reel identifier only appears in
the catalog part number description. This
identifier is used for ordering purposes
and is not printed on the device package.
Check with your Microchip Sales Office
for package availability with the Tape and
Reel option.
Temperature
Range:
E
= -40C to +125C (Extended)
Package:
MJ = 24-lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package -
4x4x0.9 mm body (QFN)
MQ = 28-lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package -
5x5x0.9 mm body (QFN)
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 223
MCP19110/11
NOTICE TO CUSTOMERS
®
This product is subject to a license from Power-One , Inc. related to digital power technology
(DPT) patents owned by Power-One, Inc. This license does not extend to stand-alone power
supply products.
DS20002331D-page 224
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices:
•
Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet.
•
Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the
intended manner and under normal conditions.
•
There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our
knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data
Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property.
•
•
Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code.
Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not
mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our
products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts
allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act.
Information contained in this publication regarding device
applications and the like is provided only for your convenience
and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to
ensure that your application meets with your specifications.
MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR
WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR
OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION,
QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR
FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability
arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip
devices in life support and/or safety applications is entirely at
the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees to defend, indemnify and
hold harmless Microchip from any and all damages, claims,
suits, or expenses resulting from such use. No licenses are
conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip
intellectual property rights unless otherwise stated.
Trademarks
The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, AnyRate,
dsPIC, FlashFlex, flexPWR, Heldo, JukeBlox, KeeLoq,
KeeLoq logo, Kleer, LANCheck, LINK MD, MediaLB, MOST,
MOST logo, MPLAB, OptoLyzer, PIC, PICSTART, PIC32 logo,
RightTouch, SpyNIC, SST, SST Logo, SuperFlash and UNI/O
are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology
Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries.
ClockWorks, The Embedded Control Solutions Company,
ETHERSYNCH, Hyper Speed Control, HyperLight Load,
IntelliMOS, mTouch, Precision Edge, and QUIET-WIRE are
registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A.
Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Any Capacitor, AnyIn, AnyOut,
BodyCom, chipKIT, chipKIT logo, CodeGuard, dsPICDEM,
dsPICDEM.net, Dynamic Average Matching, DAM, ECAN,
EtherGREEN, In-Circuit Serial Programming, ICSP, Inter-Chip
Connectivity, JitterBlocker, KleerNet, KleerNet logo, MiWi,
motorBench, MPASM, MPF, MPLAB Certified logo, MPLIB,
MPLINK, MultiTRAK, NetDetach, Omniscient Code
Generation, PICDEM, PICDEM.net, PICkit, PICtail,
PureSilicon, RightTouch logo, REAL ICE, Ripple Blocker,
Serial Quad I/O, SQI, SuperSwitcher, SuperSwitcher II, Total
Endurance, TSHARC, USBCheck, VariSense, ViewSpan,
WiperLock, Wireless DNA, and ZENA are trademarks of
Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other
countries.
SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A.
Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2009 certification for its worldwide
headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in Chandler and
Tempe, Arizona; Gresham, Oregon and design centers in California
and India. The Company’s quality system processes and procedures
are for its PIC® MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs, KEELOQ® code hopping
devices, Serial EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and
analog products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design
and manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified.
Silicon Storage Technology is a registered trademark of
Microchip Technology Inc. in other countries.
GestIC is a registered trademarks of Microchip Technology
Germany II GmbH & Co. KG, a subsidiary of Microchip
Technology Inc., in other countries.
All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their
respective companies.
QUALITYꢀMANAGEMENTꢀꢀSYSTEMꢀ
CERTIFIEDꢀBYꢀDNVꢀ
© 2013-2016, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in
the U.S.A., All Rights Reserved.
ISBN: 978-1-5224-0773-7
== ISO/TSꢀ16949ꢀ==ꢀ
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS20002331D-page 225
Worldwide Sales and Service
AMERICAS
ASIA/PACIFIC
ASIA/PACIFIC
EUROPE
Corporate Office
2355 West Chandler Blvd.
Chandler, AZ 85224-6199
Tel: 480-792-7200
Fax: 480-792-7277
Technical Support:
http://www.microchip.com/
support
Asia Pacific Office
China - Xiamen
Tel: 86-592-2388138
Fax: 86-592-2388130
Austria - Wels
Tel: 43-7242-2244-39
Fax: 43-7242-2244-393
Suites 3707-14, 37th Floor
Tower 6, The Gateway
Harbour City, Kowloon
China - Zhuhai
Tel: 86-756-3210040
Fax: 86-756-3210049
Denmark - Copenhagen
Tel: 45-4450-2828
Fax: 45-4485-2829
Hong Kong
Tel: 852-2943-5100
Fax: 852-2401-3431
India - Bangalore
Tel: 91-80-3090-4444
Fax: 91-80-3090-4123
France - Paris
Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20
Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
Australia - Sydney
Tel: 61-2-9868-6733
Fax: 61-2-9868-6755
Web Address:
www.microchip.com
India - New Delhi
Tel: 91-11-4160-8631
Fax: 91-11-4160-8632
Germany - Dusseldorf
Tel: 49-2129-3766400
Atlanta
Duluth, GA
Tel: 678-957-9614
Fax: 678-957-1455
China - Beijing
Tel: 86-10-8569-7000
Fax: 86-10-8528-2104
Germany - Karlsruhe
Tel: 49-721-625370
India - Pune
Tel: 91-20-3019-1500
China - Chengdu
Tel: 86-28-8665-5511
Fax: 86-28-8665-7889
Germany - Munich
Tel: 49-89-627-144-0
Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Austin, TX
Tel: 512-257-3370
Japan - Osaka
Tel: 81-6-6152-7160
Fax: 81-6-6152-9310
Boston
China - Chongqing
Tel: 86-23-8980-9588
Fax: 86-23-8980-9500
Italy - Milan
Tel: 39-0331-742611
Fax: 39-0331-466781
Westborough, MA
Tel: 774-760-0087
Fax: 774-760-0088
Japan - Tokyo
Tel: 81-3-6880- 3770
Fax: 81-3-6880-3771
China - Dongguan
Tel: 86-769-8702-9880
Italy - Venice
Tel: 39-049-7625286
Chicago
Itasca, IL
Tel: 630-285-0071
Fax: 630-285-0075
Korea - Daegu
Tel: 82-53-744-4301
Fax: 82-53-744-4302
China - Guangzhou
Tel: 86-20-8755-8029
Netherlands - Drunen
Tel: 31-416-690399
Fax: 31-416-690340
China - Hangzhou
Tel: 86-571-8792-8115
Fax: 86-571-8792-8116
Korea - Seoul
Cleveland
Tel: 82-2-554-7200
Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or
82-2-558-5934
Poland - Warsaw
Tel: 48-22-3325737
Independence, OH
Tel: 216-447-0464
Fax: 216-447-0643
China - Hong Kong SAR
Tel: 852-2943-5100
Fax: 852-2401-3431
Spain - Madrid
Tel: 34-91-708-08-90
Fax: 34-91-708-08-91
Malaysia - Kuala Lumpur
Tel: 60-3-6201-9857
Fax: 60-3-6201-9859
Dallas
Addison, TX
Tel: 972-818-7423
Fax: 972-818-2924
China - Nanjing
Tel: 86-25-8473-2460
Fax: 86-25-8473-2470
Sweden - Stockholm
Tel: 46-8-5090-4654
Malaysia - Penang
Tel: 60-4-227-8870
Fax: 60-4-227-4068
Detroit
Novi, MI
Tel: 248-848-4000
UK - Wokingham
Tel: 44-118-921-5800
Fax: 44-118-921-5820
China - Qingdao
Tel: 86-532-8502-7355
Fax: 86-532-8502-7205
Philippines - Manila
Tel: 63-2-634-9065
Fax: 63-2-634-9069
Houston, TX
Tel: 281-894-5983
China - Shanghai
Tel: 86-21-5407-5533
Fax: 86-21-5407-5066
Singapore
Tel: 65-6334-8870
Fax: 65-6334-8850
Indianapolis
Noblesville, IN
Tel: 317-773-8323
Fax: 317-773-5453
China - Shenyang
Tel: 86-24-2334-2829
Fax: 86-24-2334-2393
Taiwan - Hsin Chu
Tel: 886-3-5778-366
Fax: 886-3-5770-955
Los Angeles
China - Shenzhen
Tel: 86-755-8864-2200
Fax: 86-755-8203-1760
Mission Viejo, CA
Tel: 949-462-9523
Fax: 949-462-9608
Taiwan - Kaohsiung
Tel: 886-7-213-7828
China - Wuhan
Tel: 86-27-5980-5300
Fax: 86-27-5980-5118
Taiwan - Taipei
Tel: 886-2-2508-8600
Fax: 886-2-2508-0102
New York, NY
Tel: 631-435-6000
San Jose, CA
Tel: 408-735-9110
China - Xian
Tel: 86-29-8833-7252
Fax: 86-29-8833-7256
Thailand - Bangkok
Tel: 66-2-694-1351
Fax: 66-2-694-1350
Canada - Toronto
Tel: 905-695-1980
Fax: 905-695-2078
06/23/16
DS20002331D-page 226
2013-2016 Microchip Technology Inc.
相关型号:
MCP19111T-EMJ
Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Controller with Integrated Synchronous Driver
MICROCHIP
MCP19111T-EMQ
Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Controller with Integrated Synchronous Driver
MICROCHIP
MCP19116
Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Synchronous Low-Side PWM Controller with Improved 8k Word Core
MICROCHIP
MCP19116-E/MJ
Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Synchronous Low-Side PWM Controller with Improved 8k Word Core
MICROCHIP
MCP19116T-E/MJ
Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Synchronous Low-Side PWM Controller with Improved 8k Word Core
MICROCHIP
MCP19117
Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Synchronous Low-Side PWM Controller with Improved 8k Word Core
MICROCHIP
MCP19117-E/MQ
Digitally Enhanced Power Analog Synchronous Low-Side PWM Controller with Improved 8k Word Core
MICROCHIP
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明